params.c (set_param_value_internal): New.
[gcc.git] / gcc / doc / tm.texi
1 @c Copyright (C) 1988,1989,1992,1993,1994,1995,1996,1997,1998,1999,2000,2001,
2 @c 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010
3 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 @c This is part of the GCC manual.
5 @c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
6
7 @node Target Macros
8 @chapter Target Description Macros and Functions
9 @cindex machine description macros
10 @cindex target description macros
11 @cindex macros, target description
12 @cindex @file{tm.h} macros
13
14 In addition to the file @file{@var{machine}.md}, a machine description
15 includes a C header file conventionally given the name
16 @file{@var{machine}.h} and a C source file named @file{@var{machine}.c}.
17 The header file defines numerous macros that convey the information
18 about the target machine that does not fit into the scheme of the
19 @file{.md} file. The file @file{tm.h} should be a link to
20 @file{@var{machine}.h}. The header file @file{config.h} includes
21 @file{tm.h} and most compiler source files include @file{config.h}. The
22 source file defines a variable @code{targetm}, which is a structure
23 containing pointers to functions and data relating to the target
24 machine. @file{@var{machine}.c} should also contain their definitions,
25 if they are not defined elsewhere in GCC, and other functions called
26 through the macros defined in the @file{.h} file.
27
28 @menu
29 * Target Structure:: The @code{targetm} variable.
30 * Driver:: Controlling how the driver runs the compilation passes.
31 * Run-time Target:: Defining @samp{-m} options like @option{-m68000} and @option{-m68020}.
32 * Per-Function Data:: Defining data structures for per-function information.
33 * Storage Layout:: Defining sizes and alignments of data.
34 * Type Layout:: Defining sizes and properties of basic user data types.
35 * Registers:: Naming and describing the hardware registers.
36 * Register Classes:: Defining the classes of hardware registers.
37 * Old Constraints:: The old way to define machine-specific constraints.
38 * Stack and Calling:: Defining which way the stack grows and by how much.
39 * Varargs:: Defining the varargs macros.
40 * Trampolines:: Code set up at run time to enter a nested function.
41 * Library Calls:: Controlling how library routines are implicitly called.
42 * Addressing Modes:: Defining addressing modes valid for memory operands.
43 * Anchored Addresses:: Defining how @option{-fsection-anchors} should work.
44 * Condition Code:: Defining how insns update the condition code.
45 * Costs:: Defining relative costs of different operations.
46 * Scheduling:: Adjusting the behavior of the instruction scheduler.
47 * Sections:: Dividing storage into text, data, and other sections.
48 * PIC:: Macros for position independent code.
49 * Assembler Format:: Defining how to write insns and pseudo-ops to output.
50 * Debugging Info:: Defining the format of debugging output.
51 * Floating Point:: Handling floating point for cross-compilers.
52 * Mode Switching:: Insertion of mode-switching instructions.
53 * Target Attributes:: Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}.
54 * Emulated TLS:: Emulated TLS support.
55 * MIPS Coprocessors:: MIPS coprocessor support and how to customize it.
56 * PCH Target:: Validity checking for precompiled headers.
57 * C++ ABI:: Controlling C++ ABI changes.
58 * Named Address Spaces:: Adding support for named address spaces
59 * Misc:: Everything else.
60 @end menu
61
62 @node Target Structure
63 @section The Global @code{targetm} Variable
64 @cindex target hooks
65 @cindex target functions
66
67 @deftypevar {struct gcc_target} targetm
68 The target @file{.c} file must define the global @code{targetm} variable
69 which contains pointers to functions and data relating to the target
70 machine. The variable is declared in @file{target.h};
71 @file{target-def.h} defines the macro @code{TARGET_INITIALIZER} which is
72 used to initialize the variable, and macros for the default initializers
73 for elements of the structure. The @file{.c} file should override those
74 macros for which the default definition is inappropriate. For example:
75 @smallexample
76 #include "target.h"
77 #include "target-def.h"
78
79 /* @r{Initialize the GCC target structure.} */
80
81 #undef TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
82 #define TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES @var{machine}_comp_type_attributes
83
84 struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
85 @end smallexample
86 @end deftypevar
87
88 Where a macro should be defined in the @file{.c} file in this manner to
89 form part of the @code{targetm} structure, it is documented below as a
90 ``Target Hook'' with a prototype. Many macros will change in future
91 from being defined in the @file{.h} file to being part of the
92 @code{targetm} structure.
93
94 @node Driver
95 @section Controlling the Compilation Driver, @file{gcc}
96 @cindex driver
97 @cindex controlling the compilation driver
98
99 @c prevent bad page break with this line
100 You can control the compilation driver.
101
102 @defmac SWITCH_TAKES_ARG (@var{char})
103 A C expression which determines whether the option @option{-@var{char}}
104 takes arguments. The value should be the number of arguments that
105 option takes--zero, for many options.
106
107 By default, this macro is defined as
108 @code{DEFAULT_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG}, which handles the standard options
109 properly. You need not define @code{SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} unless you
110 wish to add additional options which take arguments. Any redefinition
111 should call @code{DEFAULT_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} and then check for
112 additional options.
113 @end defmac
114
115 @defmac WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG (@var{name})
116 A C expression which determines whether the option @option{-@var{name}}
117 takes arguments. The value should be the number of arguments that
118 option takes--zero, for many options. This macro rather than
119 @code{SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} is used for multi-character option names.
120
121 By default, this macro is defined as
122 @code{DEFAULT_WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG}, which handles the standard options
123 properly. You need not define @code{WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} unless you
124 wish to add additional options which take arguments. Any redefinition
125 should call @code{DEFAULT_WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} and then check for
126 additional options.
127 @end defmac
128
129 @defmac SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION (@var{char})
130 A C expression which determines whether the option @option{-@var{char}}
131 stops compilation before the generation of an executable. The value is
132 boolean, nonzero if the option does stop an executable from being
133 generated, zero otherwise.
134
135 By default, this macro is defined as
136 @code{DEFAULT_SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION}, which handles the standard
137 options properly. You need not define
138 @code{SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION} unless you wish to add additional
139 options which affect the generation of an executable. Any redefinition
140 should call @code{DEFAULT_SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION} and then check
141 for additional options.
142 @end defmac
143
144 @defmac TARGET_OPTION_TRANSLATE_TABLE
145 If defined, a list of pairs of strings, the first of which is a
146 potential command line target to the @file{gcc} driver program, and the
147 second of which is a space-separated (tabs and other whitespace are not
148 supported) list of options with which to replace the first option. The
149 target defining this list is responsible for assuring that the results
150 are valid. Replacement options may not be the @code{--opt} style, they
151 must be the @code{-opt} style. It is the intention of this macro to
152 provide a mechanism for substitution that affects the multilibs chosen,
153 such as one option that enables many options, some of which select
154 multilibs. Example nonsensical definition, where @option{-malt-abi},
155 @option{-EB}, and @option{-mspoo} cause different multilibs to be chosen:
156
157 @smallexample
158 #define TARGET_OPTION_TRANSLATE_TABLE \
159 @{ "-fast", "-march=fast-foo -malt-abi -I/usr/fast-foo" @}, \
160 @{ "-compat", "-EB -malign=4 -mspoo" @}
161 @end smallexample
162 @end defmac
163
164 @defmac DRIVER_SELF_SPECS
165 A list of specs for the driver itself. It should be a suitable
166 initializer for an array of strings, with no surrounding braces.
167
168 The driver applies these specs to its own command line between loading
169 default @file{specs} files (but not command-line specified ones) and
170 choosing the multilib directory or running any subcommands. It
171 applies them in the order given, so each spec can depend on the
172 options added by earlier ones. It is also possible to remove options
173 using @samp{%<@var{option}} in the usual way.
174
175 This macro can be useful when a port has several interdependent target
176 options. It provides a way of standardizing the command line so
177 that the other specs are easier to write.
178
179 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
180 @end defmac
181
182 @defmac OPTION_DEFAULT_SPECS
183 A list of specs used to support configure-time default options (i.e.@:
184 @option{--with} options) in the driver. It should be a suitable initializer
185 for an array of structures, each containing two strings, without the
186 outermost pair of surrounding braces.
187
188 The first item in the pair is the name of the default. This must match
189 the code in @file{config.gcc} for the target. The second item is a spec
190 to apply if a default with this name was specified. The string
191 @samp{%(VALUE)} in the spec will be replaced by the value of the default
192 everywhere it occurs.
193
194 The driver will apply these specs to its own command line between loading
195 default @file{specs} files and processing @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}, using
196 the same mechanism as @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}.
197
198 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
199 @end defmac
200
201 @defmac CPP_SPEC
202 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
203 pass to CPP@. It can also specify how to translate options you
204 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the CPP@.
205
206 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
207 @end defmac
208
209 @defmac CPLUSPLUS_CPP_SPEC
210 This macro is just like @code{CPP_SPEC}, but is used for C++, rather
211 than C@. If you do not define this macro, then the value of
212 @code{CPP_SPEC} (if any) will be used instead.
213 @end defmac
214
215 @defmac CC1_SPEC
216 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
217 pass to @code{cc1}, @code{cc1plus}, @code{f771}, and the other language
218 front ends.
219 It can also specify how to translate options you give to GCC into options
220 for GCC to pass to front ends.
221
222 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
223 @end defmac
224
225 @defmac CC1PLUS_SPEC
226 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
227 pass to @code{cc1plus}. It can also specify how to translate options you
228 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the @code{cc1plus}.
229
230 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
231 Note that everything defined in CC1_SPEC is already passed to
232 @code{cc1plus} so there is no need to duplicate the contents of
233 CC1_SPEC in CC1PLUS_SPEC@.
234 @end defmac
235
236 @defmac ASM_SPEC
237 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
238 pass to the assembler. It can also specify how to translate options
239 you give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the assembler.
240 See the file @file{sun3.h} for an example of this.
241
242 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
243 @end defmac
244
245 @defmac ASM_FINAL_SPEC
246 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program how to
247 run any programs which cleanup after the normal assembler.
248 Normally, this is not needed. See the file @file{mips.h} for
249 an example of this.
250
251 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
252 @end defmac
253
254 @defmac AS_NEEDS_DASH_FOR_PIPED_INPUT
255 Define this macro, with no value, if the driver should give the assembler
256 an argument consisting of a single dash, @option{-}, to instruct it to
257 read from its standard input (which will be a pipe connected to the
258 output of the compiler proper). This argument is given after any
259 @option{-o} option specifying the name of the output file.
260
261 If you do not define this macro, the assembler is assumed to read its
262 standard input if given no non-option arguments. If your assembler
263 cannot read standard input at all, use a @samp{%@{pipe:%e@}} construct;
264 see @file{mips.h} for instance.
265 @end defmac
266
267 @defmac LINK_SPEC
268 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
269 pass to the linker. It can also specify how to translate options you
270 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the linker.
271
272 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
273 @end defmac
274
275 @defmac LIB_SPEC
276 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The difference
277 between the two is that @code{LIB_SPEC} is used at the end of the
278 command given to the linker.
279
280 If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that
281 loads the standard C library from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
282 @end defmac
283
284 @defmac LIBGCC_SPEC
285 Another C string constant that tells the GCC driver program
286 how and when to place a reference to @file{libgcc.a} into the
287 linker command line. This constant is placed both before and after
288 the value of @code{LIB_SPEC}.
289
290 If this macro is not defined, the GCC driver provides a default that
291 passes the string @option{-lgcc} to the linker.
292 @end defmac
293
294 @defmac REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC
295 By default, if @code{ENABLE_SHARED_LIBGCC} is defined, the
296 @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} is not directly used by the driver program but is
297 instead modified to refer to different versions of @file{libgcc.a}
298 depending on the values of the command line flags @option{-static},
299 @option{-shared}, @option{-static-libgcc}, and @option{-shared-libgcc}. On
300 targets where these modifications are inappropriate, define
301 @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} instead. @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} tells the
302 driver how to place a reference to @file{libgcc} on the link command
303 line, but, unlike @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}, it is used unmodified.
304 @end defmac
305
306 @defmac USE_LD_AS_NEEDED
307 A macro that controls the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}
308 mentioned in @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}. If nonzero, a spec will be
309 generated that uses --as-needed and the shared libgcc in place of the
310 static exception handler library, when linking without any of
311 @code{-static}, @code{-static-libgcc}, or @code{-shared-libgcc}.
312 @end defmac
313
314 @defmac LINK_EH_SPEC
315 If defined, this C string constant is added to @code{LINK_SPEC}.
316 When @code{USE_LD_AS_NEEDED} is zero or undefined, it also affects
317 the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} mentioned in
318 @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}.
319 @end defmac
320
321 @defmac STARTFILE_SPEC
322 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
323 difference between the two is that @code{STARTFILE_SPEC} is used at
324 the very beginning of the command given to the linker.
325
326 If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that loads the
327 standard C startup file from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
328 @end defmac
329
330 @defmac ENDFILE_SPEC
331 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
332 difference between the two is that @code{ENDFILE_SPEC} is used at
333 the very end of the command given to the linker.
334
335 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
336 @end defmac
337
338 @defmac THREAD_MODEL_SPEC
339 GCC @code{-v} will print the thread model GCC was configured to use.
340 However, this doesn't work on platforms that are multilibbed on thread
341 models, such as AIX 4.3. On such platforms, define
342 @code{THREAD_MODEL_SPEC} such that it evaluates to a string without
343 blanks that names one of the recognized thread models. @code{%*}, the
344 default value of this macro, will expand to the value of
345 @code{thread_file} set in @file{config.gcc}.
346 @end defmac
347
348 @defmac SYSROOT_SUFFIX_SPEC
349 Define this macro to add a suffix to the target sysroot when GCC is
350 configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to search for usr/lib,
351 et al, within sysroot+suffix.
352 @end defmac
353
354 @defmac SYSROOT_HEADERS_SUFFIX_SPEC
355 Define this macro to add a headers_suffix to the target sysroot when
356 GCC is configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to pass the
357 updated sysroot+headers_suffix to CPP, causing it to search for
358 usr/include, et al, within sysroot+headers_suffix.
359 @end defmac
360
361 @defmac EXTRA_SPECS
362 Define this macro to provide additional specifications to put in the
363 @file{specs} file that can be used in various specifications like
364 @code{CC1_SPEC}.
365
366 The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures,
367 containing a string constant, that defines the specification name, and a
368 string constant that provides the specification.
369
370 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
371
372 @code{EXTRA_SPECS} is useful when an architecture contains several
373 related targets, which have various @code{@dots{}_SPECS} which are similar
374 to each other, and the maintainer would like one central place to keep
375 these definitions.
376
377 For example, the PowerPC System V.4 targets use @code{EXTRA_SPECS} to
378 define either @code{_CALL_SYSV} when the System V calling sequence is
379 used or @code{_CALL_AIX} when the older AIX-based calling sequence is
380 used.
381
382 The @file{config/rs6000/rs6000.h} target file defines:
383
384 @smallexample
385 #define EXTRA_SPECS \
386 @{ "cpp_sysv_default", CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT @},
387
388 #define CPP_SYS_DEFAULT ""
389 @end smallexample
390
391 The @file{config/rs6000/sysv.h} target file defines:
392 @smallexample
393 #undef CPP_SPEC
394 #define CPP_SPEC \
395 "%@{posix: -D_POSIX_SOURCE @} \
396 %@{mcall-sysv: -D_CALL_SYSV @} \
397 %@{!mcall-sysv: %(cpp_sysv_default) @} \
398 %@{msoft-float: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@} %@{mcpu=403: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@}"
399
400 #undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
401 #define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_SYSV"
402 @end smallexample
403
404 while the @file{config/rs6000/eabiaix.h} target file defines
405 @code{CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT} as:
406
407 @smallexample
408 #undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
409 #define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_AIX"
410 @end smallexample
411 @end defmac
412
413 @defmac LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
414 Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
415 @file{libgcc.a}. If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
416 the argument @option{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search.
417 @end defmac
418
419 @defmac LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC
420 The sequence in which libgcc and libc are specified to the linker.
421 By default this is @code{%G %L %G}.
422 @end defmac
423
424 @defmac LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
425 A C string constant giving the complete command line need to execute the
426 linker. When you do this, you will need to update your port each time a
427 change is made to the link command line within @file{gcc.c}. Therefore,
428 define this macro only if you need to completely redefine the command
429 line for invoking the linker and there is no other way to accomplish
430 the effect you need. Overriding this macro may be avoidable by overriding
431 @code{LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC} instead.
432 @end defmac
433
434 @defmac LINK_ELIMINATE_DUPLICATE_LDIRECTORIES
435 A nonzero value causes @command{collect2} to remove duplicate @option{-L@var{directory}} search
436 directories from linking commands. Do not give it a nonzero value if
437 removing duplicate search directories changes the linker's semantics.
438 @end defmac
439
440 @defmac MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
441 Define this macro as a C expression for the initializer of an array of
442 string to tell the driver program which options are defaults for this
443 target and thus do not need to be handled specially when using
444 @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS}.
445
446 Do not define this macro if @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} is not defined in
447 the target makefile fragment or if none of the options listed in
448 @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} are set by default.
449 @xref{Target Fragment}.
450 @end defmac
451
452 @defmac RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
453 Define this macro to tell @command{gcc} that it should only translate
454 a @option{-B} prefix into a @option{-L} linker option if the prefix
455 indicates an absolute file name.
456 @end defmac
457
458 @defmac MD_EXEC_PREFIX
459 If defined, this macro is an additional prefix to try after
460 @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched
461 when the compiler is built as a cross
462 compiler. If you define @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, then be sure to add it
463 to the list of directories used to find the assembler in @file{configure.in}.
464 @end defmac
465
466 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
467 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
468 standard choice of @code{libdir} as the default prefix to
469 try when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
470 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX} is not searched when the compiler
471 is built as a cross compiler.
472 @end defmac
473
474 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
475 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
476 standard choice of @code{/lib} as a prefix to try after the default prefix
477 when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
478 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1} is not searched when the compiler
479 is built as a cross compiler.
480 @end defmac
481
482 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2
483 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
484 standard choice of @code{/lib} as yet another prefix to try after the
485 default prefix when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
486 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2} is not searched when the compiler
487 is built as a cross compiler.
488 @end defmac
489
490 @defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
491 If defined, this macro supplies an additional prefix to try after the
492 standard prefixes. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched when the
493 compiler is built as a cross compiler.
494 @end defmac
495
496 @defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
497 If defined, this macro supplies yet another prefix to try after the
498 standard prefixes. It is not searched when the compiler is built as a
499 cross compiler.
500 @end defmac
501
502 @defmac INIT_ENVIRONMENT
503 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to set environment
504 variables for programs called by the driver, such as the assembler and
505 loader. The driver passes the value of this macro to @code{putenv} to
506 initialize the necessary environment variables.
507 @end defmac
508
509 @defmac LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
510 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
511 standard choice of @file{/usr/local/include} as the default prefix to
512 try when searching for local header files. @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR}
513 comes before @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR} in the search order.
514
515 Cross compilers do not search either @file{/usr/local/include} or its
516 replacement.
517 @end defmac
518
519 @defmac SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR
520 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to specify a
521 system-specific directory to search for header files before the standard
522 directory. @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR} comes before
523 @code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR} in the search order.
524
525 Cross compilers do not use this macro and do not search the directory
526 specified.
527 @end defmac
528
529 @defmac STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR
530 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
531 standard choice of @file{/usr/include} as the default prefix to
532 try when searching for header files.
533
534 Cross compilers ignore this macro and do not search either
535 @file{/usr/include} or its replacement.
536 @end defmac
537
538 @defmac STANDARD_INCLUDE_COMPONENT
539 The ``component'' corresponding to @code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR}.
540 See @code{INCLUDE_DEFAULTS}, below, for the description of components.
541 If you do not define this macro, no component is used.
542 @end defmac
543
544 @defmac INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
545 Define this macro if you wish to override the entire default search path
546 for include files. For a native compiler, the default search path
547 usually consists of @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR},
548 @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}, and
549 @code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR}. In addition, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}
550 and @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR} are defined automatically by @file{Makefile},
551 and specify private search areas for GCC@. The directory
552 @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR} is used only for C++ programs.
553
554 The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures.
555 Each array element should have four elements: the directory name (a
556 string constant), the component name (also a string constant), a flag
557 for C++-only directories,
558 and a flag showing that the includes in the directory don't need to be
559 wrapped in @code{extern @samp{C}} when compiling C++. Mark the end of
560 the array with a null element.
561
562 The component name denotes what GNU package the include file is part of,
563 if any, in all uppercase letters. For example, it might be @samp{GCC}
564 or @samp{BINUTILS}. If the package is part of a vendor-supplied
565 operating system, code the component name as @samp{0}.
566
567 For example, here is the definition used for VAX/VMS:
568
569 @smallexample
570 #define INCLUDE_DEFAULTS \
571 @{ \
572 @{ "GNU_GXX_INCLUDE:", "G++", 1, 1@}, \
573 @{ "GNU_CC_INCLUDE:", "GCC", 0, 0@}, \
574 @{ "SYS$SYSROOT:[SYSLIB.]", 0, 0, 0@}, \
575 @{ ".", 0, 0, 0@}, \
576 @{ 0, 0, 0, 0@} \
577 @}
578 @end smallexample
579 @end defmac
580
581 Here is the order of prefixes tried for exec files:
582
583 @enumerate
584 @item
585 Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
586
587 @item
588 The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or, if @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}
589 is not set and the compiler has not been installed in the configure-time
590 @var{prefix}, the location in which the compiler has actually been installed.
591
592 @item
593 The directories specified by the environment variable @code{COMPILER_PATH}.
594
595 @item
596 The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if the compiler has been installed
597 in the configured-time @var{prefix}.
598
599 @item
600 The location @file{/usr/libexec/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
601
602 @item
603 The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
604
605 @item
606 The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
607 compiler.
608 @end enumerate
609
610 Here is the order of prefixes tried for startfiles:
611
612 @enumerate
613 @item
614 Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
615
616 @item
617 The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or its automatically determined
618 value based on the installed toolchain location.
619
620 @item
621 The directories specified by the environment variable @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
622 (or port-specific name; native only, cross compilers do not use this).
623
624 @item
625 The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, but only if the toolchain is installed
626 in the configured @var{prefix} or this is a native compiler.
627
628 @item
629 The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
630
631 @item
632 The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
633 compiler.
634
635 @item
636 The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a
637 native compiler, or we have a target system root.
638
639 @item
640 The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, if defined, but only if this is a
641 native compiler, or we have a target system root.
642
643 @item
644 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, with any sysroot modifications.
645 If this path is relative it will be prefixed by @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} and
646 the machine suffix or @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX} and the machine suffix.
647
648 @item
649 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, but only if this is a native
650 compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
651 @file{/lib/}.
652
653 @item
654 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2}, but only if this is a native
655 compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
656 @file{/usr/lib/}.
657 @end enumerate
658
659 @node Run-time Target
660 @section Run-time Target Specification
661 @cindex run-time target specification
662 @cindex predefined macros
663 @cindex target specifications
664
665 @c prevent bad page break with this line
666 Here are run-time target specifications.
667
668 @defmac TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS ()
669 This function-like macro expands to a block of code that defines
670 built-in preprocessor macros and assertions for the target CPU, using
671 the functions @code{builtin_define}, @code{builtin_define_std} and
672 @code{builtin_assert}. When the front end
673 calls this macro it provides a trailing semicolon, and since it has
674 finished command line option processing your code can use those
675 results freely.
676
677 @code{builtin_assert} takes a string in the form you pass to the
678 command-line option @option{-A}, such as @code{cpu=mips}, and creates
679 the assertion. @code{builtin_define} takes a string in the form
680 accepted by option @option{-D} and unconditionally defines the macro.
681
682 @code{builtin_define_std} takes a string representing the name of an
683 object-like macro. If it doesn't lie in the user's namespace,
684 @code{builtin_define_std} defines it unconditionally. Otherwise, it
685 defines a version with two leading underscores, and another version
686 with two leading and trailing underscores, and defines the original
687 only if an ISO standard was not requested on the command line. For
688 example, passing @code{unix} defines @code{__unix}, @code{__unix__}
689 and possibly @code{unix}; passing @code{_mips} defines @code{__mips},
690 @code{__mips__} and possibly @code{_mips}, and passing @code{_ABI64}
691 defines only @code{_ABI64}.
692
693 You can also test for the C dialect being compiled. The variable
694 @code{c_language} is set to one of @code{clk_c}, @code{clk_cplusplus}
695 or @code{clk_objective_c}. Note that if we are preprocessing
696 assembler, this variable will be @code{clk_c} but the function-like
697 macro @code{preprocessing_asm_p()} will return true, so you might want
698 to check for that first. If you need to check for strict ANSI, the
699 variable @code{flag_iso} can be used. The function-like macro
700 @code{preprocessing_trad_p()} can be used to check for traditional
701 preprocessing.
702 @end defmac
703
704 @defmac TARGET_OS_CPP_BUILTINS ()
705 Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
706 and is used for the target operating system instead.
707 @end defmac
708
709 @defmac TARGET_OBJFMT_CPP_BUILTINS ()
710 Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
711 and is used for the target object format. @file{elfos.h} uses this
712 macro to define @code{__ELF__}, so you probably do not need to define
713 it yourself.
714 @end defmac
715
716 @deftypevar {extern int} target_flags
717 This variable is declared in @file{options.h}, which is included before
718 any target-specific headers.
719 @end deftypevar
720
721 @deftypevr {Target Hook} int TARGET_DEFAULT_TARGET_FLAGS
722 This variable specifies the initial value of @code{target_flags}.
723 Its default setting is 0.
724 @end deftypevr
725
726 @cindex optional hardware or system features
727 @cindex features, optional, in system conventions
728
729 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION (size_t @var{code}, const char *@var{arg}, int @var{value})
730 This hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
731 target-specific options described by the @file{.opt} definition files
732 (@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some option-specific
733 processing and should return true if the option is valid. The default
734 definition does nothing but return true.
735
736 @var{code} specifies the @code{OPT_@var{name}} enumeration value
737 associated with the selected option; @var{name} is just a rendering of
738 the option name in which non-alphanumeric characters are replaced by
739 underscores. @var{arg} specifies the string argument and is null if
740 no argument was given. If the option is flagged as a @code{UInteger}
741 (@pxref{Option properties}), @var{value} is the numeric value of the
742 argument. Otherwise @var{value} is 1 if the positive form of the
743 option was used and 0 if the ``no-'' form was.
744 @end deftypefn
745
746 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION (size_t @var{code}, const char *@var{arg}, int @var{value})
747 This target hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
748 target-specific C language family options described by the @file{.opt}
749 definition files(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some
750 option-specific processing and should return true if the option is
751 valid. The arguments are like for @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION}. The
752 default definition does nothing but return false.
753
754 In general, you should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION} to handle
755 options. However, if processing an option requires routines that are
756 only available in the C (and related language) front ends, then you
757 should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION} instead.
758 @end deftypefn
759
760 @defmac TARGET_VERSION
761 This macro is a C statement to print on @code{stderr} a string
762 describing the particular machine description choice. Every machine
763 description should define @code{TARGET_VERSION}. For example:
764
765 @smallexample
766 #ifdef MOTOROLA
767 #define TARGET_VERSION \
768 fprintf (stderr, " (68k, Motorola syntax)");
769 #else
770 #define TARGET_VERSION \
771 fprintf (stderr, " (68k, MIT syntax)");
772 #endif
773 @end smallexample
774 @end defmac
775
776 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE (void)
777 This target function is similar to the hook @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}
778 but is called when the optimize level is changed via an attribute or
779 pragma or when it is reset at the end of the code affected by the
780 attribute or pragma. It is not called at the beginning of compilation
781 when @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} is called so if you want to perform these
782 actions then, you should have @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} call
783 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}.
784 @end deftypefn
785
786 @defmac C_COMMON_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
787 This is similar to the @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} hook
788 but is only used in the C
789 language frontends (C, Objective-C, C++, Objective-C++) and so can be
790 used to alter option flag variables which only exist in those
791 frontends.
792 @end defmac
793
794 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION (int @var{level}, int @var{size})
795 Some machines may desire to change what optimizations are performed for
796 various optimization levels. This hook, if defined, is executed once
797 just after the optimization level is determined and before the remainder
798 of the command options have been parsed. Values set in this macro are
799 used as the default values for the other command line options.
800
801 @var{level} is the optimization level specified; 2 if @option{-O2} is
802 specified, 1 if @option{-O} is specified, and 0 if neither is specified.
803
804 @var{size} is nonzero if @option{-Os} is specified and zero otherwise.
805
806 This macro is run once at program startup and when the optimization
807 options are changed via @code{#pragma GCC optimize} or by using the
808 @code{optimize} attribute.
809
810 @strong{Do not examine @code{write_symbols} in
811 this hook!} The debugging options are not supposed to alter the
812 generated code.
813 @end deftypefn
814
815 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_DEFAULT_PARAMS (void)
816 Set target-dependent default values for @option{--param} settings, using calls to @code{set_default_param_value}.
817 @end deftypefn
818
819 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_HELP (void)
820 This hook is called in response to the user invoking
821 @option{--target-help} on the command line. It gives the target a
822 chance to display extra information on the target specific command
823 line options found in its @file{.opt} file.
824 @end deftypefn
825
826 @defmac CAN_DEBUG_WITHOUT_FP
827 Define this macro if debugging can be performed even without a frame
828 pointer. If this macro is defined, GCC will turn on the
829 @option{-fomit-frame-pointer} option whenever @option{-O} is specified.
830 @end defmac
831
832 @defmac SWITCHABLE_TARGET
833 Some targets need to switch between substantially different subtargets
834 during compilation. For example, the MIPS target has one subtarget for
835 the traditional MIPS architecture and another for MIPS16. Source code
836 can switch between these two subarchitectures using the @code{mips16}
837 and @code{nomips16} attributes.
838
839 Such subtargets can differ in things like the set of available
840 registers, the set of available instructions, the costs of various
841 operations, and so on. GCC caches a lot of this type of information
842 in global variables, and recomputing them for each subtarget takes a
843 significant amount of time. The compiler therefore provides a facility
844 for maintaining several versions of the global variables and quickly
845 switching between them; see @file{target-globals.h} for details.
846
847 Define this macro to 1 if your target needs this facility. The default
848 is 0.
849 @end defmac
850
851 @node Per-Function Data
852 @section Defining data structures for per-function information.
853 @cindex per-function data
854 @cindex data structures
855
856 If the target needs to store information on a per-function basis, GCC
857 provides a macro and a couple of variables to allow this. Note, just
858 using statics to store the information is a bad idea, since GCC supports
859 nested functions, so you can be halfway through encoding one function
860 when another one comes along.
861
862 GCC defines a data structure called @code{struct function} which
863 contains all of the data specific to an individual function. This
864 structure contains a field called @code{machine} whose type is
865 @code{struct machine_function *}, which can be used by targets to point
866 to their own specific data.
867
868 If a target needs per-function specific data it should define the type
869 @code{struct machine_function} and also the macro @code{INIT_EXPANDERS}.
870 This macro should be used to initialize the function pointer
871 @code{init_machine_status}. This pointer is explained below.
872
873 One typical use of per-function, target specific data is to create an
874 RTX to hold the register containing the function's return address. This
875 RTX can then be used to implement the @code{__builtin_return_address}
876 function, for level 0.
877
878 Note---earlier implementations of GCC used a single data area to hold
879 all of the per-function information. Thus when processing of a nested
880 function began the old per-function data had to be pushed onto a
881 stack, and when the processing was finished, it had to be popped off the
882 stack. GCC used to provide function pointers called
883 @code{save_machine_status} and @code{restore_machine_status} to handle
884 the saving and restoring of the target specific information. Since the
885 single data area approach is no longer used, these pointers are no
886 longer supported.
887
888 @defmac INIT_EXPANDERS
889 Macro called to initialize any target specific information. This macro
890 is called once per function, before generation of any RTL has begun.
891 The intention of this macro is to allow the initialization of the
892 function pointer @code{init_machine_status}.
893 @end defmac
894
895 @deftypevar {void (*)(struct function *)} init_machine_status
896 If this function pointer is non-@code{NULL} it will be called once per
897 function, before function compilation starts, in order to allow the
898 target to perform any target specific initialization of the
899 @code{struct function} structure. It is intended that this would be
900 used to initialize the @code{machine} of that structure.
901
902 @code{struct machine_function} structures are expected to be freed by GC@.
903 Generally, any memory that they reference must be allocated by using
904 GC allocation, including the structure itself.
905 @end deftypevar
906
907 @node Storage Layout
908 @section Storage Layout
909 @cindex storage layout
910
911 Note that the definitions of the macros in this table which are sizes or
912 alignments measured in bits do not need to be constant. They can be C
913 expressions that refer to static variables, such as the @code{target_flags}.
914 @xref{Run-time Target}.
915
916 @defmac BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
917 Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant bit in a
918 byte has the lowest number; otherwise define it to have the value zero.
919 This means that bit-field instructions count from the most significant
920 bit. If the machine has no bit-field instructions, then this must still
921 be defined, but it doesn't matter which value it is defined to. This
922 macro need not be a constant.
923
924 This macro does not affect the way structure fields are packed into
925 bytes or words; that is controlled by @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN}.
926 @end defmac
927
928 @defmac BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
929 Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant byte in a
930 word has the lowest number. This macro need not be a constant.
931 @end defmac
932
933 @defmac WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
934 Define this macro to have the value 1 if, in a multiword object, the
935 most significant word has the lowest number. This applies to both
936 memory locations and registers; GCC fundamentally assumes that the
937 order of words in memory is the same as the order in registers. This
938 macro need not be a constant.
939 @end defmac
940
941 @defmac LIBGCC2_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
942 Define this macro if @code{WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} is not constant. This must be a
943 constant value with the same meaning as @code{WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN}, which will be
944 used only when compiling @file{libgcc2.c}. Typically the value will be set
945 based on preprocessor defines.
946 @end defmac
947
948 @defmac FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
949 Define this macro to have the value 1 if @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} or
950 @code{TFmode} floating point numbers are stored in memory with the word
951 containing the sign bit at the lowest address; otherwise define it to
952 have the value 0. This macro need not be a constant.
953
954 You need not define this macro if the ordering is the same as for
955 multi-word integers.
956 @end defmac
957
958 @defmac BITS_PER_UNIT
959 Define this macro to be the number of bits in an addressable storage
960 unit (byte). If you do not define this macro the default is 8.
961 @end defmac
962
963 @defmac BITS_PER_WORD
964 Number of bits in a word. If you do not define this macro, the default
965 is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * UNITS_PER_WORD}.
966 @end defmac
967
968 @defmac MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
969 Maximum number of bits in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
970 @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
971 largest value that @code{BITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
972 @end defmac
973
974 @defmac UNITS_PER_WORD
975 Number of storage units in a word; normally the size of a general-purpose
976 register, a power of two from 1 or 8.
977 @end defmac
978
979 @defmac MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
980 Minimum number of units in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
981 @code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
982 smallest value that @code{UNITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
983 @end defmac
984
985 @defmac POINTER_SIZE
986 Width of a pointer, in bits. You must specify a value no wider than the
987 width of @code{Pmode}. If it is not equal to the width of @code{Pmode},
988 you must define @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED}. If you do not specify
989 a value the default is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
990 @end defmac
991
992 @defmac POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
993 A C expression that determines how pointers should be extended from
994 @code{ptr_mode} to either @code{Pmode} or @code{word_mode}. It is
995 greater than zero if pointers should be zero-extended, zero if they
996 should be sign-extended, and negative if some other sort of conversion
997 is needed. In the last case, the extension is done by the target's
998 @code{ptr_extend} instruction.
999
1000 You need not define this macro if the @code{ptr_mode}, @code{Pmode}
1001 and @code{word_mode} are all the same width.
1002 @end defmac
1003
1004 @defmac PROMOTE_MODE (@var{m}, @var{unsignedp}, @var{type})
1005 A macro to update @var{m} and @var{unsignedp} when an object whose type
1006 is @var{type} and which has the specified mode and signedness is to be
1007 stored in a register. This macro is only called when @var{type} is a
1008 scalar type.
1009
1010 On most RISC machines, which only have operations that operate on a full
1011 register, define this macro to set @var{m} to @code{word_mode} if
1012 @var{m} is an integer mode narrower than @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. In most
1013 cases, only integer modes should be widened because wider-precision
1014 floating-point operations are usually more expensive than their narrower
1015 counterparts.
1016
1017 For most machines, the macro definition does not change @var{unsignedp}.
1018 However, some machines, have instructions that preferentially handle
1019 either signed or unsigned quantities of certain modes. For example, on
1020 the DEC Alpha, 32-bit loads from memory and 32-bit add instructions
1021 sign-extend the result to 64 bits. On such machines, set
1022 @var{unsignedp} according to which kind of extension is more efficient.
1023
1024 Do not define this macro if it would never modify @var{m}.
1025 @end defmac
1026
1027 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_MODE (const_tree @var{type}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, int *@var{punsignedp}, const_tree @var{funtype}, int @var{for_return})
1028 Like @code{PROMOTE_MODE}, but it is applied to outgoing function arguments or
1029 function return values. The target hook should return the new mode
1030 and possibly change @code{*@var{punsignedp}} if the promotion should
1031 change signedness. This function is called only for scalar @emph{or
1032 pointer} types.
1033
1034 @var{for_return} allows to distinguish the promotion of arguments and
1035 return values. If it is @code{1}, a return value is being promoted and
1036 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must perform the same promotions done here.
1037 If it is @code{2}, the returned mode should be that of the register in
1038 which an incoming parameter is copied, or the outgoing result is computed;
1039 then the hook should return the same mode as @code{promote_mode}, though
1040 the signedness may be different.
1041
1042 The default is to not promote arguments and return values. You can
1043 also define the hook to @code{default_promote_function_mode_always_promote}
1044 if you would like to apply the same rules given by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}.
1045 @end deftypefn
1046
1047 @defmac PARM_BOUNDARY
1048 Normal alignment required for function parameters on the stack, in
1049 bits. All stack parameters receive at least this much alignment
1050 regardless of data type. On most machines, this is the same as the
1051 size of an integer.
1052 @end defmac
1053
1054 @defmac STACK_BOUNDARY
1055 Define this macro to the minimum alignment enforced by hardware for the
1056 stack pointer on this machine. The definition is a C expression for the
1057 desired alignment (measured in bits). This value is used as a default
1058 if @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY} is not defined. On most machines,
1059 this should be the same as @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}.
1060 @end defmac
1061
1062 @defmac PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY
1063 Define this macro if you wish to preserve a certain alignment for the
1064 stack pointer, greater than what the hardware enforces. The definition
1065 is a C expression for the desired alignment (measured in bits). This
1066 macro must evaluate to a value equal to or larger than
1067 @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1068 @end defmac
1069
1070 @defmac INCOMING_STACK_BOUNDARY
1071 Define this macro if the incoming stack boundary may be different
1072 from @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}. This macro must evaluate
1073 to a value equal to or larger than @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1074 @end defmac
1075
1076 @defmac FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
1077 Alignment required for a function entry point, in bits.
1078 @end defmac
1079
1080 @defmac BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
1081 Biggest alignment that any data type can require on this machine, in
1082 bits. Note that this is not the biggest alignment that is supported,
1083 just the biggest alignment that, when violated, may cause a fault.
1084 @end defmac
1085
1086 @defmac MALLOC_ABI_ALIGNMENT
1087 Alignment, in bits, a C conformant malloc implementation has to
1088 provide. If not defined, the default value is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
1089 @end defmac
1090
1091 @defmac ATTRIBUTE_ALIGNED_VALUE
1092 Alignment used by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned))} construct. If
1093 not defined, the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1094 @end defmac
1095
1096 @defmac MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
1097 If defined, the smallest alignment, in bits, that can be given to an
1098 object that can be referenced in one operation, without disturbing any
1099 nearby object. Normally, this is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}, but may be larger
1100 on machines that don't have byte or half-word store operations.
1101 @end defmac
1102
1103 @defmac BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
1104 Biggest alignment that any structure or union field can require on this
1105 machine, in bits. If defined, this overrides @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} for
1106 structure and union fields only, unless the field alignment has been set
1107 by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1108 @end defmac
1109
1110 @defmac ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN (@var{field}, @var{computed})
1111 An expression for the alignment of a structure field @var{field} if the
1112 alignment computed in the usual way (including applying of
1113 @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} and @code{BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT} to the
1114 alignment) is @var{computed}. It overrides alignment only if the
1115 field alignment has not been set by the
1116 @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1117 @end defmac
1118
1119 @defmac MAX_STACK_ALIGNMENT
1120 Biggest stack alignment guaranteed by the backend. Use this macro
1121 to specify the maximum alignment of a variable on stack.
1122
1123 If not defined, the default value is @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1124
1125 @c FIXME: The default should be @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1126 @c But the fix for PR 32893 indicates that we can only guarantee
1127 @c maximum stack alignment on stack up to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, not
1128 @c @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}, if stack alignment isn't supported.
1129 @end defmac
1130
1131 @defmac MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
1132 Biggest alignment supported by the object file format of this machine.
1133 Use this macro to limit the alignment which can be specified using the
1134 @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct. If not defined,
1135 the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1136
1137 On systems that use ELF, the default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is
1138 the largest supported 32-bit ELF section alignment representable on
1139 a 32-bit host e.g. @samp{(((unsigned HOST_WIDEST_INT) 1 << 28) * 8)}.
1140 On 32-bit ELF the largest supported section alignment in bits is
1141 @samp{(0x80000000 * 8)}, but this is not representable on 32-bit hosts.
1142 @end defmac
1143
1144 @defmac DATA_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1145 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1146 the static store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1147 the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1148 macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1149
1150 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1151
1152 @findex strcpy
1153 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1154 make it all fit in fewer cache lines. Another is to cause character
1155 arrays to be word-aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1156 constants to character arrays can be done inline.
1157 @end defmac
1158
1159 @defmac CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT (@var{constant}, @var{basic-align})
1160 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment given to a constant
1161 that is being placed in memory. @var{constant} is the constant and
1162 @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the object would ordinarily
1163 have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1164 align the object.
1165
1166 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1167
1168 The typical use of this macro is to increase alignment for string
1169 constants to be word aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1170 constants can be done inline.
1171 @end defmac
1172
1173 @defmac LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1174 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1175 the local store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1176 the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1177 macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1178
1179 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1180
1181 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1182 make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1183 @end defmac
1184
1185 @defmac STACK_SLOT_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{mode}, @var{basic-align})
1186 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for stack slot.
1187 @var{type} is the data type, @var{mode} is the widest mode available,
1188 and @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the slot would ordinarily
1189 have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1190 align the slot.
1191
1192 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used when
1193 @var{type} is @code{NULL}. Otherwise, @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT} will
1194 be used.
1195
1196 This macro is to set alignment of stack slot to the maximum alignment
1197 of all possible modes which the slot may have.
1198 @end defmac
1199
1200 @defmac LOCAL_DECL_ALIGNMENT (@var{decl})
1201 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a local
1202 variable @var{decl}.
1203
1204 If this macro is not defined, then
1205 @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (TREE_TYPE (@var{decl}), DECL_ALIGN (@var{decl}))}
1206 is used.
1207
1208 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1209 make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1210 @end defmac
1211
1212 @defmac MINIMUM_ALIGNMENT (@var{exp}, @var{mode}, @var{align})
1213 If defined, a C expression to compute the minimum required alignment
1214 for dynamic stack realignment purposes for @var{exp} (a type or decl),
1215 @var{mode}, assuming normal alignment @var{align}.
1216
1217 If this macro is not defined, then @var{align} will be used.
1218 @end defmac
1219
1220 @defmac EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
1221 Alignment in bits to be given to a structure bit-field that follows an
1222 empty field such as @code{int : 0;}.
1223
1224 If @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true, it overrides this macro.
1225 @end defmac
1226
1227 @defmac STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
1228 Number of bits which any structure or union's size must be a multiple of.
1229 Each structure or union's size is rounded up to a multiple of this.
1230
1231 If you do not define this macro, the default is the same as
1232 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1233 @end defmac
1234
1235 @defmac STRICT_ALIGNMENT
1236 Define this macro to be the value 1 if instructions will fail to work
1237 if given data not on the nominal alignment. If instructions will merely
1238 go slower in that case, define this macro as 0.
1239 @end defmac
1240
1241 @defmac PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
1242 Define this if you wish to imitate the way many other C compilers handle
1243 alignment of bit-fields and the structures that contain them.
1244
1245 The behavior is that the type written for a named bit-field (@code{int},
1246 @code{short}, or other integer type) imposes an alignment for the entire
1247 structure, as if the structure really did contain an ordinary field of
1248 that type. In addition, the bit-field is placed within the structure so
1249 that it would fit within such a field, not crossing a boundary for it.
1250
1251 Thus, on most machines, a named bit-field whose type is written as
1252 @code{int} would not cross a four-byte boundary, and would force
1253 four-byte alignment for the whole structure. (The alignment used may
1254 not be four bytes; it is controlled by the other alignment parameters.)
1255
1256 An unnamed bit-field will not affect the alignment of the containing
1257 structure.
1258
1259 If the macro is defined, its definition should be a C expression;
1260 a nonzero value for the expression enables this behavior.
1261
1262 Note that if this macro is not defined, or its value is zero, some
1263 bit-fields may cross more than one alignment boundary. The compiler can
1264 support such references if there are @samp{insv}, @samp{extv}, and
1265 @samp{extzv} insns that can directly reference memory.
1266
1267 The other known way of making bit-fields work is to define
1268 @code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} as large as @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1269 Then every structure can be accessed with fullwords.
1270
1271 Unless the machine has bit-field instructions or you define
1272 @code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} that way, you must define
1273 @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} to have a nonzero value.
1274
1275 If your aim is to make GCC use the same conventions for laying out
1276 bit-fields as are used by another compiler, here is how to investigate
1277 what the other compiler does. Compile and run this program:
1278
1279 @smallexample
1280 struct foo1
1281 @{
1282 char x;
1283 char :0;
1284 char y;
1285 @};
1286
1287 struct foo2
1288 @{
1289 char x;
1290 int :0;
1291 char y;
1292 @};
1293
1294 main ()
1295 @{
1296 printf ("Size of foo1 is %d\n",
1297 sizeof (struct foo1));
1298 printf ("Size of foo2 is %d\n",
1299 sizeof (struct foo2));
1300 exit (0);
1301 @}
1302 @end smallexample
1303
1304 If this prints 2 and 5, then the compiler's behavior is what you would
1305 get from @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS}.
1306 @end defmac
1307
1308 @defmac BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
1309 Like @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} except that its effect is limited
1310 to aligning a bit-field within the structure.
1311 @end defmac
1312
1313 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALIGN_ANON_BITFIELD (void)
1314 When @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true this hook will determine
1315 whether unnamed bitfields affect the alignment of the containing
1316 structure. The hook should return true if the structure should inherit
1317 the alignment requirements of an unnamed bitfield's type.
1318 @end deftypefn
1319
1320 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NARROW_VOLATILE_BITFIELD (void)
1321 This target hook should return @code{true} if accesses to volatile bitfields
1322 should use the narrowest mode possible. It should return @code{false} if
1323 these accesses should use the bitfield container type.
1324
1325 The default is @code{!TARGET_STRICT_ALIGN}.
1326 @end deftypefn
1327
1328 @defmac MEMBER_TYPE_FORCES_BLK (@var{field}, @var{mode})
1329 Return 1 if a structure or array containing @var{field} should be accessed using
1330 @code{BLKMODE}.
1331
1332 If @var{field} is the only field in the structure, @var{mode} is its
1333 mode, otherwise @var{mode} is VOIDmode. @var{mode} is provided in the
1334 case where structures of one field would require the structure's mode to
1335 retain the field's mode.
1336
1337 Normally, this is not needed.
1338 @end defmac
1339
1340 @defmac ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
1341 Define this macro as an expression for the alignment of a type (given
1342 by @var{type} as a tree node) if the alignment computed in the usual
1343 way is @var{computed} and the alignment explicitly specified was
1344 @var{specified}.
1345
1346 The default is to use @var{specified} if it is larger; otherwise, use
1347 the smaller of @var{computed} and @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
1348 @end defmac
1349
1350 @defmac MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
1351 An integer expression for the size in bits of the largest integer
1352 machine mode that should actually be used. All integer machine modes of
1353 this size or smaller can be used for structures and unions with the
1354 appropriate sizes. If this macro is undefined, @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE
1355 (DImode)} is assumed.
1356 @end defmac
1357
1358 @defmac STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE (@var{save_level})
1359 If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1360 specifies the mode of the save area operand of a
1361 @code{save_stack_@var{level}} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1362 @var{save_level} is one of @code{SAVE_BLOCK}, @code{SAVE_FUNCTION}, or
1363 @code{SAVE_NONLOCAL} and selects which of the three named patterns is
1364 having its mode specified.
1365
1366 You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{Pmode}. You
1367 would most commonly define this macro if the
1368 @code{save_stack_@var{level}} patterns need to support both a 32- and a
1369 64-bit mode.
1370 @end defmac
1371
1372 @defmac STACK_SIZE_MODE
1373 If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1374 specifies the mode of the size increment operand of an
1375 @code{allocate_stack} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1376
1377 You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{word_mode}.
1378 You would most commonly define this macro if the @code{allocate_stack}
1379 pattern needs to support both a 32- and a 64-bit mode.
1380 @end defmac
1381
1382 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_LIBGCC_CMP_RETURN_MODE (void)
1383 This target hook should return the mode to be used for the return value
1384 of compare instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1385 @code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1386 targets.
1387 @end deftypefn
1388
1389 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_LIBGCC_SHIFT_COUNT_MODE (void)
1390 This target hook should return the mode to be used for the shift count operand
1391 of shift instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1392 @code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1393 targets.
1394 @end deftypefn
1395
1396 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_UNWIND_WORD_MODE (void)
1397 Return machine mode to be used for @code{_Unwind_Word} type.
1398 The default is to use @code{word_mode}.
1399 @end deftypefn
1400
1401 @defmac ROUND_TOWARDS_ZERO
1402 If defined, this macro should be true if the prevailing rounding
1403 mode is towards zero.
1404
1405 Defining this macro only affects the way @file{libgcc.a} emulates
1406 floating-point arithmetic.
1407
1408 Not defining this macro is equivalent to returning zero.
1409 @end defmac
1410
1411 @defmac LARGEST_EXPONENT_IS_NORMAL (@var{size})
1412 This macro should return true if floats with @var{size}
1413 bits do not have a NaN or infinity representation, but use the largest
1414 exponent for normal numbers instead.
1415
1416 Defining this macro only affects the way @file{libgcc.a} emulates
1417 floating-point arithmetic.
1418
1419 The default definition of this macro returns false for all sizes.
1420 @end defmac
1421
1422 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MS_BITFIELD_LAYOUT_P (const_tree @var{record_type})
1423 This target hook returns @code{true} if bit-fields in the given
1424 @var{record_type} are to be laid out following the rules of Microsoft
1425 Visual C/C++, namely: (i) a bit-field won't share the same storage
1426 unit with the previous bit-field if their underlying types have
1427 different sizes, and the bit-field will be aligned to the highest
1428 alignment of the underlying types of itself and of the previous
1429 bit-field; (ii) a zero-sized bit-field will affect the alignment of
1430 the whole enclosing structure, even if it is unnamed; except that
1431 (iii) a zero-sized bit-field will be disregarded unless it follows
1432 another bit-field of nonzero size. If this hook returns @code{true},
1433 other macros that control bit-field layout are ignored.
1434
1435 When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size
1436 of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent
1437 bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record,
1438 and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same
1439 chunk of 32 bits. However, if the size changes, a new field of that
1440 size is allocated). In an unpacked record, this is the same as using
1441 alignment, but not equivalent when packing.
1442
1443 If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used,
1444 the latter will take precedence. If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is
1445 used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take
1446 precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure
1447 may affect its placement.
1448 @end deftypefn
1449
1450 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DECIMAL_FLOAT_SUPPORTED_P (void)
1451 Returns true if the target supports decimal floating point.
1452 @end deftypefn
1453
1454 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FIXED_POINT_SUPPORTED_P (void)
1455 Returns true if the target supports fixed-point arithmetic.
1456 @end deftypefn
1457
1458 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXPAND_TO_RTL_HOOK (void)
1459 This hook is called just before expansion into rtl, allowing the target
1460 to perform additional initializations or analysis before the expansion.
1461 For example, the rs6000 port uses it to allocate a scratch stack slot
1462 for use in copying SDmode values between memory and floating point
1463 registers whenever the function being expanded has any SDmode
1464 usage.
1465 @end deftypefn
1466
1467 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSTANTIATE_DECLS (void)
1468 This hook allows the backend to perform additional instantiations on rtl
1469 that are not actually in any insns yet, but will be later.
1470 @end deftypefn
1471
1472 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_MANGLE_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
1473 If your target defines any fundamental types, or any types your target
1474 uses should be mangled differently from the default, define this hook
1475 to return the appropriate encoding for these types as part of a C++
1476 mangled name. The @var{type} argument is the tree structure representing
1477 the type to be mangled. The hook may be applied to trees which are
1478 not target-specific fundamental types; it should return @code{NULL}
1479 for all such types, as well as arguments it does not recognize. If the
1480 return value is not @code{NULL}, it must point to a statically-allocated
1481 string constant.
1482
1483 Target-specific fundamental types might be new fundamental types or
1484 qualified versions of ordinary fundamental types. Encode new
1485 fundamental types as @samp{@w{u @var{n} @var{name}}}, where @var{name}
1486 is the name used for the type in source code, and @var{n} is the
1487 length of @var{name} in decimal. Encode qualified versions of
1488 ordinary types as @samp{@w{U @var{n} @var{name} @var{code}}}, where
1489 @var{name} is the name used for the type qualifier in source code,
1490 @var{n} is the length of @var{name} as above, and @var{code} is the
1491 code used to represent the unqualified version of this type. (See
1492 @code{write_builtin_type} in @file{cp/mangle.c} for the list of
1493 codes.) In both cases the spaces are for clarity; do not include any
1494 spaces in your string.
1495
1496 This hook is applied to types prior to typedef resolution. If the mangled
1497 name for a particular type depends only on that type's main variant, you
1498 can perform typedef resolution yourself using @code{TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT}
1499 before mangling.
1500
1501 The default version of this hook always returns @code{NULL}, which is
1502 appropriate for a target that does not define any new fundamental
1503 types.
1504 @end deftypefn
1505
1506 @node Type Layout
1507 @section Layout of Source Language Data Types
1508
1509 These macros define the sizes and other characteristics of the standard
1510 basic data types used in programs being compiled. Unlike the macros in
1511 the previous section, these apply to specific features of C and related
1512 languages, rather than to fundamental aspects of storage layout.
1513
1514 @defmac INT_TYPE_SIZE
1515 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{int} on the
1516 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1517 @end defmac
1518
1519 @defmac SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
1520 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short} on the
1521 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is half a word.
1522 (If this would be less than one storage unit, it is rounded up to one
1523 unit.)
1524 @end defmac
1525
1526 @defmac LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1527 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
1528 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1529 @end defmac
1530
1531 @defmac ADA_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1532 On some machines, the size used for the Ada equivalent of the type
1533 @code{long} by a native Ada compiler differs from that used by C@. In
1534 that situation, define this macro to be a C expression to be used for
1535 the size of that type. If you don't define this, the default is the
1536 value of @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE}.
1537 @end defmac
1538
1539 @defmac LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1540 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long} on the
1541 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1542 words. If you want to support GNU Ada on your machine, the value of this
1543 macro must be at least 64.
1544 @end defmac
1545
1546 @defmac CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1547 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{char} on the
1548 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1549 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1550 @end defmac
1551
1552 @defmac BOOL_TYPE_SIZE
1553 A C expression for the size in bits of the C++ type @code{bool} and
1554 C99 type @code{_Bool} on the target machine. If you don't define
1555 this, and you probably shouldn't, the default is @code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE}.
1556 @end defmac
1557
1558 @defmac FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
1559 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{float} on the
1560 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1561 @end defmac
1562
1563 @defmac DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1564 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{double} on the
1565 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1566 words.
1567 @end defmac
1568
1569 @defmac LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1570 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on
1571 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1572 words.
1573 @end defmac
1574
1575 @defmac SHORT_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1576 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Fract} on
1577 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1578 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1579 @end defmac
1580
1581 @defmac FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1582 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Fract} on
1583 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1584 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1585 @end defmac
1586
1587 @defmac LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1588 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Fract} on
1589 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1590 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1591 @end defmac
1592
1593 @defmac LONG_LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1594 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Fract} on
1595 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1596 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1597 @end defmac
1598
1599 @defmac SHORT_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1600 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Accum} on
1601 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1602 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1603 @end defmac
1604
1605 @defmac ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1606 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Accum} on
1607 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1608 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1609 @end defmac
1610
1611 @defmac LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1612 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Accum} on
1613 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1614 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1615 @end defmac
1616
1617 @defmac LONG_LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1618 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Accum} on
1619 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1620 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 16}.
1621 @end defmac
1622
1623 @defmac LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1624 Define this macro if @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not constant or
1625 if you want routines in @file{libgcc2.a} for a size other than
1626 @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}. If you don't define this, the
1627 default is @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1628 @end defmac
1629
1630 @defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_DF_MODE
1631 Define this macro if neither @code{LIBGCC2_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} nor
1632 @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is
1633 @code{DFmode} but you want @code{DFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1634 anyway. If you don't define this and either @code{LIBGCC2_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1635 or @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64 then the default is 1,
1636 otherwise it is 0.
1637 @end defmac
1638
1639 @defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_XF_MODE
1640 Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
1641 @code{XFmode} but you want @code{XFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1642 anyway. If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1643 is 80 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
1644 @end defmac
1645
1646 @defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_TF_MODE
1647 Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
1648 @code{TFmode} but you want @code{TFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1649 anyway. If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1650 is 128 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
1651 @end defmac
1652
1653 @defmac SF_SIZE
1654 @defmacx DF_SIZE
1655 @defmacx XF_SIZE
1656 @defmacx TF_SIZE
1657 Define these macros to be the size in bits of the mantissa of
1658 @code{SFmode}, @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} and @code{TFmode} values,
1659 if the defaults in @file{libgcc2.h} are inappropriate. By default,
1660 @code{FLT_MANT_DIG} is used for @code{SF_SIZE}, @code{LDBL_MANT_DIG}
1661 for @code{XF_SIZE} and @code{TF_SIZE}, and @code{DBL_MANT_DIG} or
1662 @code{LDBL_MANT_DIG} for @code{DF_SIZE} according to whether
1663 @code{LIBGCC2_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} or
1664 @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64.
1665 @end defmac
1666
1667 @defmac TARGET_FLT_EVAL_METHOD
1668 A C expression for the value for @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} in @file{float.h},
1669 assuming, if applicable, that the floating-point control word is in its
1670 default state. If you do not define this macro the value of
1671 @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} will be zero.
1672 @end defmac
1673
1674 @defmac WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
1675 A C expression for the size in bits of the widest floating-point format
1676 supported by the hardware. If you define this macro, you must specify a
1677 value less than or equal to the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1678 If you do not define this macro, the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1679 is the default.
1680 @end defmac
1681
1682 @defmac DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
1683 An expression whose value is 1 or 0, according to whether the type
1684 @code{char} should be signed or unsigned by default. The user can
1685 always override this default with the options @option{-fsigned-char}
1686 and @option{-funsigned-char}.
1687 @end defmac
1688
1689 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS (void)
1690 This target hook should return true if the compiler should give an
1691 @code{enum} type only as many bytes as it takes to represent the range
1692 of possible values of that type. It should return false if all
1693 @code{enum} types should be allocated like @code{int}.
1694
1695 The default is to return false.
1696 @end deftypefn
1697
1698 @defmac SIZE_TYPE
1699 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1700 for size values. The typedef name @code{size_t} is defined using the
1701 contents of the string.
1702
1703 The string can contain more than one keyword. If so, separate them with
1704 spaces, and write first any length keyword, then @code{unsigned} if
1705 appropriate, and finally @code{int}. The string must exactly match one
1706 of the data type names defined in the function
1707 @code{init_decl_processing} in the file @file{c-decl.c}. You may not
1708 omit @code{int} or change the order---that would cause the compiler to
1709 crash on startup.
1710
1711 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long unsigned
1712 int"}.
1713 @end defmac
1714
1715 @defmac PTRDIFF_TYPE
1716 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1717 for the result of subtracting two pointers. The typedef name
1718 @code{ptrdiff_t} is defined using the contents of the string. See
1719 @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1720
1721 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long int"}.
1722 @end defmac
1723
1724 @defmac WCHAR_TYPE
1725 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1726 for wide characters. The typedef name @code{wchar_t} is defined using
1727 the contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1728 information.
1729
1730 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"int"}.
1731 @end defmac
1732
1733 @defmac WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1734 A C expression for the size in bits of the data type for wide
1735 characters. This is used in @code{cpp}, which cannot make use of
1736 @code{WCHAR_TYPE}.
1737 @end defmac
1738
1739 @defmac WINT_TYPE
1740 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to
1741 use for wide characters passed to @code{printf} and returned from
1742 @code{getwc}. The typedef name @code{wint_t} is defined using the
1743 contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1744 information.
1745
1746 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"unsigned int"}.
1747 @end defmac
1748
1749 @defmac INTMAX_TYPE
1750 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1751 can represent any value of any standard or extended signed integer type.
1752 The typedef name @code{intmax_t} is defined using the contents of the
1753 string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1754
1755 If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1756 @code{"int"}, @code{"long int"}, or @code{"long long int"} that has as
1757 much precision as @code{long long int}.
1758 @end defmac
1759
1760 @defmac UINTMAX_TYPE
1761 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1762 can represent any value of any standard or extended unsigned integer
1763 type. The typedef name @code{uintmax_t} is defined using the contents
1764 of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1765
1766 If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1767 @code{"unsigned int"}, @code{"long unsigned int"}, or @code{"long long
1768 unsigned int"} that has as much precision as @code{long long unsigned
1769 int}.
1770 @end defmac
1771
1772 @defmac SIG_ATOMIC_TYPE
1773 @defmacx INT8_TYPE
1774 @defmacx INT16_TYPE
1775 @defmacx INT32_TYPE
1776 @defmacx INT64_TYPE
1777 @defmacx UINT8_TYPE
1778 @defmacx UINT16_TYPE
1779 @defmacx UINT32_TYPE
1780 @defmacx UINT64_TYPE
1781 @defmacx INT_LEAST8_TYPE
1782 @defmacx INT_LEAST16_TYPE
1783 @defmacx INT_LEAST32_TYPE
1784 @defmacx INT_LEAST64_TYPE
1785 @defmacx UINT_LEAST8_TYPE
1786 @defmacx UINT_LEAST16_TYPE
1787 @defmacx UINT_LEAST32_TYPE
1788 @defmacx UINT_LEAST64_TYPE
1789 @defmacx INT_FAST8_TYPE
1790 @defmacx INT_FAST16_TYPE
1791 @defmacx INT_FAST32_TYPE
1792 @defmacx INT_FAST64_TYPE
1793 @defmacx UINT_FAST8_TYPE
1794 @defmacx UINT_FAST16_TYPE
1795 @defmacx UINT_FAST32_TYPE
1796 @defmacx UINT_FAST64_TYPE
1797 @defmacx INTPTR_TYPE
1798 @defmacx UINTPTR_TYPE
1799 C expressions for the standard types @code{sig_atomic_t},
1800 @code{int8_t}, @code{int16_t}, @code{int32_t}, @code{int64_t},
1801 @code{uint8_t}, @code{uint16_t}, @code{uint32_t}, @code{uint64_t},
1802 @code{int_least8_t}, @code{int_least16_t}, @code{int_least32_t},
1803 @code{int_least64_t}, @code{uint_least8_t}, @code{uint_least16_t},
1804 @code{uint_least32_t}, @code{uint_least64_t}, @code{int_fast8_t},
1805 @code{int_fast16_t}, @code{int_fast32_t}, @code{int_fast64_t},
1806 @code{uint_fast8_t}, @code{uint_fast16_t}, @code{uint_fast32_t},
1807 @code{uint_fast64_t}, @code{intptr_t}, and @code{uintptr_t}. See
1808 @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1809
1810 If any of these macros evaluates to a null pointer, the corresponding
1811 type is not supported; if GCC is configured to provide
1812 @code{<stdint.h>} in such a case, the header provided may not conform
1813 to C99, depending on the type in question. The defaults for all of
1814 these macros are null pointers.
1815 @end defmac
1816
1817 @defmac TARGET_PTRMEMFUNC_VBIT_LOCATION
1818 The C++ compiler represents a pointer-to-member-function with a struct
1819 that looks like:
1820
1821 @smallexample
1822 struct @{
1823 union @{
1824 void (*fn)();
1825 ptrdiff_t vtable_index;
1826 @};
1827 ptrdiff_t delta;
1828 @};
1829 @end smallexample
1830
1831 @noindent
1832 The C++ compiler must use one bit to indicate whether the function that
1833 will be called through a pointer-to-member-function is virtual.
1834 Normally, we assume that the low-order bit of a function pointer must
1835 always be zero. Then, by ensuring that the vtable_index is odd, we can
1836 distinguish which variant of the union is in use. But, on some
1837 platforms function pointers can be odd, and so this doesn't work. In
1838 that case, we use the low-order bit of the @code{delta} field, and shift
1839 the remainder of the @code{delta} field to the left.
1840
1841 GCC will automatically make the right selection about where to store
1842 this bit using the @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY} setting for your platform.
1843 However, some platforms such as ARM/Thumb have @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}
1844 set such that functions always start at even addresses, but the lowest
1845 bit of pointers to functions indicate whether the function at that
1846 address is in ARM or Thumb mode. If this is the case of your
1847 architecture, you should define this macro to
1848 @code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_delta}.
1849
1850 In general, you should not have to define this macro. On architectures
1851 in which function addresses are always even, according to
1852 @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}, GCC will automatically define this macro to
1853 @code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_pfn}.
1854 @end defmac
1855
1856 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS
1857 Normally, the C++ compiler uses function pointers in vtables. This
1858 macro allows the target to change to use ``function descriptors''
1859 instead. Function descriptors are found on targets for whom a
1860 function pointer is actually a small data structure. Normally the
1861 data structure consists of the actual code address plus a data
1862 pointer to which the function's data is relative.
1863
1864 If vtables are used, the value of this macro should be the number
1865 of words that the function descriptor occupies.
1866 @end defmac
1867
1868 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN
1869 By default, the vtable entries are void pointers, the so the alignment
1870 is the same as pointer alignment. The value of this macro specifies
1871 the alignment of the vtable entry in bits. It should be defined only
1872 when special alignment is necessary. */
1873 @end defmac
1874
1875 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_DATA_ENTRY_DISTANCE
1876 There are a few non-descriptor entries in the vtable at offsets below
1877 zero. If these entries must be padded (say, to preserve the alignment
1878 specified by @code{TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN}), set this to the number
1879 of words in each data entry.
1880 @end defmac
1881
1882 @node Registers
1883 @section Register Usage
1884 @cindex register usage
1885
1886 This section explains how to describe what registers the target machine
1887 has, and how (in general) they can be used.
1888
1889 The description of which registers a specific instruction can use is
1890 done with register classes; see @ref{Register Classes}. For information
1891 on using registers to access a stack frame, see @ref{Frame Registers}.
1892 For passing values in registers, see @ref{Register Arguments}.
1893 For returning values in registers, see @ref{Scalar Return}.
1894
1895 @menu
1896 * Register Basics:: Number and kinds of registers.
1897 * Allocation Order:: Order in which registers are allocated.
1898 * Values in Registers:: What kinds of values each reg can hold.
1899 * Leaf Functions:: Renumbering registers for leaf functions.
1900 * Stack Registers:: Handling a register stack such as 80387.
1901 @end menu
1902
1903 @node Register Basics
1904 @subsection Basic Characteristics of Registers
1905
1906 @c prevent bad page break with this line
1907 Registers have various characteristics.
1908
1909 @defmac FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1910 Number of hardware registers known to the compiler. They receive
1911 numbers 0 through @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER-1}; thus, the first
1912 pseudo register's number really is assigned the number
1913 @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
1914 @end defmac
1915
1916 @defmac FIXED_REGISTERS
1917 @cindex fixed register
1918 An initializer that says which registers are used for fixed purposes
1919 all throughout the compiled code and are therefore not available for
1920 general allocation. These would include the stack pointer, the frame
1921 pointer (except on machines where that can be used as a general
1922 register when no frame pointer is needed), the program counter on
1923 machines where that is considered one of the addressable registers,
1924 and any other numbered register with a standard use.
1925
1926 This information is expressed as a sequence of numbers, separated by
1927 commas and surrounded by braces. The @var{n}th number is 1 if
1928 register @var{n} is fixed, 0 otherwise.
1929
1930 The table initialized from this macro, and the table initialized by
1931 the following one, may be overridden at run time either automatically,
1932 by the actions of the macro @code{CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}, or by
1933 the user with the command options @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1934 @option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}.
1935 @end defmac
1936
1937 @defmac CALL_USED_REGISTERS
1938 @cindex call-used register
1939 @cindex call-clobbered register
1940 @cindex call-saved register
1941 Like @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} but has 1 for each register that is
1942 clobbered (in general) by function calls as well as for fixed
1943 registers. This macro therefore identifies the registers that are not
1944 available for general allocation of values that must live across
1945 function calls.
1946
1947 If a register has 0 in @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}, the compiler
1948 automatically saves it on function entry and restores it on function
1949 exit, if the register is used within the function.
1950 @end defmac
1951
1952 @defmac CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS
1953 @cindex call-used register
1954 @cindex call-clobbered register
1955 @cindex call-saved register
1956 Like @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} except this macro doesn't require
1957 that the entire set of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} be included.
1958 (@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} must be a superset of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}).
1959 This macro is optional. If not specified, it defaults to the value
1960 of @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}.
1961 @end defmac
1962
1963 @defmac HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1964 @cindex call-used register
1965 @cindex call-clobbered register
1966 @cindex call-saved register
1967 A C expression that is nonzero if it is not permissible to store a
1968 value of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} across a
1969 call without some part of it being clobbered. For most machines this
1970 macro need not be defined. It is only required for machines that do not
1971 preserve the entire contents of a register across a call.
1972 @end defmac
1973
1974 @findex fixed_regs
1975 @findex call_used_regs
1976 @findex global_regs
1977 @findex reg_names
1978 @findex reg_class_contents
1979 @defmac CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE
1980 Zero or more C statements that may conditionally modify five variables
1981 @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs}, @code{global_regs},
1982 @code{reg_names}, and @code{reg_class_contents}, to take into account
1983 any dependence of these register sets on target flags. The first three
1984 of these are of type @code{char []} (interpreted as Boolean vectors).
1985 @code{global_regs} is a @code{const char *[]}, and
1986 @code{reg_class_contents} is a @code{HARD_REG_SET}. Before the macro is
1987 called, @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs},
1988 @code{reg_class_contents}, and @code{reg_names} have been initialized
1989 from @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS},
1990 @code{REG_CLASS_CONTENTS}, and @code{REGISTER_NAMES}, respectively.
1991 @code{global_regs} has been cleared, and any @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1992 @option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}
1993 command options have been applied.
1994
1995 You need not define this macro if it has no work to do.
1996
1997 @cindex disabling certain registers
1998 @cindex controlling register usage
1999 If the usage of an entire class of registers depends on the target
2000 flags, you may indicate this to GCC by using this macro to modify
2001 @code{fixed_regs} and @code{call_used_regs} to 1 for each of the
2002 registers in the classes which should not be used by GCC@. Also define
2003 the macro @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} / @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
2004 to return @code{NO_REGS} if it
2005 is called with a letter for a class that shouldn't be used.
2006
2007 (However, if this class is not included in @code{GENERAL_REGS} and all
2008 of the insn patterns whose constraints permit this class are
2009 controlled by target switches, then GCC will automatically avoid using
2010 these registers when the target switches are opposed to them.)
2011 @end defmac
2012
2013 @defmac INCOMING_REGNO (@var{out})
2014 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
2015 expression returns the register number as seen by the called function
2016 corresponding to the register number @var{out} as seen by the calling
2017 function. Return @var{out} if register number @var{out} is not an
2018 outbound register.
2019 @end defmac
2020
2021 @defmac OUTGOING_REGNO (@var{in})
2022 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
2023 expression returns the register number as seen by the calling function
2024 corresponding to the register number @var{in} as seen by the called
2025 function. Return @var{in} if register number @var{in} is not an inbound
2026 register.
2027 @end defmac
2028
2029 @defmac LOCAL_REGNO (@var{regno})
2030 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
2031 expression returns true if the register is call-saved but is in the
2032 register window. Unlike most call-saved registers, such registers
2033 need not be explicitly restored on function exit or during non-local
2034 gotos.
2035 @end defmac
2036
2037 @defmac PC_REGNUM
2038 If the program counter has a register number, define this as that
2039 register number. Otherwise, do not define it.
2040 @end defmac
2041
2042 @node Allocation Order
2043 @subsection Order of Allocation of Registers
2044 @cindex order of register allocation
2045 @cindex register allocation order
2046
2047 @c prevent bad page break with this line
2048 Registers are allocated in order.
2049
2050 @defmac REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2051 If defined, an initializer for a vector of integers, containing the
2052 numbers of hard registers in the order in which GCC should prefer
2053 to use them (from most preferred to least).
2054
2055 If this macro is not defined, registers are used lowest numbered first
2056 (all else being equal).
2057
2058 One use of this macro is on machines where the highest numbered
2059 registers must always be saved and the save-multiple-registers
2060 instruction supports only sequences of consecutive registers. On such
2061 machines, define @code{REG_ALLOC_ORDER} to be an initializer that lists
2062 the highest numbered allocable register first.
2063 @end defmac
2064
2065 @defmac ADJUST_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2066 A C statement (sans semicolon) to choose the order in which to allocate
2067 hard registers for pseudo-registers local to a basic block.
2068
2069 Store the desired register order in the array @code{reg_alloc_order}.
2070 Element 0 should be the register to allocate first; element 1, the next
2071 register; and so on.
2072
2073 The macro body should not assume anything about the contents of
2074 @code{reg_alloc_order} before execution of the macro.
2075
2076 On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2077 @end defmac
2078
2079 @defmac HONOR_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2080 Normally, IRA tries to estimate the costs for saving a register in the
2081 prologue and restoring it in the epilogue. This discourages it from
2082 using call-saved registers. If a machine wants to ensure that IRA
2083 allocates registers in the order given by REG_ALLOC_ORDER even if some
2084 call-saved registers appear earlier than call-used ones, this macro
2085 should be defined.
2086 @end defmac
2087
2088 @defmac IRA_HARD_REGNO_ADD_COST_MULTIPLIER (@var{regno})
2089 In some case register allocation order is not enough for the
2090 Integrated Register Allocator (@acronym{IRA}) to generate a good code.
2091 If this macro is defined, it should return a floating point value
2092 based on @var{regno}. The cost of using @var{regno} for a pseudo will
2093 be increased by approximately the pseudo's usage frequency times the
2094 value returned by this macro. Not defining this macro is equivalent
2095 to having it always return @code{0.0}.
2096
2097 On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2098 @end defmac
2099
2100 @node Values in Registers
2101 @subsection How Values Fit in Registers
2102
2103 This section discusses the macros that describe which kinds of values
2104 (specifically, which machine modes) each register can hold, and how many
2105 consecutive registers are needed for a given mode.
2106
2107 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2108 A C expression for the number of consecutive hard registers, starting
2109 at register number @var{regno}, required to hold a value of mode
2110 @var{mode}. This macro must never return zero, even if a register
2111 cannot hold the requested mode - indicate that with HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK
2112 and/or CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS instead.
2113
2114 On a machine where all registers are exactly one word, a suitable
2115 definition of this macro is
2116
2117 @smallexample
2118 #define HARD_REGNO_NREGS(REGNO, MODE) \
2119 ((GET_MODE_SIZE (MODE) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) \
2120 / UNITS_PER_WORD)
2121 @end smallexample
2122 @end defmac
2123
2124 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2125 A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode @var{mode}, stored
2126 in memory, ends with padding that causes it to take up more space than
2127 in registers starting at register number @var{regno} (as determined by
2128 multiplying GCC's notion of the size of the register when containing
2129 this mode by the number of registers returned by
2130 @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}). By default this is zero.
2131
2132 For example, if a floating-point value is stored in three 32-bit
2133 registers but takes up 128 bits in memory, then this would be
2134 nonzero.
2135
2136 This macros only needs to be defined if there are cases where
2137 @code{subreg_get_info}
2138 would otherwise wrongly determine that a @code{subreg} can be
2139 represented by an offset to the register number, when in fact such a
2140 @code{subreg} would contain some of the padding not stored in
2141 registers and so not be representable.
2142 @end defmac
2143
2144 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_WITH_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2145 For values of @var{regno} and @var{mode} for which
2146 @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING} returns nonzero, a C expression
2147 returning the greater number of registers required to hold the value
2148 including any padding. In the example above, the value would be four.
2149 @end defmac
2150
2151 @defmac REGMODE_NATURAL_SIZE (@var{mode})
2152 Define this macro if the natural size of registers that hold values
2153 of mode @var{mode} is not the word size. It is a C expression that
2154 should give the natural size in bytes for the specified mode. It is
2155 used by the register allocator to try to optimize its results. This
2156 happens for example on SPARC 64-bit where the natural size of
2157 floating-point registers is still 32-bit.
2158 @end defmac
2159
2160 @defmac HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2161 A C expression that is nonzero if it is permissible to store a value
2162 of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} (or in several
2163 registers starting with that one). For a machine where all registers
2164 are equivalent, a suitable definition is
2165
2166 @smallexample
2167 #define HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK(REGNO, MODE) 1
2168 @end smallexample
2169
2170 You need not include code to check for the numbers of fixed registers,
2171 because the allocation mechanism considers them to be always occupied.
2172
2173 @cindex register pairs
2174 On some machines, double-precision values must be kept in even/odd
2175 register pairs. You can implement that by defining this macro to reject
2176 odd register numbers for such modes.
2177
2178 The minimum requirement for a mode to be OK in a register is that the
2179 @samp{mov@var{mode}} instruction pattern support moves between the
2180 register and other hard register in the same class and that moving a
2181 value into the register and back out not alter it.
2182
2183 Since the same instruction used to move @code{word_mode} will work for
2184 all narrower integer modes, it is not necessary on any machine for
2185 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} to distinguish between these modes, provided
2186 you define patterns @samp{movhi}, etc., to take advantage of this. This
2187 is useful because of the interaction between @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}
2188 and @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P}; it is very desirable for all integer modes
2189 to be tieable.
2190
2191 Many machines have special registers for floating point arithmetic.
2192 Often people assume that floating point machine modes are allowed only
2193 in floating point registers. This is not true. Any registers that
2194 can hold integers can safely @emph{hold} a floating point machine
2195 mode, whether or not floating arithmetic can be done on it in those
2196 registers. Integer move instructions can be used to move the values.
2197
2198 On some machines, though, the converse is true: fixed-point machine
2199 modes may not go in floating registers. This is true if the floating
2200 registers normalize any value stored in them, because storing a
2201 non-floating value there would garble it. In this case,
2202 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} should reject fixed-point machine modes in
2203 floating registers. But if the floating registers do not automatically
2204 normalize, if you can store any bit pattern in one and retrieve it
2205 unchanged without a trap, then any machine mode may go in a floating
2206 register, so you can define this macro to say so.
2207
2208 The primary significance of special floating registers is rather that
2209 they are the registers acceptable in floating point arithmetic
2210 instructions. However, this is of no concern to
2211 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}. You handle it by writing the proper
2212 constraints for those instructions.
2213
2214 On some machines, the floating registers are especially slow to access,
2215 so that it is better to store a value in a stack frame than in such a
2216 register if floating point arithmetic is not being done. As long as the
2217 floating registers are not in class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, they will not
2218 be used unless some pattern's constraint asks for one.
2219 @end defmac
2220
2221 @defmac HARD_REGNO_RENAME_OK (@var{from}, @var{to})
2222 A C expression that is nonzero if it is OK to rename a hard register
2223 @var{from} to another hard register @var{to}.
2224
2225 One common use of this macro is to prevent renaming of a register to
2226 another register that is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt
2227 handler.
2228
2229 The default is always nonzero.
2230 @end defmac
2231
2232 @defmac MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})
2233 A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode
2234 @var{mode1} is accessible in mode @var{mode2} without copying.
2235
2236 If @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode1})} and
2237 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode2})} are always the same for
2238 any @var{r}, then @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})}
2239 should be nonzero. If they differ for any @var{r}, you should define
2240 this macro to return zero unless some other mechanism ensures the
2241 accessibility of the value in a narrower mode.
2242
2243 You should define this macro to return nonzero in as many cases as
2244 possible since doing so will allow GCC to perform better register
2245 allocation.
2246 @end defmac
2247
2248 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HARD_REGNO_SCRATCH_OK (unsigned int @var{regno})
2249 This target hook should return @code{true} if it is OK to use a hard register
2250 @var{regno} as scratch reg in peephole2.
2251
2252 One common use of this macro is to prevent using of a register that
2253 is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt handler.
2254
2255 The default version of this hook always returns @code{true}.
2256 @end deftypefn
2257
2258 @defmac AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
2259 Define this macro if the compiler should avoid copies to/from @code{CCmode}
2260 registers. You should only define this macro if support for copying to/from
2261 @code{CCmode} is incomplete.
2262 @end defmac
2263
2264 @node Leaf Functions
2265 @subsection Handling Leaf Functions
2266
2267 @cindex leaf functions
2268 @cindex functions, leaf
2269 On some machines, a leaf function (i.e., one which makes no calls) can run
2270 more efficiently if it does not make its own register window. Often this
2271 means it is required to receive its arguments in the registers where they
2272 are passed by the caller, instead of the registers where they would
2273 normally arrive.
2274
2275 The special treatment for leaf functions generally applies only when
2276 other conditions are met; for example, often they may use only those
2277 registers for its own variables and temporaries. We use the term ``leaf
2278 function'' to mean a function that is suitable for this special
2279 handling, so that functions with no calls are not necessarily ``leaf
2280 functions''.
2281
2282 GCC assigns register numbers before it knows whether the function is
2283 suitable for leaf function treatment. So it needs to renumber the
2284 registers in order to output a leaf function. The following macros
2285 accomplish this.
2286
2287 @defmac LEAF_REGISTERS
2288 Name of a char vector, indexed by hard register number, which
2289 contains 1 for a register that is allowable in a candidate for leaf
2290 function treatment.
2291
2292 If leaf function treatment involves renumbering the registers, then the
2293 registers marked here should be the ones before renumbering---those that
2294 GCC would ordinarily allocate. The registers which will actually be
2295 used in the assembler code, after renumbering, should not be marked with 1
2296 in this vector.
2297
2298 Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize
2299 the treatment of leaf functions.
2300 @end defmac
2301
2302 @defmac LEAF_REG_REMAP (@var{regno})
2303 A C expression whose value is the register number to which @var{regno}
2304 should be renumbered, when a function is treated as a leaf function.
2305
2306 If @var{regno} is a register number which should not appear in a leaf
2307 function before renumbering, then the expression should yield @minus{}1, which
2308 will cause the compiler to abort.
2309
2310 Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize the
2311 treatment of leaf functions, and registers need to be renumbered to do
2312 this.
2313 @end defmac
2314
2315 @findex current_function_is_leaf
2316 @findex current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs
2317 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
2318 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must usually treat leaf functions
2319 specially. They can test the C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf}
2320 which is nonzero for leaf functions. @code{current_function_is_leaf} is
2321 set prior to local register allocation and is valid for the remaining
2322 compiler passes. They can also test the C variable
2323 @code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} which is nonzero for leaf
2324 functions which only use leaf registers.
2325 @code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} is valid after all passes
2326 that modify the instructions have been run and is only useful if
2327 @code{LEAF_REGISTERS} is defined.
2328 @c changed this to fix overfull. ALSO: why the "it" at the beginning
2329 @c of the next paragraph?! --mew 2feb93
2330
2331 @node Stack Registers
2332 @subsection Registers That Form a Stack
2333
2334 There are special features to handle computers where some of the
2335 ``registers'' form a stack. Stack registers are normally written by
2336 pushing onto the stack, and are numbered relative to the top of the
2337 stack.
2338
2339 Currently, GCC can only handle one group of stack-like registers, and
2340 they must be consecutively numbered. Furthermore, the existing
2341 support for stack-like registers is specific to the 80387 floating
2342 point coprocessor. If you have a new architecture that uses
2343 stack-like registers, you will need to do substantial work on
2344 @file{reg-stack.c} and write your machine description to cooperate
2345 with it, as well as defining these macros.
2346
2347 @defmac STACK_REGS
2348 Define this if the machine has any stack-like registers.
2349 @end defmac
2350
2351 @defmac STACK_REG_COVER_CLASS
2352 This is a cover class containing the stack registers. Define this if
2353 the machine has any stack-like registers.
2354 @end defmac
2355
2356 @defmac FIRST_STACK_REG
2357 The number of the first stack-like register. This one is the top
2358 of the stack.
2359 @end defmac
2360
2361 @defmac LAST_STACK_REG
2362 The number of the last stack-like register. This one is the bottom of
2363 the stack.
2364 @end defmac
2365
2366 @node Register Classes
2367 @section Register Classes
2368 @cindex register class definitions
2369 @cindex class definitions, register
2370
2371 On many machines, the numbered registers are not all equivalent.
2372 For example, certain registers may not be allowed for indexed addressing;
2373 certain registers may not be allowed in some instructions. These machine
2374 restrictions are described to the compiler using @dfn{register classes}.
2375
2376 You define a number of register classes, giving each one a name and saying
2377 which of the registers belong to it. Then you can specify register classes
2378 that are allowed as operands to particular instruction patterns.
2379
2380 @findex ALL_REGS
2381 @findex NO_REGS
2382 In general, each register will belong to several classes. In fact, one
2383 class must be named @code{ALL_REGS} and contain all the registers. Another
2384 class must be named @code{NO_REGS} and contain no registers. Often the
2385 union of two classes will be another class; however, this is not required.
2386
2387 @findex GENERAL_REGS
2388 One of the classes must be named @code{GENERAL_REGS}. There is nothing
2389 terribly special about the name, but the operand constraint letters
2390 @samp{r} and @samp{g} specify this class. If @code{GENERAL_REGS} is
2391 the same as @code{ALL_REGS}, just define it as a macro which expands
2392 to @code{ALL_REGS}.
2393
2394 Order the classes so that if class @var{x} is contained in class @var{y}
2395 then @var{x} has a lower class number than @var{y}.
2396
2397 The way classes other than @code{GENERAL_REGS} are specified in operand
2398 constraints is through machine-dependent operand constraint letters.
2399 You can define such letters to correspond to various classes, then use
2400 them in operand constraints.
2401
2402 You should define a class for the union of two classes whenever some
2403 instruction allows both classes. For example, if an instruction allows
2404 either a floating point (coprocessor) register or a general register for a
2405 certain operand, you should define a class @code{FLOAT_OR_GENERAL_REGS}
2406 which includes both of them. Otherwise you will get suboptimal code.
2407
2408 You must also specify certain redundant information about the register
2409 classes: for each class, which classes contain it and which ones are
2410 contained in it; for each pair of classes, the largest class contained
2411 in their union.
2412
2413 When a value occupying several consecutive registers is expected in a
2414 certain class, all the registers used must belong to that class.
2415 Therefore, register classes cannot be used to enforce a requirement for
2416 a register pair to start with an even-numbered register. The way to
2417 specify this requirement is with @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}.
2418
2419 Register classes used for input-operands of bitwise-and or shift
2420 instructions have a special requirement: each such class must have, for
2421 each fixed-point machine mode, a subclass whose registers can transfer that
2422 mode to or from memory. For example, on some machines, the operations for
2423 single-byte values (@code{QImode}) are limited to certain registers. When
2424 this is so, each register class that is used in a bitwise-and or shift
2425 instruction must have a subclass consisting of registers from which
2426 single-byte values can be loaded or stored. This is so that
2427 @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} can always have a possible value to return.
2428
2429 @deftp {Data type} {enum reg_class}
2430 An enumerated type that must be defined with all the register class names
2431 as enumerated values. @code{NO_REGS} must be first. @code{ALL_REGS}
2432 must be the last register class, followed by one more enumerated value,
2433 @code{LIM_REG_CLASSES}, which is not a register class but rather
2434 tells how many classes there are.
2435
2436 Each register class has a number, which is the value of casting
2437 the class name to type @code{int}. The number serves as an index
2438 in many of the tables described below.
2439 @end deftp
2440
2441 @defmac N_REG_CLASSES
2442 The number of distinct register classes, defined as follows:
2443
2444 @smallexample
2445 #define N_REG_CLASSES (int) LIM_REG_CLASSES
2446 @end smallexample
2447 @end defmac
2448
2449 @defmac REG_CLASS_NAMES
2450 An initializer containing the names of the register classes as C string
2451 constants. These names are used in writing some of the debugging dumps.
2452 @end defmac
2453
2454 @defmac REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
2455 An initializer containing the contents of the register classes, as integers
2456 which are bit masks. The @var{n}th integer specifies the contents of class
2457 @var{n}. The way the integer @var{mask} is interpreted is that
2458 register @var{r} is in the class if @code{@var{mask} & (1 << @var{r})} is 1.
2459
2460 When the machine has more than 32 registers, an integer does not suffice.
2461 Then the integers are replaced by sub-initializers, braced groupings containing
2462 several integers. Each sub-initializer must be suitable as an initializer
2463 for the type @code{HARD_REG_SET} which is defined in @file{hard-reg-set.h}.
2464 In this situation, the first integer in each sub-initializer corresponds to
2465 registers 0 through 31, the second integer to registers 32 through 63, and
2466 so on.
2467 @end defmac
2468
2469 @defmac REGNO_REG_CLASS (@var{regno})
2470 A C expression whose value is a register class containing hard register
2471 @var{regno}. In general there is more than one such class; choose a class
2472 which is @dfn{minimal}, meaning that no smaller class also contains the
2473 register.
2474 @end defmac
2475
2476 @defmac BASE_REG_CLASS
2477 A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2478 base register must belong. A base register is one used in an address
2479 which is the register value plus a displacement.
2480 @end defmac
2481
2482 @defmac MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2483 This is a variation of the @code{BASE_REG_CLASS} macro which allows
2484 the selection of a base register in a mode dependent manner. If
2485 @var{mode} is VOIDmode then it should return the same value as
2486 @code{BASE_REG_CLASS}.
2487 @end defmac
2488
2489 @defmac MODE_BASE_REG_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2490 A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2491 base register must belong in order to be used in a base plus index
2492 register address. You should define this macro if base plus index
2493 addresses have different requirements than other base register uses.
2494 @end defmac
2495
2496 @defmac MODE_CODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2497 A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2498 base register must belong. @var{outer_code} and @var{index_code} define the
2499 context in which the base register occurs. @var{outer_code} is the code of
2500 the immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} for the top level of an
2501 address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2502 @code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the corresponding
2503 index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS}; @code{SCRATCH} otherwise.
2504 @end defmac
2505
2506 @defmac INDEX_REG_CLASS
2507 A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2508 index register must belong. An index register is one used in an
2509 address where its value is either multiplied by a scale factor or
2510 added to another register (as well as added to a displacement).
2511 @end defmac
2512
2513 @defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num})
2514 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2515 suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses.
2516 Like @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P}, this macro should also
2517 define a strict and a non-strict variant. Both variants behave
2518 the same for hard register; for pseudos, the strict variant will
2519 pass only those that have been allocated to a valid hard registers,
2520 while the non-strict variant will pass all pseudos.
2521
2522 @findex REG_OK_STRICT
2523 Compiler source files that want to use the strict variant of this and
2524 other macros define the macro @code{REG_OK_STRICT}. You should use an
2525 @code{#ifdef REG_OK_STRICT} conditional to define the strict variant in
2526 that case and the non-strict variant otherwise.
2527 @end defmac
2528
2529 @defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2530 A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
2531 that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
2532 @var{mode}. You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
2533 reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register. If
2534 you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
2535 @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for
2536 addresses that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an
2537 @code{address_operand}.
2538
2539 This macro also has strict and non-strict variants.
2540 @end defmac
2541
2542 @defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_REG_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2543 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is suitable for
2544 use as a base register in base plus index operand addresses, accessing
2545 memory in mode @var{mode}. It may be either a suitable hard register or a
2546 pseudo register that has been allocated such a hard register. You should
2547 define this macro if base plus index addresses have different requirements
2548 than other base register uses.
2549
2550 Use of this macro is deprecated; please use the more general
2551 @code{REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
2552
2553 This macro also has strict and non-strict variants.
2554 @end defmac
2555
2556 @defmac REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2557 A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except
2558 that that expression may examine the context in which the register
2559 appears in the memory reference. @var{outer_code} is the code of the
2560 immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} if at the top level of the
2561 address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2562 @code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the
2563 corresponding index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS};
2564 @code{SCRATCH} otherwise. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for addresses
2565 that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an @code{address_operand}.
2566
2567 This macro also has strict and non-strict variants.
2568 @end defmac
2569
2570 @defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{num})
2571 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2572 suitable for use as an index register in operand addresses. It may be
2573 either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
2574 allocated such a hard register.
2575
2576 The difference between an index register and a base register is that
2577 the index register may be scaled. If an address involves the sum of
2578 two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
2579 labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
2580 labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
2581 may serve in each capacity. The compiler will try both labelings,
2582 looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
2583 only if neither labeling works.
2584
2585 This macro also has strict and non-strict variants.
2586 @end defmac
2587
2588 @defmac PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2589 A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2590 to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2591 @var{class}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps
2592 another, smaller class. On many machines, the following definition is
2593 safe:
2594
2595 @smallexample
2596 #define PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS(X,CLASS) CLASS
2597 @end smallexample
2598
2599 Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2600 example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2601 for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2602 @code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{class} includes the data registers.
2603 Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2604
2605 One case where @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2606 @var{class} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2607 loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2608 force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2609 immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2610 instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2611 register, so @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2612 @var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2613 into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2614 @code{LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2615 of using @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2616
2617 If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2618 through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2619 to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2620 reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2621 this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2622 the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2623 @end defmac
2624
2625 @defmac PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2626 Like @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2627 input reloads. If you don't define this macro, the default is to use
2628 @var{class}, unchanged.
2629
2630 You can also use @code{PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to discourage
2631 reload from using some alternatives, like @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2632 @end defmac
2633
2634 @defmac LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{class})
2635 A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2636 to use when it is necessary to be able to hold a value of mode
2637 @var{mode} in a reload register for which class @var{class} would
2638 ordinarily be used.
2639
2640 Unlike @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, this macro should be used when
2641 there are certain modes that simply can't go in certain reload classes.
2642
2643 The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps another,
2644 smaller class.
2645
2646 Don't define this macro unless the target machine has limitations which
2647 require the macro to do something nontrivial.
2648 @end defmac
2649
2650 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD (bool @var{in_p}, rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{reload_class}, enum machine_mode @var{reload_mode}, secondary_reload_info *@var{sri})
2651 Many machines have some registers that cannot be copied directly to or
2652 from memory or even from other types of registers. An example is the
2653 @samp{MQ} register, which on most machines, can only be copied to or
2654 from general registers, but not memory. Below, we shall be using the
2655 term 'intermediate register' when a move operation cannot be performed
2656 directly, but has to be done by copying the source into the intermediate
2657 register first, and then copying the intermediate register to the
2658 destination. An intermediate register always has the same mode as
2659 source and destination. Since it holds the actual value being copied,
2660 reload might apply optimizations to re-use an intermediate register
2661 and eliding the copy from the source when it can determine that the
2662 intermediate register still holds the required value.
2663
2664 Another kind of secondary reload is required on some machines which
2665 allow copying all registers to and from memory, but require a scratch
2666 register for stores to some memory locations (e.g., those with symbolic
2667 address on the RT, and those with certain symbolic address on the SPARC
2668 when compiling PIC)@. Scratch registers need not have the same mode
2669 as the value being copied, and usually hold a different value than
2670 that being copied. Special patterns in the md file are needed to
2671 describe how the copy is performed with the help of the scratch register;
2672 these patterns also describe the number, register class(es) and mode(s)
2673 of the scratch register(s).
2674
2675 In some cases, both an intermediate and a scratch register are required.
2676
2677 For input reloads, this target hook is called with nonzero @var{in_p},
2678 and @var{x} is an rtx that needs to be copied to a register of class
2679 @var{reload_class} in @var{reload_mode}. For output reloads, this target
2680 hook is called with zero @var{in_p}, and a register of class @var{reload_class}
2681 needs to be copied to rtx @var{x} in @var{reload_mode}.
2682
2683 If copying a register of @var{reload_class} from/to @var{x} requires
2684 an intermediate register, the hook @code{secondary_reload} should
2685 return the register class required for this intermediate register.
2686 If no intermediate register is required, it should return NO_REGS.
2687 If more than one intermediate register is required, describe the one
2688 that is closest in the copy chain to the reload register.
2689
2690 If scratch registers are needed, you also have to describe how to
2691 perform the copy from/to the reload register to/from this
2692 closest intermediate register. Or if no intermediate register is
2693 required, but still a scratch register is needed, describe the
2694 copy from/to the reload register to/from the reload operand @var{x}.
2695
2696 You do this by setting @code{sri->icode} to the instruction code of a pattern
2697 in the md file which performs the move. Operands 0 and 1 are the output
2698 and input of this copy, respectively. Operands from operand 2 onward are
2699 for scratch operands. These scratch operands must have a mode, and a
2700 single-register-class
2701 @c [later: or memory]
2702 output constraint.
2703
2704 When an intermediate register is used, the @code{secondary_reload}
2705 hook will be called again to determine how to copy the intermediate
2706 register to/from the reload operand @var{x}, so your hook must also
2707 have code to handle the register class of the intermediate operand.
2708
2709 @c [For later: maybe we'll allow multi-alternative reload patterns -
2710 @c the port maintainer could name a mov<mode> pattern that has clobbers -
2711 @c and match the constraints of input and output to determine the required
2712 @c alternative. A restriction would be that constraints used to match
2713 @c against reloads registers would have to be written as register class
2714 @c constraints, or we need a new target macro / hook that tells us if an
2715 @c arbitrary constraint can match an unknown register of a given class.
2716 @c Such a macro / hook would also be useful in other places.]
2717
2718
2719 @var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2720 pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2721 Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2722 in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2723
2724 Scratch operands in memory (constraint @code{"=m"} / @code{"=&m"}) are
2725 currently not supported. For the time being, you will have to continue
2726 to use @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} for that purpose.
2727
2728 @code{copy_cost} also uses this target hook to find out how values are
2729 copied. If you want it to include some extra cost for the need to allocate
2730 (a) scratch register(s), set @code{sri->extra_cost} to the additional cost.
2731 Or if two dependent moves are supposed to have a lower cost than the sum
2732 of the individual moves due to expected fortuitous scheduling and/or special
2733 forwarding logic, you can set @code{sri->extra_cost} to a negative amount.
2734 @end deftypefn
2735
2736 @defmac SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2737 @defmacx SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2738 @defmacx SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2739 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
2740 @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD} instead.
2741
2742 These are obsolete macros, replaced by the @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD}
2743 target hook. Older ports still define these macros to indicate to the
2744 reload phase that it may
2745 need to allocate at least one register for a reload in addition to the
2746 register to contain the data. Specifically, if copying @var{x} to a
2747 register @var{class} in @var{mode} requires an intermediate register,
2748 you were supposed to define @code{SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to return the
2749 largest register class all of whose registers can be used as
2750 intermediate registers or scratch registers.
2751
2752 If copying a register @var{class} in @var{mode} to @var{x} requires an
2753 intermediate or scratch register, @code{SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS}
2754 was supposed to be defined be defined to return the largest register
2755 class required. If the
2756 requirements for input and output reloads were the same, the macro
2757 @code{SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS} should have been used instead of defining both
2758 macros identically.
2759
2760 The values returned by these macros are often @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
2761 Return @code{NO_REGS} if no spare register is needed; i.e., if @var{x}
2762 can be directly copied to or from a register of @var{class} in
2763 @var{mode} without requiring a scratch register. Do not define this
2764 macro if it would always return @code{NO_REGS}.
2765
2766 If a scratch register is required (either with or without an
2767 intermediate register), you were supposed to define patterns for
2768 @samp{reload_in@var{m}} or @samp{reload_out@var{m}}, as required
2769 (@pxref{Standard Names}. These patterns, which were normally
2770 implemented with a @code{define_expand}, should be similar to the
2771 @samp{mov@var{m}} patterns, except that operand 2 is the scratch
2772 register.
2773
2774 These patterns need constraints for the reload register and scratch
2775 register that
2776 contain a single register class. If the original reload register (whose
2777 class is @var{class}) can meet the constraint given in the pattern, the
2778 value returned by these macros is used for the class of the scratch
2779 register. Otherwise, two additional reload registers are required.
2780 Their classes are obtained from the constraints in the insn pattern.
2781
2782 @var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2783 pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2784 Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2785 in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2786
2787 These macros should not be used in the case where a particular class of
2788 registers can only be copied to memory and not to another class of
2789 registers. In that case, secondary reload registers are not needed and
2790 would not be helpful. Instead, a stack location must be used to perform
2791 the copy and the @code{mov@var{m}} pattern should use memory as an
2792 intermediate storage. This case often occurs between floating-point and
2793 general registers.
2794 @end defmac
2795
2796 @defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (@var{class1}, @var{class2}, @var{m})
2797 Certain machines have the property that some registers cannot be copied
2798 to some other registers without using memory. Define this macro on
2799 those machines to be a C expression that is nonzero if objects of mode
2800 @var{m} in registers of @var{class1} can only be copied to registers of
2801 class @var{class2} by storing a register of @var{class1} into memory
2802 and loading that memory location into a register of @var{class2}.
2803
2804 Do not define this macro if its value would always be zero.
2805 @end defmac
2806
2807 @defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX (@var{mode})
2808 Normally when @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} is defined, the compiler
2809 allocates a stack slot for a memory location needed for register copies.
2810 If this macro is defined, the compiler instead uses the memory location
2811 defined by this macro.
2812
2813 Do not define this macro if you do not define
2814 @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED}.
2815 @end defmac
2816
2817 @defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE (@var{mode})
2818 When the compiler needs a secondary memory location to copy between two
2819 registers of mode @var{mode}, it normally allocates sufficient memory to
2820 hold a quantity of @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits and performs the store and
2821 load operations in a mode that many bits wide and whose class is the
2822 same as that of @var{mode}.
2823
2824 This is right thing to do on most machines because it ensures that all
2825 bits of the register are copied and prevents accesses to the registers
2826 in a narrower mode, which some machines prohibit for floating-point
2827 registers.
2828
2829 However, this default behavior is not correct on some machines, such as
2830 the DEC Alpha, that store short integers in floating-point registers
2831 differently than in integer registers. On those machines, the default
2832 widening will not work correctly and you must define this macro to
2833 suppress that widening in some cases. See the file @file{alpha.h} for
2834 details.
2835
2836 Do not define this macro if you do not define
2837 @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} or if widening @var{mode} to a mode that
2838 is @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits wide is correct for your machine.
2839 @end defmac
2840
2841 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P (reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2842 A target hook which returns @code{true} if pseudos that have been assigned
2843 to registers of class @var{rclass} would likely be spilled because
2844 registers of @var{rclass} are needed for spill registers.
2845
2846 The default version of this target hook returns @code{true} if @var{rclass}
2847 has exactly one register and @code{false} otherwise. On most machines, this
2848 default should be used. Only use this target hook to some other expression
2849 if pseudos allocated by @file{local-alloc.c} end up in memory because their
2850 hard registers were needed for spill registers. If this target hook returns
2851 @code{false} for those classes, those pseudos will only be allocated by
2852 @file{global.c}, which knows how to reallocate the pseudo to another
2853 register. If there would not be another register available for reallocation,
2854 you should not change the implementation of this target hook since
2855 the only effect of such implementation would be to slow down register
2856 allocation.
2857 @end deftypefn
2858
2859 @defmac CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})
2860 A C expression for the maximum number of consecutive registers
2861 of class @var{class} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2862
2863 This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
2864 the value of the macro @code{CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})}
2865 should be the maximum value of @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno},
2866 @var{mode})} for all @var{regno} values in the class @var{class}.
2867
2868 This macro helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2869 in the reload pass.
2870 @end defmac
2871
2872 @defmac CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS (@var{from}, @var{to}, @var{class})
2873 If defined, a C expression that returns nonzero for a @var{class} for which
2874 a change from mode @var{from} to mode @var{to} is invalid.
2875
2876 For the example, loading 32-bit integer or floating-point objects into
2877 floating-point registers on the Alpha extends them to 64 bits.
2878 Therefore loading a 64-bit object and then storing it as a 32-bit object
2879 does not store the low-order 32 bits, as would be the case for a normal
2880 register. Therefore, @file{alpha.h} defines @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS}
2881 as below:
2882
2883 @smallexample
2884 #define CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS(FROM, TO, CLASS) \
2885 (GET_MODE_SIZE (FROM) != GET_MODE_SIZE (TO) \
2886 ? reg_classes_intersect_p (FLOAT_REGS, (CLASS)) : 0)
2887 @end smallexample
2888 @end defmac
2889
2890 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const reg_class_t *} TARGET_IRA_COVER_CLASSES (void)
2891 Return an array of cover classes for the Integrated Register Allocator
2892 (@acronym{IRA}). Cover classes are a set of non-intersecting register
2893 classes covering all hard registers used for register allocation
2894 purposes. If a move between two registers in the same cover class is
2895 possible, it should be cheaper than a load or store of the registers.
2896 The array is terminated by a @code{LIM_REG_CLASSES} element.
2897
2898 The order of cover classes in the array is important. If two classes
2899 have the same cost of usage for a pseudo, the class occurred first in
2900 the array is chosen for the pseudo.
2901
2902 This hook is called once at compiler startup, after the command-line
2903 options have been processed. It is then re-examined by every call to
2904 @code{target_reinit}.
2905
2906 The default implementation returns @code{IRA_COVER_CLASSES}, if defined,
2907 otherwise there is no default implementation. You must define either this
2908 macro or @code{IRA_COVER_CLASSES} in order to use the integrated register
2909 allocator with Chaitin-Briggs coloring. If the macro is not defined,
2910 the only available coloring algorithm is Chow's priority coloring.
2911 @end deftypefn
2912
2913 @defmac IRA_COVER_CLASSES
2914 See the documentation for @code{TARGET_IRA_COVER_CLASSES}.
2915 @end defmac
2916
2917 @node Old Constraints
2918 @section Obsolete Macros for Defining Constraints
2919 @cindex defining constraints, obsolete method
2920 @cindex constraints, defining, obsolete method
2921
2922 Machine-specific constraints can be defined with these macros instead
2923 of the machine description constructs described in @ref{Define
2924 Constraints}. This mechanism is obsolete. New ports should not use
2925 it; old ports should convert to the new mechanism.
2926
2927 @defmac CONSTRAINT_LEN (@var{char}, @var{str})
2928 For the constraint at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter
2929 @var{c}, return the length. This allows you to have register class /
2930 constant / extra constraints that are longer than a single letter;
2931 you don't need to define this macro if you can do with single-letter
2932 constraints only. The definition of this macro should use
2933 DEFAULT_CONSTRAINT_LEN for all the characters that you don't want
2934 to handle specially.
2935 There are some sanity checks in genoutput.c that check the constraint lengths
2936 for the md file, so you can also use this macro to help you while you are
2937 transitioning from a byzantine single-letter-constraint scheme: when you
2938 return a negative length for a constraint you want to re-use, genoutput
2939 will complain about every instance where it is used in the md file.
2940 @end defmac
2941
2942 @defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER (@var{char})
2943 A C expression which defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2944 letters for register classes. If @var{char} is such a letter, the
2945 value should be the register class corresponding to it. Otherwise,
2946 the value should be @code{NO_REGS}. The register letter @samp{r},
2947 corresponding to class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, will not be passed
2948 to this macro; you do not need to handle it.
2949 @end defmac
2950
2951 @defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT (@var{char}, @var{str})
2952 Like @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER}, but you also get the constraint string
2953 passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between
2954 different variants.
2955 @end defmac
2956
2957 @defmac CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2958 A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2959 letters (@samp{I}, @samp{J}, @samp{K}, @dots{} @samp{P}) that specify
2960 particular ranges of integer values. If @var{c} is one of those
2961 letters, the expression should check that @var{value}, an integer, is in
2962 the appropriate range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is
2963 not one of those letters, the value should be 0 regardless of
2964 @var{value}.
2965 @end defmac
2966
2967 @defmac CONST_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2968 Like @code{CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
2969 string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
2970 between different variants.
2971 @end defmac
2972
2973 @defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2974 A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2975 letters that specify particular ranges of @code{const_double} values
2976 (@samp{G} or @samp{H}).
2977
2978 If @var{c} is one of those letters, the expression should check that
2979 @var{value}, an RTX of code @code{const_double}, is in the appropriate
2980 range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is not one of those
2981 letters, the value should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2982
2983 @code{const_double} is used for all floating-point constants and for
2984 @code{DImode} fixed-point constants. A given letter can accept either
2985 or both kinds of values. It can use @code{GET_MODE} to distinguish
2986 between these kinds.
2987 @end defmac
2988
2989 @defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2990 Like @code{CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
2991 string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
2992 between different variants.
2993 @end defmac
2994
2995 @defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT (@var{value}, @var{c})
2996 A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2997 letters that can be used to segregate specific types of operands, usually
2998 memory references, for the target machine. Any letter that is not
2999 elsewhere defined and not matched by @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} /
3000 @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
3001 may be used. Normally this macro will not be defined.
3002
3003 If it is required for a particular target machine, it should return 1
3004 if @var{value} corresponds to the operand type represented by the
3005 constraint letter @var{c}. If @var{c} is not defined as an extra
3006 constraint, the value returned should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
3007
3008 For example, on the ROMP, load instructions cannot have their output
3009 in r0 if the memory reference contains a symbolic address. Constraint
3010 letter @samp{Q} is defined as representing a memory address that does
3011 @emph{not} contain a symbolic address. An alternative is specified with
3012 a @samp{Q} constraint on the input and @samp{r} on the output. The next
3013 alternative specifies @samp{m} on the input and a register class that
3014 does not include r0 on the output.
3015 @end defmac
3016
3017 @defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
3018 Like @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, but you also get the constraint string passed
3019 in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between different
3020 variants.
3021 @end defmac
3022
3023 @defmac EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
3024 A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
3025 letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, that should
3026 be treated like memory constraints by the reload pass.
3027
3028 It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
3029 at the start of @var{str}, the first letter of which is the letter @var{c},
3030 comprises a subset of all memory references including
3031 all those whose address is simply a base register. This allows the reload
3032 pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
3033 type of @var{c}, by copying its address into a base register.
3034
3035 For example, on the S/390, some instructions do not accept arbitrary
3036 memory references, but only those that do not make use of an index
3037 register. The constraint letter @samp{Q} is defined via
3038 @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} as representing a memory address of this type.
3039 If the letter @samp{Q} is marked as @code{EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT},
3040 a @samp{Q} constraint can handle any memory operand, because the
3041 reload pass knows it can be reloaded by copying the memory address
3042 into a base register if required. This is analogous to the way
3043 an @samp{o} constraint can handle any memory operand.
3044 @end defmac
3045
3046 @defmac EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
3047 A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
3048 letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} /
3049 @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR}, that should
3050 be treated like address constraints by the reload pass.
3051
3052 It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
3053 at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter @var{c}, comprises
3054 a subset of all memory addresses including
3055 all those that consist of just a base register. This allows the reload
3056 pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
3057 type of @var{str}, by copying it into a base register.
3058
3059 Any constraint marked as @code{EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT} can only
3060 be used with the @code{address_operand} predicate. It is treated
3061 analogously to the @samp{p} constraint.
3062 @end defmac
3063
3064 @node Stack and Calling
3065 @section Stack Layout and Calling Conventions
3066 @cindex calling conventions
3067
3068 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3069 This describes the stack layout and calling conventions.
3070
3071 @menu
3072 * Frame Layout::
3073 * Exception Handling::
3074 * Stack Checking::
3075 * Frame Registers::
3076 * Elimination::
3077 * Stack Arguments::
3078 * Register Arguments::
3079 * Scalar Return::
3080 * Aggregate Return::
3081 * Caller Saves::
3082 * Function Entry::
3083 * Profiling::
3084 * Tail Calls::
3085 * Stack Smashing Protection::
3086 @end menu
3087
3088 @node Frame Layout
3089 @subsection Basic Stack Layout
3090 @cindex stack frame layout
3091 @cindex frame layout
3092
3093 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3094 Here is the basic stack layout.
3095
3096 @defmac STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3097 Define this macro if pushing a word onto the stack moves the stack
3098 pointer to a smaller address.
3099
3100 When we say, ``define this macro if @dots{}'', it means that the
3101 compiler checks this macro only with @code{#ifdef} so the precise
3102 definition used does not matter.
3103 @end defmac
3104
3105 @defmac STACK_PUSH_CODE
3106 This macro defines the operation used when something is pushed
3107 on the stack. In RTL, a push operation will be
3108 @code{(set (mem (STACK_PUSH_CODE (reg sp))) @dots{})}
3109
3110 The choices are @code{PRE_DEC}, @code{POST_DEC}, @code{PRE_INC},
3111 and @code{POST_INC}. Which of these is correct depends on
3112 the stack direction and on whether the stack pointer points
3113 to the last item on the stack or whether it points to the
3114 space for the next item on the stack.
3115
3116 The default is @code{PRE_DEC} when @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is
3117 defined, which is almost always right, and @code{PRE_INC} otherwise,
3118 which is often wrong.
3119 @end defmac
3120
3121 @defmac FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3122 Define this macro to nonzero value if the addresses of local variable slots
3123 are at negative offsets from the frame pointer.
3124 @end defmac
3125
3126 @defmac ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
3127 Define this macro if successive arguments to a function occupy decreasing
3128 addresses on the stack.
3129 @end defmac
3130
3131 @defmac STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET
3132 Offset from the frame pointer to the first local variable slot to be allocated.
3133
3134 If @code{FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD}, find the next slot's offset by
3135 subtracting the first slot's length from @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
3136 Otherwise, it is found by adding the length of the first slot to the
3137 value @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
3138 @c i'm not sure if the above is still correct.. had to change it to get
3139 @c rid of an overfull. --mew 2feb93
3140 @end defmac
3141
3142 @defmac STACK_ALIGNMENT_NEEDED
3143 Define to zero to disable final alignment of the stack during reload.
3144 The nonzero default for this macro is suitable for most ports.
3145
3146 On ports where @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET} is nonzero or where there
3147 is a register save block following the local block that doesn't require
3148 alignment to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, it may be beneficial to disable
3149 stack alignment and do it in the backend.
3150 @end defmac
3151
3152 @defmac STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
3153 Offset from the stack pointer register to the first location at which
3154 outgoing arguments are placed. If not specified, the default value of
3155 zero is used. This is the proper value for most machines.
3156
3157 If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3158 the first location at which outgoing arguments are placed.
3159 @end defmac
3160
3161 @defmac FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3162 Offset from the argument pointer register to the first argument's
3163 address. On some machines it may depend on the data type of the
3164 function.
3165
3166 If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3167 the first argument's address.
3168 @end defmac
3169
3170 @defmac STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3171 Offset from the stack pointer register to an item dynamically allocated
3172 on the stack, e.g., by @code{alloca}.
3173
3174 The default value for this macro is @code{STACK_POINTER_OFFSET} plus the
3175 length of the outgoing arguments. The default is correct for most
3176 machines. See @file{function.c} for details.
3177 @end defmac
3178
3179 @defmac INITIAL_FRAME_ADDRESS_RTX
3180 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address of the initial
3181 stack frame. This address is passed to @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and
3182 @code{DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS}. If you don't define this macro, a reasonable
3183 default value will be used. Define this macro in order to make frame pointer
3184 elimination work in the presence of @code{__builtin_frame_address (count)} and
3185 @code{__builtin_return_address (count)} for @code{count} not equal to zero.
3186 @end defmac
3187
3188 @defmac DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS (@var{frameaddr})
3189 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address in a stack
3190 frame where the pointer to the caller's frame is stored. Assume that
3191 @var{frameaddr} is an RTL expression for the address of the stack frame
3192 itself.
3193
3194 If you don't define this macro, the default is to return the value
3195 of @var{frameaddr}---that is, the stack frame address is also the
3196 address of the stack word that points to the previous frame.
3197 @end defmac
3198
3199 @defmac SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
3200 If defined, a C expression that produces the machine-specific code to
3201 setup the stack so that arbitrary frames can be accessed. For example,
3202 on the SPARC, we must flush all of the register windows to the stack
3203 before we can access arbitrary stack frames. You will seldom need to
3204 define this macro.
3205 @end defmac
3206
3207 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE (void)
3208 This target hook should return an rtx that is used to store
3209 the address of the current frame into the built in @code{setjmp} buffer.
3210 The default value, @code{virtual_stack_vars_rtx}, is correct for most
3211 machines. One reason you may need to define this target hook is if
3212 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} is the appropriate value on your machine.
3213 @end deftypefn
3214
3215 @defmac FRAME_ADDR_RTX (@var{frameaddr})
3216 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the frame
3217 address for the current frame. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer
3218 of the current frame. This is used for __builtin_frame_address.
3219 You need only define this macro if the frame address is not the same
3220 as the frame pointer. Most machines do not need to define it.
3221 @end defmac
3222
3223 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_RTX (@var{count}, @var{frameaddr})
3224 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the return
3225 address for the frame @var{count} steps up from the current frame, after
3226 the prologue. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer of the @var{count}
3227 frame, or the frame pointer of the @var{count} @minus{} 1 frame if
3228 @code{RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME} is defined.
3229
3230 The value of the expression must always be the correct address when
3231 @var{count} is zero, but may be @code{NULL_RTX} if there is no way to
3232 determine the return address of other frames.
3233 @end defmac
3234
3235 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
3236 Define this if the return address of a particular stack frame is accessed
3237 from the frame pointer of the previous stack frame.
3238 @end defmac
3239
3240 @defmac INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
3241 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the location of the
3242 incoming return address at the beginning of any function, before the
3243 prologue. This RTL is either a @code{REG}, indicating that the return
3244 value is saved in @samp{REG}, or a @code{MEM} representing a location in
3245 the stack.
3246
3247 You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3248 debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3249
3250 If this RTL is a @code{REG}, you should also define
3251 @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO)}.
3252 @end defmac
3253
3254 @defmac DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
3255 A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 column
3256 number that may be used as an alternative return column. The column
3257 must not correspond to any gcc hard register (that is, it must not
3258 be in the range of @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM}).
3259
3260 This macro can be useful if @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} is set to a
3261 general register, but an alternative column needs to be used for signal
3262 frames. Some targets have also used different frame return columns
3263 over time.
3264 @end defmac
3265
3266 @defmac DWARF_ZERO_REG
3267 A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 register
3268 number that is considered to always have the value zero. This should
3269 only be defined if the target has an architected zero register, and
3270 someone decided it was a good idea to use that register number to
3271 terminate the stack backtrace. New ports should avoid this.
3272 @end defmac
3273
3274 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_DWARF_HANDLE_FRAME_UNSPEC (const char *@var{label}, rtx @var{pattern}, int @var{index})
3275 This target hook allows the backend to emit frame-related insns that
3276 contain UNSPECs or UNSPEC_VOLATILEs. The DWARF 2 call frame debugging
3277 info engine will invoke it on insns of the form
3278 @smallexample
3279 (set (reg) (unspec [@dots{}] UNSPEC_INDEX))
3280 @end smallexample
3281 and
3282 @smallexample
3283 (set (reg) (unspec_volatile [@dots{}] UNSPECV_INDEX)).
3284 @end smallexample
3285 to let the backend emit the call frame instructions. @var{label} is
3286 the CFI label attached to the insn, @var{pattern} is the pattern of
3287 the insn and @var{index} is @code{UNSPEC_INDEX} or @code{UNSPECV_INDEX}.
3288 @end deftypefn
3289
3290 @defmac INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
3291 A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3292 from the value of the stack pointer register to the top of the stack
3293 frame at the beginning of any function, before the prologue. The top of
3294 the frame is defined to be the value of the stack pointer in the
3295 previous frame, just before the call instruction.
3296
3297 You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3298 debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3299 @end defmac
3300
3301 @defmac ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3302 A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3303 from the argument pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa). The
3304 final value should coincide with that calculated by
3305 @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}. Which is unfortunately not usable
3306 during virtual register instantiation.
3307
3308 The default value for this macro is
3309 @code{FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (fundecl) + crtl->args.pretend_args_size},
3310 which is correct for most machines; in general, the arguments are found
3311 immediately before the stack frame. Note that this is not the case on
3312 some targets that save registers into the caller's frame, such as SPARC
3313 and rs6000, and so such targets need to define this macro.
3314
3315 You only need to define this macro if the default is incorrect, and you
3316 want to support call frame debugging information like that provided by
3317 DWARF 2.
3318 @end defmac
3319
3320 @defmac FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3321 If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3322 in bytes from the frame pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa).
3323 The final value should coincide with that calculated by
3324 @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}.
3325
3326 Normally the CFA is calculated as an offset from the argument pointer,
3327 via @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}, but if the argument pointer is
3328 variable due to the ABI, this may not be possible. If this macro is
3329 defined, it implies that the virtual register instantiation should be
3330 based on the frame pointer instead of the argument pointer. Only one
3331 of @code{FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET} and @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}
3332 should be defined.
3333 @end defmac
3334
3335 @defmac CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3336 If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3337 in bytes from the canonical frame address (cfa) to the frame base used
3338 in DWARF 2 debug information. The default is zero. A different value
3339 may reduce the size of debug information on some ports.
3340 @end defmac
3341
3342 @node Exception Handling
3343 @subsection Exception Handling Support
3344 @cindex exception handling
3345
3346 @defmac EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (@var{N})
3347 A C expression whose value is the @var{N}th register number used for
3348 data by exception handlers, or @code{INVALID_REGNUM} if fewer than
3349 @var{N} registers are usable.
3350
3351 The exception handling library routines communicate with the exception
3352 handlers via a set of agreed upon registers. Ideally these registers
3353 should be call-clobbered; it is possible to use call-saved registers,
3354 but may negatively impact code size. The target must support at least
3355 2 data registers, but should define 4 if there are enough free registers.
3356
3357 You must define this macro if you want to support call frame exception
3358 handling like that provided by DWARF 2.
3359 @end defmac
3360
3361 @defmac EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX
3362 A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3363 to store a stack adjustment to be applied before function return.
3364 This is used to unwind the stack to an exception handler's call frame.
3365 It will be assigned zero on code paths that return normally.
3366
3367 Typically this is a call-clobbered hard register that is otherwise
3368 untouched by the epilogue, but could also be a stack slot.
3369
3370 Do not define this macro if the stack pointer is saved and restored
3371 by the regular prolog and epilog code in the call frame itself; in
3372 this case, the exception handling library routines will update the
3373 stack location to be restored in place. Otherwise, you must define
3374 this macro if you want to support call frame exception handling like
3375 that provided by DWARF 2.
3376 @end defmac
3377
3378 @defmac EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX
3379 A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3380 to store the address of an exception handler to which we should
3381 return. It will not be assigned on code paths that return normally.
3382
3383 Typically this is the location in the call frame at which the normal
3384 return address is stored. For targets that return by popping an
3385 address off the stack, this might be a memory address just below
3386 the @emph{target} call frame rather than inside the current call
3387 frame. If defined, @code{EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX} will have already
3388 been assigned, so it may be used to calculate the location of the
3389 target call frame.
3390
3391 Some targets have more complex requirements than storing to an
3392 address calculable during initial code generation. In that case
3393 the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern should be used instead.
3394
3395 If you want to support call frame exception handling, you must
3396 define either this macro or the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern.
3397 @end defmac
3398
3399 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_OFFSET
3400 If defined, an integer-valued C expression for which rtl will be generated
3401 to add it to the exception handler address before it is searched in the
3402 exception handling tables, and to subtract it again from the address before
3403 using it to return to the exception handler.
3404 @end defmac
3405
3406 @defmac ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (@var{code}, @var{global})
3407 This macro chooses the encoding of pointers embedded in the exception
3408 handling sections. If at all possible, this should be defined such
3409 that the exception handling section will not require dynamic relocations,
3410 and so may be read-only.
3411
3412 @var{code} is 0 for data, 1 for code labels, 2 for function pointers.
3413 @var{global} is true if the symbol may be affected by dynamic relocations.
3414 The macro should return a combination of the @code{DW_EH_PE_*} defines
3415 as found in @file{dwarf2.h}.
3416
3417 If this macro is not defined, pointers will not be encoded but
3418 represented directly.
3419 @end defmac
3420
3421 @defmac ASM_MAYBE_OUTPUT_ENCODED_ADDR_RTX (@var{file}, @var{encoding}, @var{size}, @var{addr}, @var{done})
3422 This macro allows the target to emit whatever special magic is required
3423 to represent the encoding chosen by @code{ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT}.
3424 Generic code takes care of pc-relative and indirect encodings; this must
3425 be defined if the target uses text-relative or data-relative encodings.
3426
3427 This is a C statement that branches to @var{done} if the format was
3428 handled. @var{encoding} is the format chosen, @var{size} is the number
3429 of bytes that the format occupies, @var{addr} is the @code{SYMBOL_REF}
3430 to be emitted.
3431 @end defmac
3432
3433 @defmac MD_UNWIND_SUPPORT
3434 A string specifying a file to be #include'd in unwind-dw2.c. The file
3435 so included typically defines @code{MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR}.
3436 @end defmac
3437
3438 @defmac MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3439 This macro allows the target to add CPU and operating system specific
3440 code to the call-frame unwinder for use when there is no unwind data
3441 available. The most common reason to implement this macro is to unwind
3442 through signal frames.
3443
3444 This macro is called from @code{uw_frame_state_for} in
3445 @file{unwind-dw2.c}, @file{unwind-dw2-xtensa.c} and
3446 @file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3447 @var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{context->ra}
3448 for the address of the code being executed and @code{context->cfa} for
3449 the stack pointer value. If the frame can be decoded, the register
3450 save addresses should be updated in @var{fs} and the macro should
3451 evaluate to @code{_URC_NO_REASON}. If the frame cannot be decoded,
3452 the macro should evaluate to @code{_URC_END_OF_STACK}.
3453
3454 For proper signal handling in Java this macro is accompanied by
3455 @code{MAKE_THROW_FRAME}, defined in @file{libjava/include/*-signal.h} headers.
3456 @end defmac
3457
3458 @defmac MD_HANDLE_UNWABI (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3459 This macro allows the target to add operating system specific code to the
3460 call-frame unwinder to handle the IA-64 @code{.unwabi} unwinding directive,
3461 usually used for signal or interrupt frames.
3462
3463 This macro is called from @code{uw_update_context} in @file{unwind-ia64.c}.
3464 @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3465 @var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{fs->unwabi}
3466 for the abi and context in the @code{.unwabi} directive. If the
3467 @code{.unwabi} directive can be handled, the register save addresses should
3468 be updated in @var{fs}.
3469 @end defmac
3470
3471 @defmac TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO
3472 A C expression that evaluates to true if the target requires unwind
3473 info to be given comdat linkage. Define it to be @code{1} if comdat
3474 linkage is necessary. The default is @code{0}.
3475 @end defmac
3476
3477 @node Stack Checking
3478 @subsection Specifying How Stack Checking is Done
3479
3480 GCC will check that stack references are within the boundaries of the
3481 stack, if the option @option{-fstack-check} is specified, in one of
3482 three ways:
3483
3484 @enumerate
3485 @item
3486 If the value of the @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC
3487 will assume that you have arranged for full stack checking to be done
3488 at appropriate places in the configuration files. GCC will not do
3489 other special processing.
3490
3491 @item
3492 If @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} is zero and the value of the
3493 @code{STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC will assume
3494 that you have arranged for static stack checking (checking of the
3495 static stack frame of functions) to be done at appropriate places
3496 in the configuration files. GCC will only emit code to do dynamic
3497 stack checking (checking on dynamic stack allocations) using the third
3498 approach below.
3499
3500 @item
3501 If neither of the above are true, GCC will generate code to periodically
3502 ``probe'' the stack pointer using the values of the macros defined below.
3503 @end enumerate
3504
3505 If neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined,
3506 GCC will change its allocation strategy for large objects if the option
3507 @option{-fstack-check} is specified: they will always be allocated
3508 dynamically if their size exceeds @code{STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE} bytes.
3509
3510 @defmac STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3511 A nonzero value if stack checking is done by the configuration files in a
3512 machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if stack checking
3513 is required by the ABI of your machine or if you would like to do stack
3514 checking in some more efficient way than the generic approach. The default
3515 value of this macro is zero.
3516 @end defmac
3517
3518 @defmac STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN
3519 A nonzero value if static stack checking is done by the configuration files
3520 in a machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if you would
3521 like to do static stack checking in some more efficient way than the generic
3522 approach. The default value of this macro is zero.
3523 @end defmac
3524
3525 @defmac STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL_EXP
3526 An integer specifying the interval at which GCC must generate stack probe
3527 instructions, defined as 2 raised to this integer. You will normally
3528 define this macro so that the interval be no larger than the size of
3529 the ``guard pages'' at the end of a stack area. The default value
3530 of 12 (4096-byte interval) is suitable for most systems.
3531 @end defmac
3532
3533 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MOVING_SP
3534 An integer which is nonzero if GCC should move the stack pointer page by page
3535 when doing probes. This can be necessary on systems where the stack pointer
3536 contains the bottom address of the memory area accessible to the executing
3537 thread at any point in time. In this situation an alternate signal stack
3538 is required in order to be able to recover from a stack overflow. The
3539 default value of this macro is zero.
3540 @end defmac
3541
3542 @defmac STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
3543 The number of bytes of stack needed to recover from a stack overflow, for
3544 languages where such a recovery is supported. The default value of 75 words
3545 with the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism and
3546 8192 bytes with other exception handling mechanisms should be adequate for
3547 most machines.
3548 @end defmac
3549
3550 The following macros are relevant only if neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3551 nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined; you can omit them altogether
3552 in the opposite case.
3553
3554 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
3555 The maximum size of a stack frame, in bytes. GCC will generate probe
3556 instructions in non-leaf functions to ensure at least this many bytes of
3557 stack are available. If a stack frame is larger than this size, stack
3558 checking will not be reliable and GCC will issue a warning. The
3559 default is chosen so that GCC only generates one instruction on most
3560 systems. You should normally not change the default value of this macro.
3561 @end defmac
3562
3563 @defmac STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
3564 GCC uses this value to generate the above warning message. It
3565 represents the amount of fixed frame used by a function, not including
3566 space for any callee-saved registers, temporaries and user variables.
3567 You need only specify an upper bound for this amount and will normally
3568 use the default of four words.
3569 @end defmac
3570
3571 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
3572 The maximum size, in bytes, of an object that GCC will place in the
3573 fixed area of the stack frame when the user specifies
3574 @option{-fstack-check}.
3575 GCC computed the default from the values of the above macros and you will
3576 normally not need to override that default.
3577 @end defmac
3578
3579 @need 2000
3580 @node Frame Registers
3581 @subsection Registers That Address the Stack Frame
3582
3583 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3584 This discusses registers that address the stack frame.
3585
3586 @defmac STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
3587 The register number of the stack pointer register, which must also be a
3588 fixed register according to @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}. On most machines,
3589 the hardware determines which register this is.
3590 @end defmac
3591
3592 @defmac FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3593 The register number of the frame pointer register, which is used to
3594 access automatic variables in the stack frame. On some machines, the
3595 hardware determines which register this is. On other machines, you can
3596 choose any register you wish for this purpose.
3597 @end defmac
3598
3599 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3600 On some machines the offset between the frame pointer and starting
3601 offset of the automatic variables is not known until after register
3602 allocation has been done (for example, because the saved registers are
3603 between these two locations). On those machines, define
3604 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} the number of a special, fixed register to
3605 be used internally until the offset is known, and define
3606 @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} to be the actual hard register number
3607 used for the frame pointer.
3608
3609 You should define this macro only in the very rare circumstances when it
3610 is not possible to calculate the offset between the frame pointer and
3611 the automatic variables until after register allocation has been
3612 completed. When this macro is defined, you must also indicate in your
3613 definition of @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} how to eliminate
3614 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} into either @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}
3615 or @code{STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3616
3617 Do not define this macro if it would be the same as
3618 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3619 @end defmac
3620
3621 @defmac ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
3622 The register number of the arg pointer register, which is used to access
3623 the function's argument list. On some machines, this is the same as the
3624 frame pointer register. On some machines, the hardware determines which
3625 register this is. On other machines, you can choose any register you
3626 wish for this purpose. If this is not the same register as the frame
3627 pointer register, then you must mark it as a fixed register according to
3628 @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, or arrange to be able to eliminate it
3629 (@pxref{Elimination}).
3630 @end defmac
3631
3632 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_FRAME_POINTER
3633 Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3634 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{frame_pointer_rtx} should be
3635 the same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3636 == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3637 definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3638 @end defmac
3639
3640 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_ARG_POINTER
3641 Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3642 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{arg_pointer_rtx} should be the
3643 same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM ==
3644 ARG_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3645 definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3646 @end defmac
3647
3648 @defmac RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
3649 The register number of the return address pointer register, which is used to
3650 access the current function's return address from the stack. On some
3651 machines, the return address is not at a fixed offset from the frame
3652 pointer or stack pointer or argument pointer. This register can be defined
3653 to point to the return address on the stack, and then be converted by
3654 @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} into either the frame pointer or stack pointer.
3655
3656 Do not define this macro unless there is no other way to get the return
3657 address from the stack.
3658 @end defmac
3659
3660 @defmac STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
3661 @defmacx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
3662 Register numbers used for passing a function's static chain pointer. If
3663 register windows are used, the register number as seen by the called
3664 function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM}, while the register
3665 number as seen by the calling function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM}. If
3666 these registers are the same, @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM} need
3667 not be defined.
3668
3669 The static chain register need not be a fixed register.
3670
3671 If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros should not be
3672 defined; instead, the @code{TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN} hook should be used.
3673 @end defmac
3674
3675 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN (const_tree @var{fndecl}, bool @var{incoming_p})
3676 This hook replaces the use of @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al for
3677 targets that may use different static chain locations for different
3678 nested functions. This may be required if the target has function
3679 attributes that affect the calling conventions of the function and
3680 those calling conventions use different static chain locations.
3681
3682 The default version of this hook uses @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al.
3683
3684 If the static chain is passed in memory, this hook should be used to
3685 provide rtx giving @code{mem} expressions that denote where they are stored.
3686 Often the @code{mem} expression as seen by the caller will be at an offset
3687 from the stack pointer and the @code{mem} expression as seen by the callee
3688 will be at an offset from the frame pointer.
3689 @findex stack_pointer_rtx
3690 @findex frame_pointer_rtx
3691 @findex arg_pointer_rtx
3692 The variables @code{stack_pointer_rtx}, @code{frame_pointer_rtx}, and
3693 @code{arg_pointer_rtx} will have been initialized and should be used
3694 to refer to those items.
3695 @end deftypefn
3696
3697 @defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3698 This macro specifies the maximum number of hard registers that can be
3699 saved in a call frame. This is used to size data structures used in
3700 DWARF2 exception handling.
3701
3702 Prior to GCC 3.0, this macro was needed in order to establish a stable
3703 exception handling ABI in the face of adding new hard registers for ISA
3704 extensions. In GCC 3.0 and later, the EH ABI is insulated from changes
3705 in the number of hard registers. Nevertheless, this macro can still be
3706 used to reduce the runtime memory requirements of the exception handling
3707 routines, which can be substantial if the ISA contains a lot of
3708 registers that are not call-saved.
3709
3710 If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3711 @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
3712 @end defmac
3713
3714 @defmac PRE_GCC3_DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3715
3716 This macro is similar to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}, but is provided
3717 for backward compatibility in pre GCC 3.0 compiled code.
3718
3719 If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3720 @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}.
3721 @end defmac
3722
3723 @defmac DWARF_REG_TO_UNWIND_COLUMN (@var{regno})
3724
3725 Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3726 is different than the internal representation for unwind column.
3727 Given a dwarf register, this macro should return the internal unwind
3728 column number to use instead.
3729
3730 See the PowerPC's SPE target for an example.
3731 @end defmac
3732
3733 @defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (@var{regno})
3734
3735 Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3736 used in .eh_frame or .debug_frame is different from that used in other
3737 debug info sections. Given a GCC hard register number, this macro
3738 should return the .eh_frame register number. The default is
3739 @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})}.
3740
3741 @end defmac
3742
3743 @defmac DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (@var{regno}, @var{for_eh})
3744
3745 Define this macro to map register numbers held in the call frame info
3746 that GCC has collected using @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM} to those that
3747 should be output in .debug_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is zero) and
3748 .eh_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is nonzero). The default is to
3749 return @code{@var{regno}}.
3750
3751 @end defmac
3752
3753 @node Elimination
3754 @subsection Eliminating Frame Pointer and Arg Pointer
3755
3756 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3757 This is about eliminating the frame pointer and arg pointer.
3758
3759 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED (void)
3760 This target hook should return @code{true} if a function must have and use
3761 a frame pointer. This target hook is called in the reload pass. If its return
3762 value is @code{true} the function will have a frame pointer.
3763
3764 This target hook can in principle examine the current function and decide
3765 according to the facts, but on most machines the constant @code{false} or the
3766 constant @code{true} suffices. Use @code{false} when the machine allows code
3767 to be generated with no frame pointer, and doing so saves some time or space.
3768 Use @code{true} when there is no possible advantage to avoiding a frame
3769 pointer.
3770
3771 In certain cases, the compiler does not know how to produce valid code
3772 without a frame pointer. The compiler recognizes those cases and
3773 automatically gives the function a frame pointer regardless of what
3774 @code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} returns. You don't need to worry about
3775 them.
3776
3777 In a function that does not require a frame pointer, the frame pointer
3778 register can be allocated for ordinary usage, unless you mark it as a
3779 fixed register. See @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} for more information.
3780
3781 Default return value is @code{false}.
3782 @end deftypefn
3783
3784 @findex get_frame_size
3785 @defmac INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (@var{depth-var})
3786 A C statement to store in the variable @var{depth-var} the difference
3787 between the frame pointer and the stack pointer values immediately after
3788 the function prologue. The value would be computed from information
3789 such as the result of @code{get_frame_size ()} and the tables of
3790 registers @code{regs_ever_live} and @code{call_used_regs}.
3791
3792 If @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is defined, this macro will be not be used and
3793 need not be defined. Otherwise, it must be defined even if
3794 @code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} always returns true; in that
3795 case, you may set @var{depth-var} to anything.
3796 @end defmac
3797
3798 @defmac ELIMINABLE_REGS
3799 If defined, this macro specifies a table of register pairs used to
3800 eliminate unneeded registers that point into the stack frame. If it is not
3801 defined, the only elimination attempted by the compiler is to replace
3802 references to the frame pointer with references to the stack pointer.
3803
3804 The definition of this macro is a list of structure initializations, each
3805 of which specifies an original and replacement register.
3806
3807 On some machines, the position of the argument pointer is not known until
3808 the compilation is completed. In such a case, a separate hard register
3809 must be used for the argument pointer. This register can be eliminated by
3810 replacing it with either the frame pointer or the argument pointer,
3811 depending on whether or not the frame pointer has been eliminated.
3812
3813 In this case, you might specify:
3814 @smallexample
3815 #define ELIMINABLE_REGS \
3816 @{@{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3817 @{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3818 @{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}@}
3819 @end smallexample
3820
3821 Note that the elimination of the argument pointer with the stack pointer is
3822 specified first since that is the preferred elimination.
3823 @end defmac
3824
3825 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_ELIMINATE (const int @var{from_reg}, const int @var{to_reg})
3826 This target hook should returns @code{true} if the compiler is allowed to
3827 try to replace register number @var{from_reg} with register number
3828 @var{to_reg}. This target hook need only be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS}
3829 is defined, and will usually be @code{true}, since most of the cases
3830 preventing register elimination are things that the compiler already
3831 knows about.
3832
3833 Default return value is @code{true}.
3834 @end deftypefn
3835
3836 @defmac INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg}, @var{offset-var})
3837 This macro is similar to @code{INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET}. It
3838 specifies the initial difference between the specified pair of
3839 registers. This macro must be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is
3840 defined.
3841 @end defmac
3842
3843 @node Stack Arguments
3844 @subsection Passing Function Arguments on the Stack
3845 @cindex arguments on stack
3846 @cindex stack arguments
3847
3848 The macros in this section control how arguments are passed
3849 on the stack. See the following section for other macros that
3850 control passing certain arguments in registers.
3851
3852 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES (const_tree @var{fntype})
3853 This target hook returns @code{true} if an argument declared in a
3854 prototype as an integral type smaller than @code{int} should actually be
3855 passed as an @code{int}. In addition to avoiding errors in certain
3856 cases of mismatch, it also makes for better code on certain machines.
3857 The default is to not promote prototypes.
3858 @end deftypefn
3859
3860 @defmac PUSH_ARGS
3861 A C expression. If nonzero, push insns will be used to pass
3862 outgoing arguments.
3863 If the target machine does not have a push instruction, set it to zero.
3864 That directs GCC to use an alternate strategy: to
3865 allocate the entire argument block and then store the arguments into
3866 it. When @code{PUSH_ARGS} is nonzero, @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} must be defined too.
3867 @end defmac
3868
3869 @defmac PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED
3870 A C expression. If nonzero, function arguments will be evaluated from
3871 last to first, rather than from first to last. If this macro is not
3872 defined, it defaults to @code{PUSH_ARGS} on targets where the stack
3873 and args grow in opposite directions, and 0 otherwise.
3874 @end defmac
3875
3876 @defmac PUSH_ROUNDING (@var{npushed})
3877 A C expression that is the number of bytes actually pushed onto the
3878 stack when an instruction attempts to push @var{npushed} bytes.
3879
3880 On some machines, the definition
3881
3882 @smallexample
3883 #define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (BYTES)
3884 @end smallexample
3885
3886 @noindent
3887 will suffice. But on other machines, instructions that appear
3888 to push one byte actually push two bytes in an attempt to maintain
3889 alignment. Then the definition should be
3890
3891 @smallexample
3892 #define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (((BYTES) + 1) & ~1)
3893 @end smallexample
3894 @end defmac
3895
3896 @findex current_function_outgoing_args_size
3897 @defmac ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
3898 A C expression. If nonzero, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments
3899 will be computed and placed into the variable
3900 @code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}. No space will be pushed
3901 onto the stack for each call; instead, the function prologue should
3902 increase the stack frame size by this amount.
3903
3904 Setting both @code{PUSH_ARGS} and @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS}
3905 is not proper.
3906 @end defmac
3907
3908 @defmac REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
3909 Define this macro if functions should assume that stack space has been
3910 allocated for arguments even when their values are passed in
3911 registers.
3912
3913 The value of this macro is the size, in bytes, of the area reserved for
3914 arguments passed in registers for the function represented by @var{fndecl},
3915 which can be zero if GCC is calling a library function.
3916 The argument @var{fndecl} can be the FUNCTION_DECL, or the type itself
3917 of the function.
3918
3919 This space can be allocated by the caller, or be a part of the
3920 machine-dependent stack frame: @code{OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} says
3921 which.
3922 @end defmac
3923 @c above is overfull. not sure what to do. --mew 5feb93 did
3924 @c something, not sure if it looks good. --mew 10feb93
3925
3926 @defmac OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fntype})
3927 Define this to a nonzero value if it is the responsibility of the
3928 caller to allocate the area reserved for arguments passed in registers
3929 when calling a function of @var{fntype}. @var{fntype} may be NULL
3930 if the function called is a library function.
3931
3932 If @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, this macro controls
3933 whether the space for these arguments counts in the value of
3934 @code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}.
3935 @end defmac
3936
3937 @defmac STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
3938 Define this macro if @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is defined, but the
3939 stack parameters don't skip the area specified by it.
3940 @c i changed this, makes more sens and it should have taken care of the
3941 @c overfull.. not as specific, tho. --mew 5feb93
3942
3943 Normally, when a parameter is not passed in registers, it is placed on the
3944 stack beyond the @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} area. Defining this macro
3945 suppresses this behavior and causes the parameter to be passed on the
3946 stack in its natural location.
3947 @end defmac
3948
3949 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_RETURN_POPS_ARGS (tree @var{fundecl}, tree @var{funtype}, int @var{size})
3950 This target hook returns the number of bytes of its own arguments that
3951 a function pops on returning, or 0 if the function pops no arguments
3952 and the caller must therefore pop them all after the function returns.
3953
3954 @var{fundecl} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that describes
3955 the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3956 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} that describes the declaration of the function.
3957 From this you can obtain the @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of the function.
3958
3959 @var{funtype} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that
3960 describes the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3961 @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} that describes the data type of the function.
3962 From this it is possible to obtain the data types of the value and
3963 arguments (if known).
3964
3965 When a call to a library function is being considered, @var{fundecl}
3966 will contain an identifier node for the library function. Thus, if
3967 you need to distinguish among various library functions, you can do so
3968 by their names. Note that ``library function'' in this context means
3969 a function used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known specially
3970 in the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being compiled.
3971
3972 @var{size} is the number of bytes of arguments passed on the
3973 stack. If a variable number of bytes is passed, it is zero, and
3974 argument popping will always be the responsibility of the calling function.
3975
3976 On the VAX, all functions always pop their arguments, so the definition
3977 of this macro is @var{size}. On the 68000, using the standard
3978 calling convention, no functions pop their arguments, so the value of
3979 the macro is always 0 in this case. But an alternative calling
3980 convention is available in which functions that take a fixed number of
3981 arguments pop them but other functions (such as @code{printf}) pop
3982 nothing (the caller pops all). When this convention is in use,
3983 @var{funtype} is examined to determine whether a function takes a fixed
3984 number of arguments.
3985 @end deftypefn
3986
3987 @defmac CALL_POPS_ARGS (@var{cum})
3988 A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes a call sequence
3989 pops off the stack. It is added to the value of @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS}
3990 when compiling a function call.
3991
3992 @var{cum} is the variable in which all arguments to the called function
3993 have been accumulated.
3994
3995 On certain architectures, such as the SH5, a call trampoline is used
3996 that pops certain registers off the stack, depending on the arguments
3997 that have been passed to the function. Since this is a property of the
3998 call site, not of the called function, @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} is not
3999 appropriate.
4000 @end defmac
4001
4002 @node Register Arguments
4003 @subsection Passing Arguments in Registers
4004 @cindex arguments in registers
4005 @cindex registers arguments
4006
4007 This section describes the macros which let you control how various
4008 types of arguments are passed in registers or how they are arranged in
4009 the stack.
4010
4011 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
4012 A C expression that controls whether a function argument is passed
4013 in a register, and which register.
4014
4015 The arguments are @var{cum}, which summarizes all the previous
4016 arguments; @var{mode}, the machine mode of the argument; @var{type},
4017 the data type of the argument as a tree node or 0 if that is not known
4018 (which happens for C support library functions); and @var{named},
4019 which is 1 for an ordinary argument and 0 for nameless arguments that
4020 correspond to @samp{@dots{}} in the called function's prototype.
4021 @var{type} can be an incomplete type if a syntax error has previously
4022 occurred.
4023
4024 The value of the expression is usually either a @code{reg} RTX for the
4025 hard register in which to pass the argument, or zero to pass the
4026 argument on the stack.
4027
4028 For machines like the VAX and 68000, where normally all arguments are
4029 pushed, zero suffices as a definition.
4030
4031 The value of the expression can also be a @code{parallel} RTX@. This is
4032 used when an argument is passed in multiple locations. The mode of the
4033 @code{parallel} should be the mode of the entire argument. The
4034 @code{parallel} holds any number of @code{expr_list} pairs; each one
4035 describes where part of the argument is passed. In each
4036 @code{expr_list} the first operand must be a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
4037 register in which to pass this part of the argument, and the mode of the
4038 register RTX indicates how large this part of the argument is. The
4039 second operand of the @code{expr_list} is a @code{const_int} which gives
4040 the offset in bytes into the entire argument of where this part starts.
4041 As a special exception the first @code{expr_list} in the @code{parallel}
4042 RTX may have a first operand of zero. This indicates that the entire
4043 argument is also stored on the stack.
4044
4045 The last time this macro is called, it is called with @code{MODE ==
4046 VOIDmode}, and its result is passed to the @code{call} or @code{call_value}
4047 pattern as operands 2 and 3 respectively.
4048
4049 @cindex @file{stdarg.h} and register arguments
4050 The usual way to make the ISO library @file{stdarg.h} work on a machine
4051 where some arguments are usually passed in registers, is to cause
4052 nameless arguments to be passed on the stack instead. This is done
4053 by making @code{FUNCTION_ARG} return 0 whenever @var{named} is 0.
4054
4055 @cindex @code{TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK}, and @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
4056 @cindex @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, and @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
4057 You may use the hook @code{targetm.calls.must_pass_in_stack}
4058 in the definition of this macro to determine if this argument is of a
4059 type that must be passed in the stack. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}
4060 is not defined and @code{FUNCTION_ARG} returns nonzero for such an
4061 argument, the compiler will abort. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is
4062 defined, the argument will be computed in the stack and then loaded into
4063 a register.
4064 @end defmac
4065
4066 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
4067 This target hook should return @code{true} if we should not pass @var{type}
4068 solely in registers. The file @file{expr.h} defines a
4069 definition that is usually appropriate, refer to @file{expr.h} for additional
4070 documentation.
4071 @end deftypefn
4072
4073 @defmac FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
4074 Define this macro if the target machine has ``register windows'', so
4075 that the register in which a function sees an arguments is not
4076 necessarily the same as the one in which the caller passed the
4077 argument.
4078
4079 For such machines, @code{FUNCTION_ARG} computes the register in which
4080 the caller passes the value, and @code{FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} should
4081 be defined in a similar fashion to tell the function being called
4082 where the arguments will arrive.
4083
4084 If @code{FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} is not defined, @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
4085 serves both purposes.
4086 @end defmac
4087
4088 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *@var{cum}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4089 This target hook returns the number of bytes at the beginning of an
4090 argument that must be put in registers. The value must be zero for
4091 arguments that are passed entirely in registers or that are entirely
4092 pushed on the stack.
4093
4094 On some machines, certain arguments must be passed partially in
4095 registers and partially in memory. On these machines, typically the
4096 first few words of arguments are passed in registers, and the rest
4097 on the stack. If a multi-word argument (a @code{double} or a
4098 structure) crosses that boundary, its first few words must be passed
4099 in registers and the rest must be pushed. This macro tells the
4100 compiler when this occurs, and how many bytes should go in registers.
4101
4102 @code{FUNCTION_ARG} for these arguments should return the first
4103 register to be used by the caller for this argument; likewise
4104 @code{FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG}, for the called function.
4105 @end deftypefn
4106
4107 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *@var{cum}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4108 This target hook should return @code{true} if an argument at the
4109 position indicated by @var{cum} should be passed by reference. This
4110 predicate is queried after target independent reasons for being
4111 passed by reference, such as @code{TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type)}.
4112
4113 If the hook returns true, a copy of that argument is made in memory and a
4114 pointer to the argument is passed instead of the argument itself.
4115 The pointer is passed in whatever way is appropriate for passing a pointer
4116 to that type.
4117 @end deftypefn
4118
4119 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CALLEE_COPIES (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *@var{cum}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4120 The function argument described by the parameters to this hook is
4121 known to be passed by reference. The hook should return true if the
4122 function argument should be copied by the callee instead of copied
4123 by the caller.
4124
4125 For any argument for which the hook returns true, if it can be
4126 determined that the argument is not modified, then a copy need
4127 not be generated.
4128
4129 The default version of this hook always returns false.
4130 @end deftypefn
4131
4132 @defmac CUMULATIVE_ARGS
4133 A C type for declaring a variable that is used as the first argument of
4134 @code{FUNCTION_ARG} and other related values. For some target machines,
4135 the type @code{int} suffices and can hold the number of bytes of
4136 argument so far.
4137
4138 There is no need to record in @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} anything about the
4139 arguments that have been passed on the stack. The compiler has other
4140 variables to keep track of that. For target machines on which all
4141 arguments are passed on the stack, there is no need to store anything in
4142 @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}; however, the data structure must exist and
4143 should not be empty, so use @code{int}.
4144 @end defmac
4145
4146 @defmac OVERRIDE_ABI_FORMAT (@var{fndecl})
4147 If defined, this macro is called before generating any code for a
4148 function, but after the @var{cfun} descriptor for the function has been
4149 created. The back end may use this macro to update @var{cfun} to
4150 reflect an ABI other than that which would normally be used by default.
4151 If the compiler is generating code for a compiler-generated function,
4152 @var{fndecl} may be @code{NULL}.
4153 @end defmac
4154
4155 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname}, @var{fndecl}, @var{n_named_args})
4156 A C statement (sans semicolon) for initializing the variable
4157 @var{cum} for the state at the beginning of the argument list. The
4158 variable has type @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}. The value of @var{fntype}
4159 is the tree node for the data type of the function which will receive
4160 the args, or 0 if the args are to a compiler support library function.
4161 For direct calls that are not libcalls, @var{fndecl} contain the
4162 declaration node of the function. @var{fndecl} is also set when
4163 @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used to find arguments for the function
4164 being compiled. @var{n_named_args} is set to the number of named
4165 arguments, including a structure return address if it is passed as a
4166 parameter, when making a call. When processing incoming arguments,
4167 @var{n_named_args} is set to @minus{}1.
4168
4169 When processing a call to a compiler support library function,
4170 @var{libname} identifies which one. It is a @code{symbol_ref} rtx which
4171 contains the name of the function, as a string. @var{libname} is 0 when
4172 an ordinary C function call is being processed. Thus, each time this
4173 macro is called, either @var{libname} or @var{fntype} is nonzero, but
4174 never both of them at once.
4175 @end defmac
4176
4177 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_LIBCALL_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{libname})
4178 Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but only used for outgoing libcalls,
4179 it gets a @code{MODE} argument instead of @var{fntype}, that would be
4180 @code{NULL}. @var{indirect} would always be zero, too. If this macro
4181 is not defined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (cum, NULL_RTX, libname,
4182 0)} is used instead.
4183 @end defmac
4184
4185 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname})
4186 Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but overrides it for the purposes of
4187 finding the arguments for the function being compiled. If this macro is
4188 undefined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used instead.
4189
4190 The value passed for @var{libname} is always 0, since library routines
4191 with special calling conventions are never compiled with GCC@. The
4192 argument @var{libname} exists for symmetry with
4193 @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}.
4194 @c could use "this macro" in place of @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}, maybe.
4195 @c --mew 5feb93 i switched the order of the sentences. --mew 10feb93
4196 @end defmac
4197
4198 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
4199 A C statement (sans semicolon) to update the summarizer variable
4200 @var{cum} to advance past an argument in the argument list. The
4201 values @var{mode}, @var{type} and @var{named} describe that argument.
4202 Once this is done, the variable @var{cum} is suitable for analyzing
4203 the @emph{following} argument with @code{FUNCTION_ARG}, etc.
4204
4205 This macro need not do anything if the argument in question was passed
4206 on the stack. The compiler knows how to track the amount of stack space
4207 used for arguments without any special help.
4208 @end defmac
4209
4210 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_OFFSET (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4211 If defined, a C expression that is the number of bytes to add to the
4212 offset of the argument passed in memory. This is needed for the SPU,
4213 which passes @code{char} and @code{short} arguments in the preferred
4214 slot that is in the middle of the quad word instead of starting at the
4215 top.
4216 @end defmac
4217
4218 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4219 If defined, a C expression which determines whether, and in which direction,
4220 to pad out an argument with extra space. The value should be of type
4221 @code{enum direction}: either @code{upward} to pad above the argument,
4222 @code{downward} to pad below, or @code{none} to inhibit padding.
4223
4224 The @emph{amount} of padding is always just enough to reach the next
4225 multiple of @code{FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY}; this macro does not control
4226 it.
4227
4228 This macro has a default definition which is right for most systems.
4229 For little-endian machines, the default is to pad upward. For
4230 big-endian machines, the default is to pad downward for an argument of
4231 constant size shorter than an @code{int}, and upward otherwise.
4232 @end defmac
4233
4234 @defmac PAD_VARARGS_DOWN
4235 If defined, a C expression which determines whether the default
4236 implementation of va_arg will attempt to pad down before reading the
4237 next argument, if that argument is smaller than its aligned space as
4238 controlled by @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}. If this macro is not defined, all such
4239 arguments are padded down if @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN} is true.
4240 @end defmac
4241
4242 @defmac BLOCK_REG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{first})
4243 Specify padding for the last element of a block move between registers and
4244 memory. @var{first} is nonzero if this is the only element. Defining this
4245 macro allows better control of register function parameters on big-endian
4246 machines, without using @code{PARALLEL} rtl. In particular,
4247 @code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK} need not test padding and mode of types in
4248 registers, as there is no longer a "wrong" part of a register; For example,
4249 a three byte aggregate may be passed in the high part of a register if so
4250 required.
4251 @end defmac
4252
4253 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4254 If defined, a C expression that gives the alignment boundary, in bits,
4255 of an argument with the specified mode and type. If it is not defined,
4256 @code{PARM_BOUNDARY} is used for all arguments.
4257 @end defmac
4258
4259 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4260 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4261 register in which function arguments are sometimes passed. This does
4262 @emph{not} include implicit arguments such as the static chain and
4263 the structure-value address. On many machines, no registers can be
4264 used for this purpose since all function arguments are pushed on the
4265 stack.
4266 @end defmac
4267
4268 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SPLIT_COMPLEX_ARG (const_tree @var{type})
4269 This hook should return true if parameter of type @var{type} are passed
4270 as two scalar parameters. By default, GCC will attempt to pack complex
4271 arguments into the target's word size. Some ABIs require complex arguments
4272 to be split and treated as their individual components. For example, on
4273 AIX64, complex floats should be passed in a pair of floating point
4274 registers, even though a complex float would fit in one 64-bit floating
4275 point register.
4276
4277 The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which is treated as always
4278 false.
4279 @end deftypefn
4280
4281 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILD_BUILTIN_VA_LIST (void)
4282 This hook returns a type node for @code{va_list} for the target.
4283 The default version of the hook returns @code{void*}.
4284 @end deftypefn
4285
4286 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ENUM_VA_LIST_P (int @var{idx}, const char **@var{pname}, tree *@var{ptree})
4287 This target hook is used in function @code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins}
4288 to iterate through the target specific builtin types for va_list. The
4289 variable @var{idx} is used as iterator. @var{pname} has to be a pointer
4290 to a @code{const char *} and @var{ptree} a pointer to a @code{tree} typed
4291 variable.
4292 The arguments @var{pname} and @var{ptree} are used to store the result of
4293 this macro and are set to the name of the va_list builtin type and its
4294 internal type.
4295 If the return value of this macro is zero, then there is no more element.
4296 Otherwise the @var{IDX} should be increased for the next call of this
4297 macro to iterate through all types.
4298 @end deftypefn
4299
4300 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_FN_ABI_VA_LIST (tree @var{fndecl})
4301 This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by
4302 @var{fndecl}.
4303 The default version of this hook returns @code{va_list_type_node}.
4304 @end deftypefn
4305
4306 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CANONICAL_VA_LIST_TYPE (tree @var{type})
4307 This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by the
4308 type of @var{type}. If @var{type} is not a valid va_list type, it returns
4309 @code{NULL_TREE}.
4310 @end deftypefn
4311
4312 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GIMPLIFY_VA_ARG_EXPR (tree @var{valist}, tree @var{type}, gimple_seq *@var{pre_p}, gimple_seq *@var{post_p})
4313 This hook performs target-specific gimplification of
4314 @code{VA_ARG_EXPR}. The first two parameters correspond to the
4315 arguments to @code{va_arg}; the latter two are as in
4316 @code{gimplify.c:gimplify_expr}.
4317 @end deftypefn
4318
4319 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
4320 Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
4321 with machine mode @var{mode}. The default version of this
4322 hook returns true for both @code{ptr_mode} and @code{Pmode}.
4323 @end deftypefn
4324
4325 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
4326 Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4327 insns involving scalar mode @var{mode}. For a scalar mode to be
4328 considered supported, all the basic arithmetic and comparisons
4329 must work.
4330
4331 The default version of this hook returns true for any mode
4332 required to handle the basic C types (as defined by the port).
4333 Included here are the double-word arithmetic supported by the
4334 code in @file{optabs.c}.
4335 @end deftypefn
4336
4337 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
4338 Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4339 insns involving vector mode @var{mode}. At the very least, it
4340 must have move patterns for this mode.
4341 @end deftypefn
4342
4343 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES_FOR_MODE_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
4344 Define this to return nonzero for machine modes for which the port has
4345 small register classes. If this target hook returns nonzero for a given
4346 @var{mode}, the compiler will try to minimize the lifetime of registers
4347 in @var{mode}. The hook may be called with @code{VOIDmode} as argument.
4348 In this case, the hook is expected to return nonzero if it returns nonzero
4349 for any mode.
4350
4351 On some machines, it is risky to let hard registers live across arbitrary
4352 insns. Typically, these machines have instructions that require values
4353 to be in specific registers (like an accumulator), and reload will fail
4354 if the required hard register is used for another purpose across such an
4355 insn.
4356
4357 Passes before reload do not know which hard registers will be used
4358 in an instruction, but the machine modes of the registers set or used in
4359 the instruction are already known. And for some machines, register
4360 classes are small for, say, integer registers but not for floating point
4361 registers. For example, the AMD x86-64 architecture requires specific
4362 registers for the legacy x86 integer instructions, but there are many
4363 SSE registers for floating point operations. On such targets, a good
4364 strategy may be to return nonzero from this hook for @code{INTEGRAL_MODE_P}
4365 machine modes but zero for the SSE register classes.
4366
4367 The default version of this hook retuns false for any mode. It is always
4368 safe to redefine this hook to return with a nonzero value. But if you
4369 unnecessarily define it, you will reduce the amount of optimizations
4370 that can be performed in some cases. If you do not define this hook
4371 to return a nonzero value when it is required, the compiler will run out
4372 of spill registers and print a fatal error message.
4373 @end deftypefn
4374
4375 @node Scalar Return
4376 @subsection How Scalar Function Values Are Returned
4377 @cindex return values in registers
4378 @cindex values, returned by functions
4379 @cindex scalars, returned as values
4380
4381 This section discusses the macros that control returning scalars as
4382 values---values that can fit in registers.
4383
4384 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE (const_tree @var{ret_type}, const_tree @var{fn_decl_or_type}, bool @var{outgoing})
4385
4386 Define this to return an RTX representing the place where a function
4387 returns or receives a value of data type @var{ret_type}, a tree node
4388 representing a data type. @var{fn_decl_or_type} is a tree node
4389 representing @code{FUNCTION_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} of a
4390 function being called. If @var{outgoing} is false, the hook should
4391 compute the register in which the caller will see the return value.
4392 Otherwise, the hook should return an RTX representing the place where
4393 a function returns a value.
4394
4395 On many machines, only @code{TYPE_MODE (@var{ret_type})} is relevant.
4396 (Actually, on most machines, scalar values are returned in the same
4397 place regardless of mode.) The value of the expression is usually a
4398 @code{reg} RTX for the hard register where the return value is stored.
4399 The value can also be a @code{parallel} RTX, if the return value is in
4400 multiple places. See @code{FUNCTION_ARG} for an explanation of the
4401 @code{parallel} form. Note that the callee will populate every
4402 location specified in the @code{parallel}, but if the first element of
4403 the @code{parallel} contains the whole return value, callers will use
4404 that element as the canonical location and ignore the others. The m68k
4405 port uses this type of @code{parallel} to return pointers in both
4406 @samp{%a0} (the canonical location) and @samp{%d0}.
4407
4408 If @code{TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN} returns true, you must apply
4409 the same promotion rules specified in @code{PROMOTE_MODE} if
4410 @var{valtype} is a scalar type.
4411
4412 If the precise function being called is known, @var{func} is a tree
4413 node (@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
4414 pointer. This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
4415 convention for specific functions when all their calls are
4416 known.
4417
4418 Some target machines have ``register windows'' so that the register in
4419 which a function returns its value is not the same as the one in which
4420 the caller sees the value. For such machines, you should return
4421 different RTX depending on @var{outgoing}.
4422
4423 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} is not used for return values with
4424 aggregate data types, because these are returned in another way. See
4425 @code{TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX} and related macros, below.
4426 @end deftypefn
4427
4428 @defmac FUNCTION_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
4429 This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} for
4430 a new target instead.
4431 @end defmac
4432
4433 @defmac LIBCALL_VALUE (@var{mode})
4434 A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a library
4435 function returns a value of mode @var{mode}.
4436
4437 Note that ``library function'' in this context means a compiler
4438 support routine, used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known
4439 specially by the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being
4440 compiled.
4441 @end defmac
4442
4443 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LIBCALL_VALUE (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_rtx @var{fun})
4444 Define this hook if the back-end needs to know the name of the libcall
4445 function in order to determine where the result should be returned.
4446
4447 The mode of the result is given by @var{mode} and the name of the called
4448 library function is given by @var{fun}. The hook should return an RTX
4449 representing the place where the library function result will be returned.
4450
4451 If this hook is not defined, then LIBCALL_VALUE will be used.
4452 @end deftypefn
4453
4454 @defmac FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4455 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4456 register in which the values of called function may come back.
4457
4458 A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4459 second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4460 recognized by this macro. So for most machines, this definition
4461 suffices:
4462
4463 @smallexample
4464 #define FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P(N) ((N) == 0)
4465 @end smallexample
4466
4467 If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4468 function use different registers for the return value, this macro
4469 should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4470
4471 This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P}
4472 for a new target instead.
4473 @end defmac
4474
4475 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (const unsigned int @var{regno})
4476 A target hook that return @code{true} if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4477 register in which the values of called function may come back.
4478
4479 A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4480 second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4481 recognized by this target hook.
4482
4483 If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4484 function use different registers for the return value, this target hook
4485 should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4486
4487 If this hook is not defined, then FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P will be used.
4488 @end deftypefn
4489
4490 @defmac APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
4491 Define this macro if @samp{untyped_call} and @samp{untyped_return}
4492 need more space than is implied by @code{FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P} for
4493 saving and restoring an arbitrary return value.
4494 @end defmac
4495
4496 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RETURN_IN_MSB (const_tree @var{type})
4497 This hook should return true if values of type @var{type} are returned
4498 at the most significant end of a register (in other words, if they are
4499 padded at the least significant end). You can assume that @var{type}
4500 is returned in a register; the caller is required to check this.
4501
4502 Note that the register provided by @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must
4503 be able to hold the complete return value. For example, if a 1-, 2-
4504 or 3-byte structure is returned at the most significant end of a
4505 4-byte register, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} should provide an
4506 @code{SImode} rtx.
4507 @end deftypefn
4508
4509 @node Aggregate Return
4510 @subsection How Large Values Are Returned
4511 @cindex aggregates as return values
4512 @cindex large return values
4513 @cindex returning aggregate values
4514 @cindex structure value address
4515
4516 When a function value's mode is @code{BLKmode} (and in some other
4517 cases), the value is not returned according to
4518 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} (@pxref{Scalar Return}). Instead, the
4519 caller passes the address of a block of memory in which the value
4520 should be stored. This address is called the @dfn{structure value
4521 address}.
4522
4523 This section describes how to control returning structure values in
4524 memory.
4525
4526 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY (const_tree @var{type}, const_tree @var{fntype})
4527 This target hook should return a nonzero value to say to return the
4528 function value in memory, just as large structures are always returned.
4529 Here @var{type} will be the data type of the value, and @var{fntype}
4530 will be the type of the function doing the returning, or @code{NULL} for
4531 libcalls.
4532
4533 Note that values of mode @code{BLKmode} must be explicitly handled
4534 by this function. Also, the option @option{-fpcc-struct-return}
4535 takes effect regardless of this macro. On most systems, it is
4536 possible to leave the hook undefined; this causes a default
4537 definition to be used, whose value is the constant 1 for @code{BLKmode}
4538 values, and 0 otherwise.
4539
4540 Do not use this hook to indicate that structures and unions should always
4541 be returned in memory. You should instead use @code{DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN}
4542 to indicate this.
4543 @end deftypefn
4544
4545 @defmac DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
4546 Define this macro to be 1 if all structure and union return values must be
4547 in memory. Since this results in slower code, this should be defined
4548 only if needed for compatibility with other compilers or with an ABI@.
4549 If you define this macro to be 0, then the conventions used for structure
4550 and union return values are decided by the @code{TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY}
4551 target hook.
4552
4553 If not defined, this defaults to the value 1.
4554 @end defmac
4555
4556 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX (tree @var{fndecl}, int @var{incoming})
4557 This target hook should return the location of the structure value
4558 address (normally a @code{mem} or @code{reg}), or 0 if the address is
4559 passed as an ``invisible'' first argument. Note that @var{fndecl} may
4560 be @code{NULL}, for libcalls. You do not need to define this target
4561 hook if the address is always passed as an ``invisible'' first
4562 argument.
4563
4564 On some architectures the place where the structure value address
4565 is found by the called function is not the same place that the
4566 caller put it. This can be due to register windows, or it could
4567 be because the function prologue moves it to a different place.
4568 @var{incoming} is @code{1} or @code{2} when the location is needed in
4569 the context of the called function, and @code{0} in the context of
4570 the caller.
4571
4572 If @var{incoming} is nonzero and the address is to be found on the
4573 stack, return a @code{mem} which refers to the frame pointer. If
4574 @var{incoming} is @code{2}, the result is being used to fetch the
4575 structure value address at the beginning of a function. If you need
4576 to emit adjusting code, you should do it at this point.
4577 @end deftypefn
4578
4579 @defmac PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
4580 Define this macro if the usual system convention on the target machine
4581 for returning structures and unions is for the called function to return
4582 the address of a static variable containing the value.
4583
4584 Do not define this if the usual system convention is for the caller to
4585 pass an address to the subroutine.
4586
4587 This macro has effect in @option{-fpcc-struct-return} mode, but it does
4588 nothing when you use @option{-freg-struct-return} mode.
4589 @end defmac
4590
4591 @node Caller Saves
4592 @subsection Caller-Saves Register Allocation
4593
4594 If you enable it, GCC can save registers around function calls. This
4595 makes it possible to use call-clobbered registers to hold variables that
4596 must live across calls.
4597
4598 @defmac CALLER_SAVE_PROFITABLE (@var{refs}, @var{calls})
4599 A C expression to determine whether it is worthwhile to consider placing
4600 a pseudo-register in a call-clobbered hard register and saving and
4601 restoring it around each function call. The expression should be 1 when
4602 this is worth doing, and 0 otherwise.
4603
4604 If you don't define this macro, a default is used which is good on most
4605 machines: @code{4 * @var{calls} < @var{refs}}.
4606 @end defmac
4607
4608 @defmac HARD_REGNO_CALLER_SAVE_MODE (@var{regno}, @var{nregs})
4609 A C expression specifying which mode is required for saving @var{nregs}
4610 of a pseudo-register in call-clobbered hard register @var{regno}. If
4611 @var{regno} is unsuitable for caller save, @code{VOIDmode} should be
4612 returned. For most machines this macro need not be defined since GCC
4613 will select the smallest suitable mode.
4614 @end defmac
4615
4616 @node Function Entry
4617 @subsection Function Entry and Exit
4618 @cindex function entry and exit
4619 @cindex prologue
4620 @cindex epilogue
4621
4622 This section describes the macros that output function entry
4623 (@dfn{prologue}) and exit (@dfn{epilogue}) code.
4624
4625 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
4626 If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for entry to a
4627 function. The prologue is responsible for setting up the stack frame,
4628 initializing the frame pointer register, saving registers that must be
4629 saved, and allocating @var{size} additional bytes of storage for the
4630 local variables. @var{size} is an integer. @var{file} is a stdio
4631 stream to which the assembler code should be output.
4632
4633 The label for the beginning of the function need not be output by this
4634 macro. That has already been done when the macro is run.
4635
4636 @findex regs_ever_live
4637 To determine which registers to save, the macro can refer to the array
4638 @code{regs_ever_live}: element @var{r} is nonzero if hard register
4639 @var{r} is used anywhere within the function. This implies the function
4640 prologue should save register @var{r}, provided it is not one of the
4641 call-used registers. (@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must likewise use
4642 @code{regs_ever_live}.)
4643
4644 On machines that have ``register windows'', the function entry code does
4645 not save on the stack the registers that are in the windows, even if
4646 they are supposed to be preserved by function calls; instead it takes
4647 appropriate steps to ``push'' the register stack, if any non-call-used
4648 registers are used in the function.
4649
4650 @findex frame_pointer_needed
4651 On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4652 function entry code must vary accordingly; it must set up the frame
4653 pointer if one is wanted, and not otherwise. To determine whether a
4654 frame pointer is in wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4655 @code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 at run
4656 time in a function that needs a frame pointer. @xref{Elimination}.
4657
4658 The function entry code is responsible for allocating any stack space
4659 required for the function. This stack space consists of the regions
4660 listed below. In most cases, these regions are allocated in the
4661 order listed, with the last listed region closest to the top of the
4662 stack (the lowest address if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and
4663 the highest address if it is not defined). You can use a different order
4664 for a machine if doing so is more convenient or required for
4665 compatibility reasons. Except in cases where required by standard
4666 or by a debugger, there is no reason why the stack layout used by GCC
4667 need agree with that used by other compilers for a machine.
4668 @end deftypefn
4669
4670 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_END_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4671 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the end of a
4672 prologue. This should be used when the function prologue is being
4673 emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4674 emitted. @xref{prologue instruction pattern}.
4675 @end deftypefn
4676
4677 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_BEGIN_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4678 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the start of an
4679 epilogue. This should be used when the function epilogue is being
4680 emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4681 emitted. @xref{epilogue instruction pattern}.
4682 @end deftypefn
4683
4684 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
4685 If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for exit from a
4686 function. The epilogue is responsible for restoring the saved
4687 registers and stack pointer to their values when the function was
4688 called, and returning control to the caller. This macro takes the
4689 same arguments as the macro @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}, and the
4690 registers to restore are determined from @code{regs_ever_live} and
4691 @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} in the same way.
4692
4693 On some machines, there is a single instruction that does all the work
4694 of returning from the function. On these machines, give that
4695 instruction the name @samp{return} and do not define the macro
4696 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} at all.
4697
4698 Do not define a pattern named @samp{return} if you want the
4699 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to be used. If you want the target
4700 switches to control whether return instructions or epilogues are used,
4701 define a @samp{return} pattern with a validity condition that tests the
4702 target switches appropriately. If the @samp{return} pattern's validity
4703 condition is false, epilogues will be used.
4704
4705 On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4706 function exit code must vary accordingly. Sometimes the code for these
4707 two cases is completely different. To determine whether a frame pointer
4708 is wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4709 @code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 when compiling
4710 a function that needs a frame pointer.
4711
4712 Normally, @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
4713 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must treat leaf functions specially.
4714 The C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} is nonzero for such a
4715 function. @xref{Leaf Functions}.
4716
4717 On some machines, some functions pop their arguments on exit while
4718 others leave that for the caller to do. For example, the 68020 when
4719 given @option{-mrtd} pops arguments in functions that take a fixed
4720 number of arguments.
4721
4722 @findex current_function_pops_args
4723 Your definition of the macro @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} decides which
4724 functions pop their own arguments. @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}
4725 needs to know what was decided. The number of bytes of the current
4726 function's arguments that this function should pop is available in
4727 @code{crtl->args.pops_args}. @xref{Scalar Return}.
4728 @end deftypefn
4729
4730 @itemize @bullet
4731 @item
4732 @findex current_function_pretend_args_size
4733 A region of @code{current_function_pretend_args_size} bytes of
4734 uninitialized space just underneath the first argument arriving on the
4735 stack. (This may not be at the very start of the allocated stack region
4736 if the calling sequence has pushed anything else since pushing the stack
4737 arguments. But usually, on such machines, nothing else has been pushed
4738 yet, because the function prologue itself does all the pushing.) This
4739 region is used on machines where an argument may be passed partly in
4740 registers and partly in memory, and, in some cases to support the
4741 features in @code{<stdarg.h>}.
4742
4743 @item
4744 An area of memory used to save certain registers used by the function.
4745 The size of this area, which may also include space for such things as
4746 the return address and pointers to previous stack frames, is
4747 machine-specific and usually depends on which registers have been used
4748 in the function. Machines with register windows often do not require
4749 a save area.
4750
4751 @item
4752 A region of at least @var{size} bytes, possibly rounded up to an allocation
4753 boundary, to contain the local variables of the function. On some machines,
4754 this region and the save area may occur in the opposite order, with the
4755 save area closer to the top of the stack.
4756
4757 @item
4758 @cindex @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} and stack frames
4759 Optionally, when @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, a region of
4760 @code{current_function_outgoing_args_size} bytes to be used for outgoing
4761 argument lists of the function. @xref{Stack Arguments}.
4762 @end itemize
4763
4764 @defmac EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
4765 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if the return
4766 instruction or the function epilogue ignores the value of the stack
4767 pointer; in other words, if it is safe to delete an instruction to
4768 adjust the stack pointer before a return from the function. The
4769 default is 0.
4770
4771 Note that this macro's value is relevant only for functions for which
4772 frame pointers are maintained. It is never safe to delete a final
4773 stack adjustment in a function that has no frame pointer, and the
4774 compiler knows this regardless of @code{EXIT_IGNORE_STACK}.
4775 @end defmac
4776
4777 @defmac EPILOGUE_USES (@var{regno})
4778 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4779 used by the epilogue or the @samp{return} pattern. The stack and frame
4780 pointer registers are already assumed to be used as needed.
4781 @end defmac
4782
4783 @defmac EH_USES (@var{regno})
4784 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4785 used by the exception handling mechanism, and so should be considered live
4786 on entry to an exception edge.
4787 @end defmac
4788
4789 @defmac DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE
4790 Define this macro if the function epilogue contains delay slots to which
4791 instructions from the rest of the function can be ``moved''. The
4792 definition should be a C expression whose value is an integer
4793 representing the number of delay slots there.
4794 @end defmac
4795
4796 @defmac ELIGIBLE_FOR_EPILOGUE_DELAY (@var{insn}, @var{n})
4797 A C expression that returns 1 if @var{insn} can be placed in delay
4798 slot number @var{n} of the epilogue.
4799
4800 The argument @var{n} is an integer which identifies the delay slot now
4801 being considered (since different slots may have different rules of
4802 eligibility). It is never negative and is always less than the number
4803 of epilogue delay slots (what @code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE} returns).
4804 If you reject a particular insn for a given delay slot, in principle, it
4805 may be reconsidered for a subsequent delay slot. Also, other insns may
4806 (at least in principle) be considered for the so far unfilled delay
4807 slot.
4808
4809 @findex current_function_epilogue_delay_list
4810 @findex final_scan_insn
4811 The insns accepted to fill the epilogue delay slots are put in an RTL
4812 list made with @code{insn_list} objects, stored in the variable
4813 @code{current_function_epilogue_delay_list}. The insn for the first
4814 delay slot comes first in the list. Your definition of the macro
4815 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} should fill the delay slots by
4816 outputting the insns in this list, usually by calling
4817 @code{final_scan_insn}.
4818
4819 You need not define this macro if you did not define
4820 @code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE}.
4821 @end defmac
4822
4823 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (FILE *@var{file}, tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{vcall_offset}, tree @var{function})
4824 A function that outputs the assembler code for a thunk
4825 function, used to implement C++ virtual function calls with multiple
4826 inheritance. The thunk acts as a wrapper around a virtual function,
4827 adjusting the implicit object parameter before handing control off to
4828 the real function.
4829
4830 First, emit code to add the integer @var{delta} to the location that
4831 contains the incoming first argument. Assume that this argument
4832 contains a pointer, and is the one used to pass the @code{this} pointer
4833 in C++. This is the incoming argument @emph{before} the function prologue,
4834 e.g.@: @samp{%o0} on a sparc. The addition must preserve the values of
4835 all other incoming arguments.
4836
4837 Then, if @var{vcall_offset} is nonzero, an additional adjustment should be
4838 made after adding @code{delta}. In particular, if @var{p} is the
4839 adjusted pointer, the following adjustment should be made:
4840
4841 @smallexample
4842 p += (*((ptrdiff_t **)p))[vcall_offset/sizeof(ptrdiff_t)]
4843 @end smallexample
4844
4845 After the additions, emit code to jump to @var{function}, which is a
4846 @code{FUNCTION_DECL}. This is a direct pure jump, not a call, and does
4847 not touch the return address. Hence returning from @var{FUNCTION} will
4848 return to whoever called the current @samp{thunk}.
4849
4850 The effect must be as if @var{function} had been called directly with
4851 the adjusted first argument. This macro is responsible for emitting all
4852 of the code for a thunk function; @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}
4853 and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} are not invoked.
4854
4855 The @var{thunk_fndecl} is redundant. (@var{delta} and @var{function}
4856 have already been extracted from it.) It might possibly be useful on
4857 some targets, but probably not.
4858
4859 If you do not define this macro, the target-independent code in the C++
4860 front end will generate a less efficient heavyweight thunk that calls
4861 @var{function} instead of jumping to it. The generic approach does
4862 not support varargs.
4863 @end deftypefn
4864
4865 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (const_tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{vcall_offset}, const_tree @var{function})
4866 A function that returns true if TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK would be able
4867 to output the assembler code for the thunk function specified by the
4868 arguments it is passed, and false otherwise. In the latter case, the
4869 generic approach will be used by the C++ front end, with the limitations
4870 previously exposed.
4871 @end deftypefn
4872
4873 @node Profiling
4874 @subsection Generating Code for Profiling
4875 @cindex profiling, code generation
4876
4877 These macros will help you generate code for profiling.
4878
4879 @defmac FUNCTION_PROFILER (@var{file}, @var{labelno})
4880 A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some
4881 assembler code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount}.
4882
4883 @findex mcount
4884 The details of how @code{mcount} expects to be called are determined by
4885 your operating system environment, not by GCC@. To figure them out,
4886 compile a small program for profiling using the system's installed C
4887 compiler and look at the assembler code that results.
4888
4889 Older implementations of @code{mcount} expect the address of a counter
4890 variable to be loaded into some register. The name of this variable is
4891 @samp{LP} followed by the number @var{labelno}, so you would generate
4892 the name using @samp{LP%d} in a @code{fprintf}.
4893 @end defmac
4894
4895 @defmac PROFILE_HOOK
4896 A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some assembly
4897 code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount} even the target does
4898 not support profiling.
4899 @end defmac
4900
4901 @defmac NO_PROFILE_COUNTERS
4902 Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if the
4903 @code{mcount} subroutine on your system does not need a counter variable
4904 allocated for each function. This is true for almost all modern
4905 implementations. If you define this macro, you must not use the
4906 @var{labelno} argument to @code{FUNCTION_PROFILER}.
4907 @end defmac
4908
4909 @defmac PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
4910 Define this macro if the code for function profiling should come before
4911 the function prologue. Normally, the profiling code comes after.
4912 @end defmac
4913
4914 @node Tail Calls
4915 @subsection Permitting tail calls
4916 @cindex tail calls
4917
4918 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL (tree @var{decl}, tree @var{exp})
4919 True if it is ok to do sibling call optimization for the specified
4920 call expression @var{exp}. @var{decl} will be the called function,
4921 or @code{NULL} if this is an indirect call.
4922
4923 It is not uncommon for limitations of calling conventions to prevent
4924 tail calls to functions outside the current unit of translation, or
4925 during PIC compilation. The hook is used to enforce these restrictions,
4926 as the @code{sibcall} md pattern can not fail, or fall over to a
4927 ``normal'' call. The criteria for successful sibling call optimization
4928 may vary greatly between different architectures.
4929 @end deftypefn
4930
4931 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXTRA_LIVE_ON_ENTRY (bitmap @var{regs})
4932 Add any hard registers to @var{regs} that are live on entry to the
4933 function. This hook only needs to be defined to provide registers that
4934 cannot be found by examination of FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P, the callee saved
4935 registers, STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM, STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM,
4936 TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, EH_USES,
4937 FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, and the PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM.
4938 @end deftypefn
4939
4940 @node Stack Smashing Protection
4941 @subsection Stack smashing protection
4942 @cindex stack smashing protection
4943
4944 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_GUARD (void)
4945 This hook returns a @code{DECL} node for the external variable to use
4946 for the stack protection guard. This variable is initialized by the
4947 runtime to some random value and is used to initialize the guard value
4948 that is placed at the top of the local stack frame. The type of this
4949 variable must be @code{ptr_type_node}.
4950
4951 The default version of this hook creates a variable called
4952 @samp{__stack_chk_guard}, which is normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4953 @end deftypefn
4954
4955 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_FAIL (void)
4956 This hook returns a tree expression that alerts the runtime that the
4957 stack protect guard variable has been modified. This expression should
4958 involve a call to a @code{noreturn} function.
4959
4960 The default version of this hook invokes a function called
4961 @samp{__stack_chk_fail}, taking no arguments. This function is
4962 normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4963 @end deftypefn
4964
4965 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SUPPORTS_SPLIT_STACK (bool)
4966 Whether this target supports splitting the stack. This is called after options have been parsed, so the target may reject splitting the stack in some configurations. The default version of this hook returns false. If @var{report} is true, this function may issue a warning or error; if @var{report} is false, it must simply return a value
4967 @end deftypefn
4968
4969 @node Varargs
4970 @section Implementing the Varargs Macros
4971 @cindex varargs implementation
4972
4973 GCC comes with an implementation of @code{<varargs.h>} and
4974 @code{<stdarg.h>} that work without change on machines that pass arguments
4975 on the stack. Other machines require their own implementations of
4976 varargs, and the two machine independent header files must have
4977 conditionals to include it.
4978
4979 ISO @code{<stdarg.h>} differs from traditional @code{<varargs.h>} mainly in
4980 the calling convention for @code{va_start}. The traditional
4981 implementation takes just one argument, which is the variable in which
4982 to store the argument pointer. The ISO implementation of
4983 @code{va_start} takes an additional second argument. The user is
4984 supposed to write the last named argument of the function here.
4985
4986 However, @code{va_start} should not use this argument. The way to find
4987 the end of the named arguments is with the built-in functions described
4988 below.
4989
4990 @defmac __builtin_saveregs ()
4991 Use this built-in function to save the argument registers in memory so
4992 that the varargs mechanism can access them. Both ISO and traditional
4993 versions of @code{va_start} must use @code{__builtin_saveregs}, unless
4994 you use @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} (see below) instead.
4995
4996 On some machines, @code{__builtin_saveregs} is open-coded under the
4997 control of the target hook @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. On
4998 other machines, it calls a routine written in assembler language,
4999 found in @file{libgcc2.c}.
5000
5001 Code generated for the call to @code{__builtin_saveregs} appears at the
5002 beginning of the function, as opposed to where the call to
5003 @code{__builtin_saveregs} is written, regardless of what the code is.
5004 This is because the registers must be saved before the function starts
5005 to use them for its own purposes.
5006 @c i rewrote the first sentence above to fix an overfull hbox. --mew
5007 @c 10feb93
5008 @end defmac
5009
5010 @defmac __builtin_next_arg (@var{lastarg})
5011 This builtin returns the address of the first anonymous stack
5012 argument, as type @code{void *}. If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, it
5013 returns the address of the location above the first anonymous stack
5014 argument. Use it in @code{va_start} to initialize the pointer for
5015 fetching arguments from the stack. Also use it in @code{va_start} to
5016 verify that the second parameter @var{lastarg} is the last named argument
5017 of the current function.
5018 @end defmac
5019
5020 @defmac __builtin_classify_type (@var{object})
5021 Since each machine has its own conventions for which data types are
5022 passed in which kind of register, your implementation of @code{va_arg}
5023 has to embody these conventions. The easiest way to categorize the
5024 specified data type is to use @code{__builtin_classify_type} together
5025 with @code{sizeof} and @code{__alignof__}.
5026
5027 @code{__builtin_classify_type} ignores the value of @var{object},
5028 considering only its data type. It returns an integer describing what
5029 kind of type that is---integer, floating, pointer, structure, and so on.
5030
5031 The file @file{typeclass.h} defines an enumeration that you can use to
5032 interpret the values of @code{__builtin_classify_type}.
5033 @end defmac
5034
5035 These machine description macros help implement varargs:
5036
5037 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS (void)
5038 If defined, this hook produces the machine-specific code for a call to
5039 @code{__builtin_saveregs}. This code will be moved to the very
5040 beginning of the function, before any parameter access are made. The
5041 return value of this function should be an RTX that contains the value
5042 to use as the return of @code{__builtin_saveregs}.
5043 @end deftypefn
5044
5045 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *@var{args_so_far}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, int *@var{pretend_args_size}, int @var{second_time})
5046 This target hook offers an alternative to using
5047 @code{__builtin_saveregs} and defining the hook
5048 @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. Use it to store the anonymous
5049 register arguments into the stack so that all the arguments appear to
5050 have been passed consecutively on the stack. Once this is done, you can
5051 use the standard implementation of varargs that works for machines that
5052 pass all their arguments on the stack.
5053
5054 The argument @var{args_so_far} points to the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data
5055 structure, containing the values that are obtained after processing the
5056 named arguments. The arguments @var{mode} and @var{type} describe the
5057 last named argument---its machine mode and its data type as a tree node.
5058
5059 The target hook should do two things: first, push onto the stack all the
5060 argument registers @emph{not} used for the named arguments, and second,
5061 store the size of the data thus pushed into the @code{int}-valued
5062 variable pointed to by @var{pretend_args_size}. The value that you
5063 store here will serve as additional offset for setting up the stack
5064 frame.
5065
5066 Because you must generate code to push the anonymous arguments at
5067 compile time without knowing their data types,
5068 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is only useful on machines that
5069 have just a single category of argument register and use it uniformly
5070 for all data types.
5071
5072 If the argument @var{second_time} is nonzero, it means that the
5073 arguments of the function are being analyzed for the second time. This
5074 happens for an inline function, which is not actually compiled until the
5075 end of the source file. The hook @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} should
5076 not generate any instructions in this case.
5077 @end deftypefn
5078
5079 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *@var{ca})
5080 Define this hook to return @code{true} if the location where a function
5081 argument is passed depends on whether or not it is a named argument.
5082
5083 This hook controls how the @var{named} argument to @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
5084 is set for varargs and stdarg functions. If this hook returns
5085 @code{true}, the @var{named} argument is always true for named
5086 arguments, and false for unnamed arguments. If it returns @code{false},
5087 but @code{TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED} returns @code{true},
5088 then all arguments are treated as named. Otherwise, all named arguments
5089 except the last are treated as named.
5090
5091 You need not define this hook if it always returns @code{false}.
5092 @end deftypefn
5093
5094 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *@var{ca})
5095 If you need to conditionally change ABIs so that one works with
5096 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}, but the other works like neither
5097 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} nor @code{TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING} was
5098 defined, then define this hook to return @code{true} if
5099 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is used, @code{false} otherwise.
5100 Otherwise, you should not define this hook.
5101 @end deftypefn
5102
5103 @node Trampolines
5104 @section Trampolines for Nested Functions
5105 @cindex trampolines for nested functions
5106 @cindex nested functions, trampolines for
5107
5108 A @dfn{trampoline} is a small piece of code that is created at run time
5109 when the address of a nested function is taken. It normally resides on
5110 the stack, in the stack frame of the containing function. These macros
5111 tell GCC how to generate code to allocate and initialize a
5112 trampoline.
5113
5114 The instructions in the trampoline must do two things: load a constant
5115 address into the static chain register, and jump to the real address of
5116 the nested function. On CISC machines such as the m68k, this requires
5117 two instructions, a move immediate and a jump. Then the two addresses
5118 exist in the trampoline as word-long immediate operands. On RISC
5119 machines, it is often necessary to load each address into a register in
5120 two parts. Then pieces of each address form separate immediate
5121 operands.
5122
5123 The code generated to initialize the trampoline must store the variable
5124 parts---the static chain value and the function address---into the
5125 immediate operands of the instructions. On a CISC machine, this is
5126 simply a matter of copying each address to a memory reference at the
5127 proper offset from the start of the trampoline. On a RISC machine, it
5128 may be necessary to take out pieces of the address and store them
5129 separately.
5130
5131 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE (FILE *@var{f})
5132 This hook is called by @code{assemble_trampoline_template} to output,
5133 on the stream @var{f}, assembler code for a block of data that contains
5134 the constant parts of a trampoline. This code should not include a
5135 label---the label is taken care of automatically.
5136
5137 If you do not define this hook, it means no template is needed
5138 for the target. Do not define this hook on systems where the block move
5139 code to copy the trampoline into place would be larger than the code
5140 to generate it on the spot.
5141 @end deftypefn
5142
5143 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
5144 Return the section into which the trampoline template is to be placed
5145 (@pxref{Sections}). The default value is @code{readonly_data_section}.
5146 @end defmac
5147
5148 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
5149 A C expression for the size in bytes of the trampoline, as an integer.
5150 @end defmac
5151
5152 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
5153 Alignment required for trampolines, in bits.
5154
5155 If you don't define this macro, the value of @code{FUNCTION_ALIGNMENT}
5156 is used for aligning trampolines.
5157 @end defmac
5158
5159 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT (rtx @var{m_tramp}, tree @var{fndecl}, rtx @var{static_chain})
5160 This hook is called to initialize a trampoline.
5161 @var{m_tramp} is an RTX for the memory block for the trampoline; @var{fndecl}
5162 is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} for the nested function; @var{static_chain} is an
5163 RTX for the static chain value that should be passed to the function
5164 when it is called.
5165
5166 If the target defines @code{TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE}, then the
5167 first thing this hook should do is emit a block move into @var{m_tramp}
5168 from the memory block returned by @code{assemble_trampoline_template}.
5169 Note that the block move need only cover the constant parts of the
5170 trampoline. If the target isolates the variable parts of the trampoline
5171 to the end, not all @code{TRAMPOLINE_SIZE} bytes need be copied.
5172
5173 If the target requires any other actions, such as flushing caches or
5174 enabling stack execution, these actions should be performed after
5175 initializing the trampoline proper.
5176 @end deftypefn
5177
5178 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS (rtx @var{addr})
5179 This hook should perform any machine-specific adjustment in
5180 the address of the trampoline. Its argument contains the address of the
5181 memory block that was passed to @code{TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT}. In case
5182 the address to be used for a function call should be different from the
5183 address at which the template was stored, the different address should
5184 be returned; otherwise @var{addr} should be returned unchanged.
5185 If this hook is not defined, @var{addr} will be used for function calls.
5186 @end deftypefn
5187
5188 Implementing trampolines is difficult on many machines because they have
5189 separate instruction and data caches. Writing into a stack location
5190 fails to clear the memory in the instruction cache, so when the program
5191 jumps to that location, it executes the old contents.
5192
5193 Here are two possible solutions. One is to clear the relevant parts of
5194 the instruction cache whenever a trampoline is set up. The other is to
5195 make all trampolines identical, by having them jump to a standard
5196 subroutine. The former technique makes trampoline execution faster; the
5197 latter makes initialization faster.
5198
5199 To clear the instruction cache when a trampoline is initialized, define
5200 the following macro.
5201
5202 @defmac CLEAR_INSN_CACHE (@var{beg}, @var{end})
5203 If defined, expands to a C expression clearing the @emph{instruction
5204 cache} in the specified interval. The definition of this macro would
5205 typically be a series of @code{asm} statements. Both @var{beg} and
5206 @var{end} are both pointer expressions.
5207 @end defmac
5208
5209 The operating system may also require the stack to be made executable
5210 before calling the trampoline. To implement this requirement, define
5211 the following macro.
5212
5213 @defmac ENABLE_EXECUTE_STACK
5214 Define this macro if certain operations must be performed before executing
5215 code located on the stack. The macro should expand to a series of C
5216 file-scope constructs (e.g.@: functions) and provide a unique entry point
5217 named @code{__enable_execute_stack}. The target is responsible for
5218 emitting calls to the entry point in the code, for example from the
5219 @code{TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT} hook.
5220 @end defmac
5221
5222 To use a standard subroutine, define the following macro. In addition,
5223 you must make sure that the instructions in a trampoline fill an entire
5224 cache line with identical instructions, or else ensure that the
5225 beginning of the trampoline code is always aligned at the same point in
5226 its cache line. Look in @file{m68k.h} as a guide.
5227
5228 @defmac TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
5229 Define this macro if trampolines need a special subroutine to do their
5230 work. The macro should expand to a series of @code{asm} statements
5231 which will be compiled with GCC@. They go in a library function named
5232 @code{__transfer_from_trampoline}.
5233
5234 If you need to avoid executing the ordinary prologue code of a compiled
5235 C function when you jump to the subroutine, you can do so by placing a
5236 special label of your own in the assembler code. Use one @code{asm}
5237 statement to generate an assembler label, and another to make the label
5238 global. Then trampolines can use that label to jump directly to your
5239 special assembler code.
5240 @end defmac
5241
5242 @node Library Calls
5243 @section Implicit Calls to Library Routines
5244 @cindex library subroutine names
5245 @cindex @file{libgcc.a}
5246
5247 @c prevent bad page break with this line
5248 Here is an explanation of implicit calls to library routines.
5249
5250 @defmac DECLARE_LIBRARY_RENAMES
5251 This macro, if defined, should expand to a piece of C code that will get
5252 expanded when compiling functions for libgcc.a. It can be used to
5253 provide alternate names for GCC's internal library functions if there
5254 are ABI-mandated names that the compiler should provide.
5255 @end defmac
5256
5257 @findex set_optab_libfunc
5258 @findex init_one_libfunc
5259 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS (void)
5260 This hook should declare additional library routines or rename
5261 existing ones, using the functions @code{set_optab_libfunc} and
5262 @code{init_one_libfunc} defined in @file{optabs.c}.
5263 @code{init_optabs} calls this macro after initializing all the normal
5264 library routines.
5265
5266 The default is to do nothing. Most ports don't need to define this hook.
5267 @end deftypefn
5268
5269 @defmac FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL (@var{mode}, @var{comparison})
5270 This macro should return @code{true} if the library routine that
5271 implements the floating point comparison operator @var{comparison} in
5272 mode @var{mode} will return a boolean, and @var{false} if it will
5273 return a tristate.
5274
5275 GCC's own floating point libraries return tristates from the
5276 comparison operators, so the default returns false always. Most ports
5277 don't need to define this macro.
5278 @end defmac
5279
5280 @defmac TARGET_LIB_INT_CMP_BIASED
5281 This macro should evaluate to @code{true} if the integer comparison
5282 functions (like @code{__cmpdi2}) return 0 to indicate that the first
5283 operand is smaller than the second, 1 to indicate that they are equal,
5284 and 2 to indicate that the first operand is greater than the second.
5285 If this macro evaluates to @code{false} the comparison functions return
5286 @minus{}1, 0, and 1 instead of 0, 1, and 2. If the target uses the routines
5287 in @file{libgcc.a}, you do not need to define this macro.
5288 @end defmac
5289
5290 @cindex US Software GOFAST, floating point emulation library
5291 @cindex floating point emulation library, US Software GOFAST
5292 @cindex GOFAST, floating point emulation library
5293 @findex gofast_maybe_init_libfuncs
5294 @defmac US_SOFTWARE_GOFAST
5295 Define this macro if your system C library uses the US Software GOFAST
5296 library to provide floating point emulation.
5297
5298 In addition to defining this macro, your architecture must set
5299 @code{TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS} to @code{gofast_maybe_init_libfuncs}, or
5300 else call that function from its version of that hook. It is defined
5301 in @file{config/gofast.h}, which must be included by your
5302 architecture's @file{@var{cpu}.c} file. See @file{sparc/sparc.c} for
5303 an example.
5304
5305 If this macro is defined, the
5306 @code{TARGET_FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL} target hook must return
5307 false for @code{SFmode} and @code{DFmode} comparisons.
5308 @end defmac
5309
5310 @cindex @code{EDOM}, implicit usage
5311 @findex matherr
5312 @defmac TARGET_EDOM
5313 The value of @code{EDOM} on the target machine, as a C integer constant
5314 expression. If you don't define this macro, GCC does not attempt to
5315 deposit the value of @code{EDOM} into @code{errno} directly. Look in
5316 @file{/usr/include/errno.h} to find the value of @code{EDOM} on your
5317 system.
5318
5319 If you do not define @code{TARGET_EDOM}, then compiled code reports
5320 domain errors by calling the library function and letting it report the
5321 error. If mathematical functions on your system use @code{matherr} when
5322 there is an error, then you should leave @code{TARGET_EDOM} undefined so
5323 that @code{matherr} is used normally.
5324 @end defmac
5325
5326 @cindex @code{errno}, implicit usage
5327 @defmac GEN_ERRNO_RTX
5328 Define this macro as a C expression to create an rtl expression that
5329 refers to the global ``variable'' @code{errno}. (On certain systems,
5330 @code{errno} may not actually be a variable.) If you don't define this
5331 macro, a reasonable default is used.
5332 @end defmac
5333
5334 @cindex C99 math functions, implicit usage
5335 @defmac TARGET_C99_FUNCTIONS
5336 When this macro is nonzero, GCC will implicitly optimize @code{sin} calls into
5337 @code{sinf} and similarly for other functions defined by C99 standard. The
5338 default is zero because a number of existing systems lack support for these
5339 functions in their runtime so this macro needs to be redefined to one on
5340 systems that do support the C99 runtime.
5341 @end defmac
5342
5343 @cindex sincos math function, implicit usage
5344 @defmac TARGET_HAS_SINCOS
5345 When this macro is nonzero, GCC will implicitly optimize calls to @code{sin}
5346 and @code{cos} with the same argument to a call to @code{sincos}. The
5347 default is zero. The target has to provide the following functions:
5348 @smallexample
5349 void sincos(double x, double *sin, double *cos);
5350 void sincosf(float x, float *sin, float *cos);
5351 void sincosl(long double x, long double *sin, long double *cos);
5352 @end smallexample
5353 @end defmac
5354
5355 @defmac NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME
5356 Define this macro to generate code for Objective-C message sending using
5357 the calling convention of the NeXT system. This calling convention
5358 involves passing the object, the selector and the method arguments all
5359 at once to the method-lookup library function.
5360
5361 The default calling convention passes just the object and the selector
5362 to the lookup function, which returns a pointer to the method.
5363 @end defmac
5364
5365 @node Addressing Modes
5366 @section Addressing Modes
5367 @cindex addressing modes
5368
5369 @c prevent bad page break with this line
5370 This is about addressing modes.
5371
5372 @defmac HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
5373 @defmacx HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
5374 @defmacx HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
5375 @defmacx HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
5376 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre-increment,
5377 pre-decrement, post-increment, or post-decrement addressing respectively.
5378 @end defmac
5379
5380 @defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_DISP
5381 @defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_DISP
5382 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5383 post-address side-effect generation involving constants other than
5384 the size of the memory operand.
5385 @end defmac
5386
5387 @defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_REG
5388 @defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_REG
5389 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5390 post-address side-effect generation involving a register displacement.
5391 @end defmac
5392
5393 @defmac CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (@var{x})
5394 A C expression that is 1 if the RTX @var{x} is a constant which
5395 is a valid address. On most machines the default definition of
5396 @code{(CONSTANT_P (@var{x}) && GET_CODE (@var{x}) != CONST_DOUBLE)}
5397 is acceptable, but a few machines are more restrictive as to which
5398 constant addresses are supported.
5399 @end defmac
5400
5401 @defmac CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
5402 @code{CONSTANT_P}, which is defined by target-independent code,
5403 accepts integer-values expressions whose values are not explicitly
5404 known, such as @code{symbol_ref}, @code{label_ref}, and @code{high}
5405 expressions and @code{const} arithmetic expressions, in addition to
5406 @code{const_int} and @code{const_double} expressions.
5407 @end defmac
5408
5409 @defmac MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
5410 A number, the maximum number of registers that can appear in a valid
5411 memory address. Note that it is up to you to specify a value equal to
5412 the maximum number that @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} would ever
5413 accept.
5414 @end defmac
5415
5416 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x}, bool @var{strict})
5417 A function that returns whether @var{x} (an RTX) is a legitimate memory
5418 address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5419
5420 Legitimate addresses are defined in two variants: a strict variant and a
5421 non-strict one. The @var{strict} parameter chooses which variant is
5422 desired by the caller.
5423
5424 The strict variant is used in the reload pass. It must be defined so
5425 that any pseudo-register that has not been allocated a hard register is
5426 considered a memory reference. This is because in contexts where some
5427 kind of register is required, a pseudo-register with no hard register
5428 must be rejected. For non-hard registers, the strict variant should look
5429 up the @code{reg_renumber} array; it should then proceed using the hard
5430 register number in the array, or treat the pseudo as a memory reference
5431 if the array holds @code{-1}.
5432
5433 The non-strict variant is used in other passes. It must be defined to
5434 accept all pseudo-registers in every context where some kind of
5435 register is required.
5436
5437 Normally, constant addresses which are the sum of a @code{symbol_ref}
5438 and an integer are stored inside a @code{const} RTX to mark them as
5439 constant. Therefore, there is no need to recognize such sums
5440 specifically as legitimate addresses. Normally you would simply
5441 recognize any @code{const} as legitimate.
5442
5443 Usually @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS} is not prepared to handle constant
5444 sums that are not marked with @code{const}. It assumes that a naked
5445 @code{plus} indicates indexing. If so, then you @emph{must} reject such
5446 naked constant sums as illegitimate addresses, so that none of them will
5447 be given to @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.
5448
5449 @cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} and address validation
5450 On some machines, whether a symbolic address is legitimate depends on
5451 the section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the
5452 target hook @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information
5453 into the @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. When you see a
5454 @code{const}, you will have to look inside it to find the
5455 @code{symbol_ref} in order to determine the section. @xref{Assembler
5456 Format}.
5457
5458 @cindex @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS}
5459 Some ports are still using a deprecated legacy substitute for
5460 this hook, the @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} macro. This macro
5461 has this syntax:
5462
5463 @example
5464 #define GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{label})
5465 @end example
5466
5467 @noindent
5468 and should @code{goto @var{label}} if the address @var{x} is a valid
5469 address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5470 Whether the strict or non-strict variants are desired is defined by
5471 the @code{REG_OK_STRICT} macro introduced earlier in this section.
5472 Using the hook is usually simpler because it limits the number of
5473 files that are recompiled when changes are made.
5474 @end deftypefn
5475
5476 @defmac TARGET_MEM_CONSTRAINT
5477 A single character to be used instead of the default @code{'m'}
5478 character for general memory addresses. This defines the constraint
5479 letter which matches the memory addresses accepted by
5480 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P}. Define this macro if you want to
5481 support new address formats in your back end without changing the
5482 semantics of the @code{'m'} constraint. This is necessary in order to
5483 preserve functionality of inline assembly constructs using the
5484 @code{'m'} constraint.
5485 @end defmac
5486
5487 @defmac FIND_BASE_TERM (@var{x})
5488 A C expression to determine the base term of address @var{x},
5489 or to provide a simplified version of @var{x} from which @file{alias.c}
5490 can easily find the base term. This macro is used in only two places:
5491 @code{find_base_value} and @code{find_base_term} in @file{alias.c}.
5492
5493 It is always safe for this macro to not be defined. It exists so
5494 that alias analysis can understand machine-dependent addresses.
5495
5496 The typical use of this macro is to handle addresses containing
5497 a label_ref or symbol_ref within an UNSPEC@.
5498 @end defmac
5499
5500 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x}, rtx @var{oldx}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
5501 This hook is given an invalid memory address @var{x} for an
5502 operand of mode @var{mode} and should try to return a valid memory
5503 address.
5504
5505 @findex break_out_memory_refs
5506 @var{x} will always be the result of a call to @code{break_out_memory_refs},
5507 and @var{oldx} will be the operand that was given to that function to produce
5508 @var{x}.
5509
5510 The code of the hook should not alter the substructure of
5511 @var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5512 should return the new @var{x}.
5513
5514 It is not necessary for this hook to come up with a legitimate address.
5515 The compiler has standard ways of doing so in all cases. In fact, it
5516 is safe to omit this hook or make it return @var{x} if it cannot find
5517 a valid way to legitimize the address. But often a machine-dependent
5518 strategy can generate better code.
5519 @end deftypefn
5520
5521 @defmac LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{opnum}, @var{type}, @var{ind_levels}, @var{win})
5522 A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x}, which is an address
5523 that needs reloading, with a valid memory address for an operand of mode
5524 @var{mode}. @var{win} will be a C statement label elsewhere in the code.
5525 It is not necessary to define this macro, but it might be useful for
5526 performance reasons.
5527
5528 For example, on the i386, it is sometimes possible to use a single
5529 reload register instead of two by reloading a sum of two pseudo
5530 registers into a register. On the other hand, for number of RISC
5531 processors offsets are limited so that often an intermediate address
5532 needs to be generated in order to address a stack slot. By defining
5533 @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} appropriately, the intermediate addresses
5534 generated for adjacent some stack slots can be made identical, and thus
5535 be shared.
5536
5537 @emph{Note}: This macro should be used with caution. It is necessary
5538 to know something of how reload works in order to effectively use this,
5539 and it is quite easy to produce macros that build in too much knowledge
5540 of reload internals.
5541
5542 @emph{Note}: This macro must be able to reload an address created by a
5543 previous invocation of this macro. If it fails to handle such addresses
5544 then the compiler may generate incorrect code or abort.
5545
5546 @findex push_reload
5547 The macro definition should use @code{push_reload} to indicate parts that
5548 need reloading; @var{opnum}, @var{type} and @var{ind_levels} are usually
5549 suitable to be passed unaltered to @code{push_reload}.
5550
5551 The code generated by this macro must not alter the substructure of
5552 @var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5553 should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
5554 This also applies to parts that you change indirectly by calling
5555 @code{push_reload}.
5556
5557 @findex strict_memory_address_p
5558 The macro definition may use @code{strict_memory_address_p} to test if
5559 the address has become legitimate.
5560
5561 @findex copy_rtx
5562 If you want to change only a part of @var{x}, one standard way of doing
5563 this is to use @code{copy_rtx}. Note, however, that it unshares only a
5564 single level of rtl. Thus, if the part to be changed is not at the
5565 top level, you'll need to replace first the top level.
5566 It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
5567 address; but often a machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
5568 @end defmac
5569
5570 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P (const_rtx @var{addr})
5571 This hook returns @code{true} if memory address @var{addr} can have
5572 different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5573 reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5574 but not others.
5575
5576 Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5577 effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5578 of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5579 addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5580
5581 You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5582
5583 The default version of this hook returns @code{false}.
5584 @end deftypefn
5585
5586 @defmac GO_IF_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS (@var{addr}, @var{label})
5587 A C statement or compound statement with a conditional @code{goto
5588 @var{label};} executed if memory address @var{x} (an RTX) can have
5589 different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5590 reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5591 but not others.
5592
5593 Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5594 effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5595 of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5596 addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5597
5598 You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5599
5600 These are obsolete macros, replaced by the
5601 @code{TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P} target hook.
5602 @end defmac
5603
5604 @defmac LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
5605 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate constant for
5606 an immediate operand on the target machine. You can assume that
5607 @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not check this. In fact,
5608 @samp{1} is a suitable definition for this macro on machines where
5609 anything @code{CONSTANT_P} is valid.
5610 @end defmac
5611
5612 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_DELEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x})
5613 This hook is used to undo the possibly obfuscating effects of the
5614 @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} and @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} target
5615 macros. Some backend implementations of these macros wrap symbol
5616 references inside an @code{UNSPEC} rtx to represent PIC or similar
5617 addressing modes. This target hook allows GCC's optimizers to understand
5618 the semantics of these opaque @code{UNSPEC}s by converting them back
5619 into their original form.
5620 @end deftypefn
5621
5622 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM (rtx @var{x})
5623 This hook should return true if @var{x} is of a form that cannot (or
5624 should not) be spilled to the constant pool. The default version of
5625 this hook returns false.
5626
5627 The primary reason to define this hook is to prevent reload from
5628 deciding that a non-legitimate constant would be better reloaded
5629 from the constant pool instead of spilling and reloading a register
5630 holding the constant. This restriction is often true of addresses
5631 of TLS symbols for various targets.
5632 @end deftypefn
5633
5634 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_CONSTANT_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_rtx @var{x})
5635 This hook should return true if pool entries for constant @var{x} can
5636 be placed in an @code{object_block} structure. @var{mode} is the mode
5637 of @var{x}.
5638
5639 The default version returns false for all constants.
5640 @end deftypefn
5641
5642 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_RECIPROCAL (unsigned @var{fn}, bool @var{md_fn}, bool @var{sqrt})
5643 This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements reciprocal of
5644 the builtin function with builtin function code @var{fn}, or
5645 @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available. @var{md_fn} is true
5646 when @var{fn} is a code of a machine-dependent builtin function. When
5647 @var{sqrt} is true, additional optimizations that apply only to the reciprocal
5648 of a square root function are performed, and only reciprocals of @code{sqrt}
5649 function are valid.
5650 @end deftypefn
5651
5652 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MASK_FOR_LOAD (void)
5653 This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that given an
5654 address @var{addr} as an argument returns a mask @var{m} that can be
5655 used to extract from two vectors the relevant data that resides in
5656 @var{addr} in case @var{addr} is not properly aligned.
5657
5658 The autovectorizer, when vectorizing a load operation from an address
5659 @var{addr} that may be unaligned, will generate two vector loads from
5660 the two aligned addresses around @var{addr}. It then generates a
5661 @code{REALIGN_LOAD} operation to extract the relevant data from the
5662 two loaded vectors. The first two arguments to @code{REALIGN_LOAD},
5663 @var{v1} and @var{v2}, are the two vectors, each of size @var{VS}, and
5664 the third argument, @var{OFF}, defines how the data will be extracted
5665 from these two vectors: if @var{OFF} is 0, then the returned vector is
5666 @var{v2}; otherwise, the returned vector is composed from the last
5667 @var{VS}-@var{OFF} elements of @var{v1} concatenated to the first
5668 @var{OFF} elements of @var{v2}.
5669
5670 If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will generate a call
5671 to @var{f} (using the DECL tree that this hook returns) and will
5672 use the return value of @var{f} as the argument @var{OFF} to
5673 @code{REALIGN_LOAD}. Therefore, the mask @var{m} returned by @var{f}
5674 should comply with the semantics expected by @code{REALIGN_LOAD}
5675 described above.
5676 If this hook is not defined, then @var{addr} will be used as
5677 the argument @var{OFF} to @code{REALIGN_LOAD}, in which case the low
5678 log2(@var{VS}) @minus{} 1 bits of @var{addr} will be considered.
5679 @end deftypefn
5680
5681 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_EVEN (tree @var{x})
5682 This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that implements
5683 widening multiplication of the even elements of two input vectors of type @var{x}.
5684
5685 If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use it along with the
5686 @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_ODD} target hook when vectorizing
5687 widening multiplication in cases that the order of the results does not have to be
5688 preserved (e.g.@: used only by a reduction computation). Otherwise, the
5689 @code{widen_mult_hi/lo} idioms will be used.
5690 @end deftypefn
5691
5692 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_ODD (tree @var{x})
5693 This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that implements
5694 widening multiplication of the odd elements of two input vectors of type @var{x}.
5695
5696 If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use it along with the
5697 @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_EVEN} target hook when vectorizing
5698 widening multiplication in cases that the order of the results does not have to be
5699 preserved (e.g.@: used only by a reduction computation). Otherwise, the
5700 @code{widen_mult_hi/lo} idioms will be used.
5701 @end deftypefn
5702
5703 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZATION_COST (enum vect_cost_for_stmt @var{type_of_cost}, tree @var{vectype}, int @var{misalign})
5704 Returns cost of different scalar or vector statements for vectorization cost model.
5705 For vector memory operations the cost may depend on type (@var{vectype}) and
5706 misalignment value (@var{misalign}).
5707 @end deftypefn
5708
5709 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT_REACHABLE (const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{is_packed})
5710 Return true if vector alignment is reachable (by peeling N iterations) for the given type.
5711 @end deftypefn
5712
5713 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VEC_PERM (tree @var{type}, tree *@var{mask_element_type})
5714 Target builtin that implements vector permute.
5715 @end deftypefn
5716
5717 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VEC_PERM_OK (tree @var{vec_type}, tree @var{mask})
5718 Return true if a vector created for @code{builtin_vec_perm} is valid.
5719 @end deftypefn
5720
5721 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION (unsigned @var{code}, tree @var{dest_type}, tree @var{src_type})
5722 This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements conversion of the
5723 input vector of type @var{src_type} to type @var{dest_type}.
5724 The value of @var{code} is one of the enumerators in @code{enum tree_code} and
5725 specifies how the conversion is to be applied
5726 (truncation, rounding, etc.).
5727
5728 If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use the
5729 @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION} target hook when vectorizing
5730 conversion. Otherwise, it will return @code{NULL_TREE}.
5731 @end deftypefn
5732
5733 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZED_FUNCTION (tree @var{fndecl}, tree @var{vec_type_out}, tree @var{vec_type_in})
5734 This hook should return the decl of a function that implements the
5735 vectorized variant of the builtin function with builtin function code
5736 @var{code} or @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available.
5737 The value of @var{fndecl} is the builtin function declaration. The
5738 return type of the vectorized function shall be of vector type
5739 @var{vec_type_out} and the argument types should be @var{vec_type_in}.
5740 @end deftypefn
5741
5742 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_SUPPORT_VECTOR_MISALIGNMENT (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, int @var{misalignment}, bool @var{is_packed})
5743 This hook should return true if the target supports misaligned vector
5744 store/load of a specific factor denoted in the @var{misalignment}
5745 parameter. The vector store/load should be of machine mode @var{mode} and
5746 the elements in the vectors should be of type @var{type}. @var{is_packed}
5747 parameter is true if the memory access is defined in a packed struct.
5748 @end deftypefn
5749
5750 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
5751 This hook should return the preferred mode for vectorizing scalar
5752 mode @var{mode}. The default is
5753 equal to @code{word_mode}, because the vectorizer can do some
5754 transformations even in absence of specialized @acronym{SIMD} hardware.
5755 @end deftypefn
5756
5757 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_VECTORIZE_AUTOVECTORIZE_VECTOR_SIZES (void)
5758 This hook should return a mask of sizes that should be iterated over
5759 after trying to autovectorize using the vector size derived from the
5760 mode returned by @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE}.
5761 The default is zero which means to not iterate over other vector sizes.
5762 @end deftypefn
5763
5764 @node Anchored Addresses
5765 @section Anchored Addresses
5766 @cindex anchored addresses
5767 @cindex @option{-fsection-anchors}
5768
5769 GCC usually addresses every static object as a separate entity.
5770 For example, if we have:
5771
5772 @smallexample
5773 static int a, b, c;
5774 int foo (void) @{ return a + b + c; @}
5775 @end smallexample
5776
5777 the code for @code{foo} will usually calculate three separate symbolic
5778 addresses: those of @code{a}, @code{b} and @code{c}. On some targets,
5779 it would be better to calculate just one symbolic address and access
5780 the three variables relative to it. The equivalent pseudocode would
5781 be something like:
5782
5783 @smallexample
5784 int foo (void)
5785 @{
5786 register int *xr = &x;
5787 return xr[&a - &x] + xr[&b - &x] + xr[&c - &x];
5788 @}
5789 @end smallexample
5790
5791 (which isn't valid C). We refer to shared addresses like @code{x} as
5792 ``section anchors''. Their use is controlled by @option{-fsection-anchors}.
5793
5794 The hooks below describe the target properties that GCC needs to know
5795 in order to make effective use of section anchors. It won't use
5796 section anchors at all unless either @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}
5797 or @code{TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET} is set to a nonzero value.
5798
5799 @deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5800 The minimum offset that should be applied to a section anchor.
5801 On most targets, it should be the smallest offset that can be
5802 applied to a base register while still giving a legitimate address
5803 for every mode. The default value is 0.
5804 @end deftypevr
5805
5806 @deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5807 Like @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}, but the maximum (inclusive)
5808 offset that should be applied to section anchors. The default
5809 value is 0.
5810 @end deftypevr
5811
5812 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ANCHOR (rtx @var{x})
5813 Write the assembly code to define section anchor @var{x}, which is a
5814 @code{SYMBOL_REF} for which @samp{SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})} is true.
5815 The hook is called with the assembly output position set to the beginning
5816 of @code{SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK (@var{x})}.
5817
5818 If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is available, the hook's default definition uses
5819 it to define the symbol as @samp{. + SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK_OFFSET (@var{x})}.
5820 If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is not available, the hook's default definition
5821 is @code{NULL}, which disables the use of section anchors altogether.
5822 @end deftypefn
5823
5824 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_ANCHORS_FOR_SYMBOL_P (const_rtx @var{x})
5825 Return true if GCC should attempt to use anchors to access @code{SYMBOL_REF}
5826 @var{x}. You can assume @samp{SYMBOL_REF_HAS_BLOCK_INFO_P (@var{x})} and
5827 @samp{!SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})}.
5828
5829 The default version is correct for most targets, but you might need to
5830 intercept this hook to handle things like target-specific attributes
5831 or target-specific sections.
5832 @end deftypefn
5833
5834 @node Condition Code
5835 @section Condition Code Status
5836 @cindex condition code status
5837
5838 The macros in this section can be split in two families, according to the
5839 two ways of representing condition codes in GCC.
5840
5841 The first representation is the so called @code{(cc0)} representation
5842 (@pxref{Jump Patterns}), where all instructions can have an implicit
5843 clobber of the condition codes. The second is the condition code
5844 register representation, which provides better schedulability for
5845 architectures that do have a condition code register, but on which
5846 most instructions do not affect it. The latter category includes
5847 most RISC machines.
5848
5849 The implicit clobbering poses a strong restriction on the placement of
5850 the definition and use of the condition code, which need to be in adjacent
5851 insns for machines using @code{(cc0)}. This can prevent important
5852 optimizations on some machines. For example, on the IBM RS/6000, there
5853 is a delay for taken branches unless the condition code register is set
5854 three instructions earlier than the conditional branch. The instruction
5855 scheduler cannot perform this optimization if it is not permitted to
5856 separate the definition and use of the condition code register.
5857
5858 For this reason, it is possible and suggested to use a register to
5859 represent the condition code for new ports. If there is a specific
5860 condition code register in the machine, use a hard register. If the
5861 condition code or comparison result can be placed in any general register,
5862 or if there are multiple condition registers, use a pseudo register.
5863 Registers used to store the condition code value will usually have a mode
5864 that is in class @code{MODE_CC}.
5865
5866 Alternatively, you can use @code{BImode} if the comparison operator is
5867 specified already in the compare instruction. In this case, you are not
5868 interested in most macros in this section.
5869
5870 @menu
5871 * CC0 Condition Codes:: Old style representation of condition codes.
5872 * MODE_CC Condition Codes:: Modern representation of condition codes.
5873 * Cond. Exec. Macros:: Macros to control conditional execution.
5874 @end menu
5875
5876 @node CC0 Condition Codes
5877 @subsection Representation of condition codes using @code{(cc0)}
5878 @findex cc0
5879
5880 @findex cc_status
5881 The file @file{conditions.h} defines a variable @code{cc_status} to
5882 describe how the condition code was computed (in case the interpretation of
5883 the condition code depends on the instruction that it was set by). This
5884 variable contains the RTL expressions on which the condition code is
5885 currently based, and several standard flags.
5886
5887 Sometimes additional machine-specific flags must be defined in the machine
5888 description header file. It can also add additional machine-specific
5889 information by defining @code{CC_STATUS_MDEP}.
5890
5891 @defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP
5892 C code for a data type which is used for declaring the @code{mdep}
5893 component of @code{cc_status}. It defaults to @code{int}.
5894
5895 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5896 @end defmac
5897
5898 @defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
5899 A C expression to initialize the @code{mdep} field to ``empty''.
5900 The default definition does nothing, since most machines don't use
5901 the field anyway. If you want to use the field, you should probably
5902 define this macro to initialize it.
5903
5904 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5905 @end defmac
5906
5907 @defmac NOTICE_UPDATE_CC (@var{exp}, @var{insn})
5908 A C compound statement to set the components of @code{cc_status}
5909 appropriately for an insn @var{insn} whose body is @var{exp}. It is
5910 this macro's responsibility to recognize insns that set the condition
5911 code as a byproduct of other activity as well as those that explicitly
5912 set @code{(cc0)}.
5913
5914 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5915
5916 If there are insns that do not set the condition code but do alter
5917 other machine registers, this macro must check to see whether they
5918 invalidate the expressions that the condition code is recorded as
5919 reflecting. For example, on the 68000, insns that store in address
5920 registers do not set the condition code, which means that usually
5921 @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} can leave @code{cc_status} unaltered for such
5922 insns. But suppose that the previous insn set the condition code
5923 based on location @samp{a4@@(102)} and the current insn stores a new
5924 value in @samp{a4}. Although the condition code is not changed by
5925 this, it will no longer be true that it reflects the contents of
5926 @samp{a4@@(102)}. Therefore, @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must alter
5927 @code{cc_status} in this case to say that nothing is known about the
5928 condition code value.
5929
5930 The definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must be prepared to deal
5931 with the results of peephole optimization: insns whose patterns are
5932 @code{parallel} RTXs containing various @code{reg}, @code{mem} or
5933 constants which are just the operands. The RTL structure of these
5934 insns is not sufficient to indicate what the insns actually do. What
5935 @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} should do when it sees one is just to run
5936 @code{CC_STATUS_INIT}.
5937
5938 A possible definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} is to call a function
5939 that looks at an attribute (@pxref{Insn Attributes}) named, for example,
5940 @samp{cc}. This avoids having detailed information about patterns in
5941 two places, the @file{md} file and in @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC}.
5942 @end defmac
5943
5944 @node MODE_CC Condition Codes
5945 @subsection Representation of condition codes using registers
5946 @findex CCmode
5947 @findex MODE_CC
5948
5949 @defmac SELECT_CC_MODE (@var{op}, @var{x}, @var{y})
5950 On many machines, the condition code may be produced by other instructions
5951 than compares, for example the branch can use directly the condition
5952 code set by a subtract instruction. However, on some machines
5953 when the condition code is set this way some bits (such as the overflow
5954 bit) are not set in the same way as a test instruction, so that a different
5955 branch instruction must be used for some conditional branches. When
5956 this happens, use the machine mode of the condition code register to
5957 record different formats of the condition code register. Modes can
5958 also be used to record which compare instruction (e.g. a signed or an
5959 unsigned comparison) produced the condition codes.
5960
5961 If other modes than @code{CCmode} are required, add them to
5962 @file{@var{machine}-modes.def} and define @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} to choose
5963 a mode given an operand of a compare. This is needed because the modes
5964 have to be chosen not only during RTL generation but also, for example,
5965 by instruction combination. The result of @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} should
5966 be consistent with the mode used in the patterns; for example to support
5967 the case of the add on the SPARC discussed above, we have the pattern
5968
5969 @smallexample
5970 (define_insn ""
5971 [(set (reg:CC_NOOV 0)
5972 (compare:CC_NOOV
5973 (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "%r")
5974 (match_operand:SI 1 "arith_operand" "rI"))
5975 (const_int 0)))]
5976 ""
5977 "@dots{}")
5978 @end smallexample
5979
5980 @noindent
5981 together with a @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} that returns @code{CC_NOOVmode}
5982 for comparisons whose argument is a @code{plus}:
5983
5984 @smallexample
5985 #define SELECT_CC_MODE(OP,X,Y) \
5986 (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (X)) == MODE_FLOAT \
5987 ? ((OP == EQ || OP == NE) ? CCFPmode : CCFPEmode) \
5988 : ((GET_CODE (X) == PLUS || GET_CODE (X) == MINUS \
5989 || GET_CODE (X) == NEG) \
5990 ? CC_NOOVmode : CCmode))
5991 @end smallexample
5992
5993 Another reason to use modes is to retain information on which operands
5994 were used by the comparison; see @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE} later in
5995 this section.
5996
5997 You should define this macro if and only if you define extra CC modes
5998 in @file{@var{machine}-modes.def}.
5999 @end defmac
6000
6001 @defmac CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON (@var{code}, @var{op0}, @var{op1})
6002 On some machines not all possible comparisons are defined, but you can
6003 convert an invalid comparison into a valid one. For example, the Alpha
6004 does not have a @code{GT} comparison, but you can use an @code{LT}
6005 comparison instead and swap the order of the operands.
6006
6007 On such machines, define this macro to be a C statement to do any
6008 required conversions. @var{code} is the initial comparison code
6009 and @var{op0} and @var{op1} are the left and right operands of the
6010 comparison, respectively. You should modify @var{code}, @var{op0}, and
6011 @var{op1} as required.
6012
6013 GCC will not assume that the comparison resulting from this macro is
6014 valid but will see if the resulting insn matches a pattern in the
6015 @file{md} file.
6016
6017 You need not define this macro if it would never change the comparison
6018 code or operands.
6019 @end defmac
6020
6021 @defmac REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})
6022 A C expression whose value is one if it is always safe to reverse a
6023 comparison whose mode is @var{mode}. If @code{SELECT_CC_MODE}
6024 can ever return @var{mode} for a floating-point inequality comparison,
6025 then @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} must be zero.
6026
6027 You need not define this macro if it would always returns zero or if the
6028 floating-point format is anything other than @code{IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT}.
6029 For example, here is the definition used on the SPARC, where floating-point
6030 inequality comparisons are always given @code{CCFPEmode}:
6031
6032 @smallexample
6033 #define REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE(MODE) ((MODE) != CCFPEmode)
6034 @end smallexample
6035 @end defmac
6036
6037 @defmac REVERSE_CONDITION (@var{code}, @var{mode})
6038 A C expression whose value is reversed condition code of the @var{code} for
6039 comparison done in CC_MODE @var{mode}. The macro is used only in case
6040 @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} is nonzero. Define this macro in case
6041 machine has some non-standard way how to reverse certain conditionals. For
6042 instance in case all floating point conditions are non-trapping, compiler may
6043 freely convert unordered compares to ordered one. Then definition may look
6044 like:
6045
6046 @smallexample
6047 #define REVERSE_CONDITION(CODE, MODE) \
6048 ((MODE) != CCFPmode ? reverse_condition (CODE) \
6049 : reverse_condition_maybe_unordered (CODE))
6050 @end smallexample
6051 @end defmac
6052
6053 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FIXED_CONDITION_CODE_REGS (unsigned int *@var{p1}, unsigned int *@var{p2})
6054 On targets which do not use @code{(cc0)}, and which use a hard
6055 register rather than a pseudo-register to hold condition codes, the
6056 regular CSE passes are often not able to identify cases in which the
6057 hard register is set to a common value. Use this hook to enable a
6058 small pass which optimizes such cases. This hook should return true
6059 to enable this pass, and it should set the integers to which its
6060 arguments point to the hard register numbers used for condition codes.
6061 When there is only one such register, as is true on most systems, the
6062 integer pointed to by @var{p2} should be set to
6063 @code{INVALID_REGNUM}.
6064
6065 The default version of this hook returns false.
6066 @end deftypefn
6067
6068 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_CC_MODES_COMPATIBLE (enum machine_mode @var{m1}, enum machine_mode @var{m2})
6069 On targets which use multiple condition code modes in class
6070 @code{MODE_CC}, it is sometimes the case that a comparison can be
6071 validly done in more than one mode. On such a system, define this
6072 target hook to take two mode arguments and to return a mode in which
6073 both comparisons may be validly done. If there is no such mode,
6074 return @code{VOIDmode}.
6075
6076 The default version of this hook checks whether the modes are the
6077 same. If they are, it returns that mode. If they are different, it
6078 returns @code{VOIDmode}.
6079 @end deftypefn
6080
6081 @node Cond. Exec. Macros
6082 @subsection Macros to control conditional execution
6083 @findex conditional execution
6084 @findex predication
6085
6086 There is one macro that may need to be defined for targets
6087 supporting conditional execution, independent of how they
6088 represent conditional branches.
6089
6090 @defmac REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P (@var{op1}, @var{op2})
6091 A C expression that returns true if the conditional execution predicate
6092 @var{op1}, a comparison operation, is the inverse of @var{op2} and vice
6093 versa. Define this to return 0 if the target has conditional execution
6094 predicates that cannot be reversed safely. There is no need to validate
6095 that the arguments of op1 and op2 are the same, this is done separately.
6096 If no expansion is specified, this macro is defined as follows:
6097
6098 @smallexample
6099 #define REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P (x, y) \
6100 (GET_CODE ((x)) == reversed_comparison_code ((y), NULL))
6101 @end smallexample
6102 @end defmac
6103
6104 @node Costs
6105 @section Describing Relative Costs of Operations
6106 @cindex costs of instructions
6107 @cindex relative costs
6108 @cindex speed of instructions
6109
6110 These macros let you describe the relative speed of various operations
6111 on the target machine.
6112
6113 @defmac REGISTER_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{from}, @var{to})
6114 A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} from a
6115 register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes are
6116 expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}. A
6117 value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6118 that.
6119
6120 It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6121 same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6122 registers if they are not general registers.
6123
6124 If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6125 hard registers, and if @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6126 classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6127 constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6128 allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6129 if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6130
6131 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6132 @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} instead.
6133 @end defmac
6134
6135 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, reg_class_t @var{from}, reg_class_t @var{to})
6136 This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6137 from a register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes
6138 are expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
6139 A value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6140 that.
6141
6142 It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6143 same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6144 registers if they are not general registers.
6145
6146 If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6147 hard registers, and if @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6148 classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6149 constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6150 allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6151 if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6152
6153 The default version of this function returns 2.
6154 @end deftypefn
6155
6156 @defmac MEMORY_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{class}, @var{in})
6157 A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} between a
6158 register of class @var{class} and memory; @var{in} is zero if the value
6159 is to be written to memory, nonzero if it is to be read in. This cost
6160 is relative to those in @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST}. If moving between
6161 registers and memory is more expensive than between two registers, you
6162 should define this macro to express the relative cost.
6163
6164 If you do not define this macro, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6165 the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6166 needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6167 between memory and a register of @var{class} but the reload mechanism is
6168 more complex than copying via an intermediate, define this macro to
6169 reflect the actual cost of the move.
6170
6171 GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6172 secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6173 a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6174 secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
6175 4 is not correct for your machine, define this macro to add some other
6176 value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6177 are the same as to this macro.
6178
6179 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6180 @code{TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST} instead.
6181 @end defmac
6182
6183 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, reg_class_t @var{rclass}, bool @var{in})
6184 This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6185 between a register of class @var{rclass} and memory; @var{in} is @code{false}
6186 if the value is to be written to memory, @code{true} if it is to be read in.
6187 This cost is relative to those in @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST}.
6188 If moving between registers and memory is more expensive than between two
6189 registers, you should add this target hook to express the relative cost.
6190
6191 If you do not add this target hook, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6192 the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6193 needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6194 between memory and a register of @var{rclass} but the reload mechanism is
6195 more complex than copying via an intermediate, use this target hook to
6196 reflect the actual cost of the move.
6197
6198 GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6199 secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6200 a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6201 secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
6202 4 is not correct for your machine, use this target hook to add some other
6203 value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6204 are the same as to this target hook.
6205 @end deftypefn
6206
6207 @defmac BRANCH_COST (@var{speed_p}, @var{predictable_p})
6208 A C expression for the cost of a branch instruction. A value of 1 is the
6209 default; other values are interpreted relative to that. Parameter @var{speed_p}
6210 is true when the branch in question should be optimized for speed. When
6211 it is false, @code{BRANCH_COST} should be returning value optimal for code size
6212 rather then performance considerations. @var{predictable_p} is true for well
6213 predictable branches. On many architectures the @code{BRANCH_COST} can be
6214 reduced then.
6215 @end defmac
6216
6217 Here are additional macros which do not specify precise relative costs,
6218 but only that certain actions are more expensive than GCC would
6219 ordinarily expect.
6220
6221 @defmac SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
6222 Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if accessing less
6223 than a word of memory (i.e.@: a @code{char} or a @code{short}) is no
6224 faster than accessing a word of memory, i.e., if such access
6225 require more than one instruction or if there is no difference in cost
6226 between byte and (aligned) word loads.
6227
6228 When this macro is not defined, the compiler will access a field by
6229 finding the smallest containing object; when it is defined, a fullword
6230 load will be used if alignment permits. Unless bytes accesses are
6231 faster than word accesses, using word accesses is preferable since it
6232 may eliminate subsequent memory access if subsequent accesses occur to
6233 other fields in the same word of the structure, but to different bytes.
6234 @end defmac
6235
6236 @defmac SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (@var{mode}, @var{alignment})
6237 Define this macro to be the value 1 if memory accesses described by the
6238 @var{mode} and @var{alignment} parameters have a cost many times greater
6239 than aligned accesses, for example if they are emulated in a trap
6240 handler.
6241
6242 When this macro is nonzero, the compiler will act as if
6243 @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} were nonzero when generating code for block
6244 moves. This can cause significantly more instructions to be produced.
6245 Therefore, do not set this macro nonzero if unaligned accesses only add a
6246 cycle or two to the time for a memory access.
6247
6248 If the value of this macro is always zero, it need not be defined. If
6249 this macro is defined, it should produce a nonzero value when
6250 @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} is nonzero.
6251 @end defmac
6252
6253 @defmac MOVE_RATIO (@var{speed})
6254 The threshold of number of scalar memory-to-memory move insns, @emph{below}
6255 which a sequence of insns should be generated instead of a
6256 string move insn or a library call. Increasing the value will always
6257 make code faster, but eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6258
6259 Note that on machines where the corresponding move insn is a
6260 @code{define_expand} that emits a sequence of insns, this macro counts
6261 the number of such sequences.
6262
6263 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6264 optimized for speed rather than size.
6265
6266 If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6267 @end defmac
6268
6269 @defmac MOVE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6270 A C expression used to determine whether @code{move_by_pieces} will be used to
6271 copy a chunk of memory, or whether some other block move mechanism
6272 will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6273 than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6274 @end defmac
6275
6276 @defmac MOVE_MAX_PIECES
6277 A C expression used by @code{move_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
6278 a load or store used to copy memory is. Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX}.
6279 @end defmac
6280
6281 @defmac CLEAR_RATIO (@var{speed})
6282 The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6283 of insns should be generated to clear memory instead of a string clear insn
6284 or a library call. Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6285 eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6286
6287 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6288 optimized for speed rather than size.
6289
6290 If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6291 @end defmac
6292
6293 @defmac CLEAR_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6294 A C expression used to determine whether @code{clear_by_pieces} will be used
6295 to clear a chunk of memory, or whether some other block clear mechanism
6296 will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6297 than @code{CLEAR_RATIO}.
6298 @end defmac
6299
6300 @defmac SET_RATIO (@var{speed})
6301 The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6302 of insns should be generated to set memory to a constant value, instead of
6303 a block set insn or a library call.
6304 Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6305 eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6306
6307 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6308 optimized for speed rather than size.
6309
6310 If you don't define this, it defaults to the value of @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6311 @end defmac
6312
6313 @defmac SET_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6314 A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
6315 used to set a chunk of memory to a constant value, or whether some
6316 other mechanism will be used. Used by @code{__builtin_memset} when
6317 storing values other than constant zero.
6318 Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6319 than @code{SET_RATIO}.
6320 @end defmac
6321
6322 @defmac STORE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6323 A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
6324 used to set a chunk of memory to a constant string value, or whether some
6325 other mechanism will be used. Used by @code{__builtin_strcpy} when
6326 called with a constant source string.
6327 Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6328 than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6329 @end defmac
6330
6331 @defmac USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6332 A C expression used to determine whether a load postincrement is a good
6333 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6334 @code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6335 @end defmac
6336
6337 @defmac USE_LOAD_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6338 A C expression used to determine whether a load postdecrement is a good
6339 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6340 @code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6341 @end defmac
6342
6343 @defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6344 A C expression used to determine whether a load preincrement is a good
6345 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6346 @code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6347 @end defmac
6348
6349 @defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6350 A C expression used to determine whether a load predecrement is a good
6351 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6352 @code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6353 @end defmac
6354
6355 @defmac USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6356 A C expression used to determine whether a store postincrement is a good
6357 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6358 @code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6359 @end defmac
6360
6361 @defmac USE_STORE_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6362 A C expression used to determine whether a store postdecrement is a good
6363 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6364 @code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6365 @end defmac
6366
6367 @defmac USE_STORE_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6368 This macro is used to determine whether a store preincrement is a good
6369 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6370 @code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6371 @end defmac
6372
6373 @defmac USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6374 This macro is used to determine whether a store predecrement is a good
6375 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6376 @code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6377 @end defmac
6378
6379 @defmac NO_FUNCTION_CSE
6380 Define this macro if it is as good or better to call a constant
6381 function address than to call an address kept in a register.
6382 @end defmac
6383
6384 @defmac RANGE_TEST_NON_SHORT_CIRCUIT
6385 Define this macro if a non-short-circuit operation produced by
6386 @samp{fold_range_test ()} is optimal. This macro defaults to true if
6387 @code{BRANCH_COST} is greater than or equal to the value 2.
6388 @end defmac
6389
6390 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RTX_COSTS (rtx @var{x}, int @var{code}, int @var{outer_code}, int *@var{total}, bool @var{speed})
6391 This target hook describes the relative costs of RTL expressions.
6392
6393 The cost may depend on the precise form of the expression, which is
6394 available for examination in @var{x}, and the rtx code of the expression
6395 in which it is contained, found in @var{outer_code}. @var{code} is the
6396 expression code---redundant, since it can be obtained with
6397 @code{GET_CODE (@var{x})}.
6398
6399 In implementing this hook, you can use the construct
6400 @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (@var{n})} to specify a cost equal to @var{n} fast
6401 instructions.
6402
6403 On entry to the hook, @code{*@var{total}} contains a default estimate
6404 for the cost of the expression. The hook should modify this value as
6405 necessary. Traditionally, the default costs are @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (5)}
6406 for multiplications, @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (7)} for division and modulus
6407 operations, and @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (1)} for all other operations.
6408
6409 When optimizing for code size, i.e.@: when @code{speed} is
6410 false, this target hook should be used to estimate the relative
6411 size cost of an expression, again relative to @code{COSTS_N_INSNS}.
6412
6413 The hook returns true when all subexpressions of @var{x} have been
6414 processed, and false when @code{rtx_cost} should recurse.
6415 @end deftypefn
6416
6417 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ADDRESS_COST (rtx @var{address}, bool @var{speed})
6418 This hook computes the cost of an addressing mode that contains
6419 @var{address}. If not defined, the cost is computed from
6420 the @var{address} expression and the @code{TARGET_RTX_COST} hook.
6421
6422 For most CISC machines, the default cost is a good approximation of the
6423 true cost of the addressing mode. However, on RISC machines, all
6424 instructions normally have the same length and execution time. Hence
6425 all addresses will have equal costs.
6426
6427 In cases where more than one form of an address is known, the form with
6428 the lowest cost will be used. If multiple forms have the same, lowest,
6429 cost, the one that is the most complex will be used.
6430
6431 For example, suppose an address that is equal to the sum of a register
6432 and a constant is used twice in the same basic block. When this macro
6433 is not defined, the address will be computed in a register and memory
6434 references will be indirect through that register. On machines where
6435 the cost of the addressing mode containing the sum is no higher than
6436 that of a simple indirect reference, this will produce an additional
6437 instruction and possibly require an additional register. Proper
6438 specification of this macro eliminates this overhead for such machines.
6439
6440 This hook is never called with an invalid address.
6441
6442 On machines where an address involving more than one register is as
6443 cheap as an address computation involving only one register, defining
6444 @code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} to reflect this can cause two registers to
6445 be live over a region of code where only one would have been if
6446 @code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} were not defined in that manner. This effect
6447 should be considered in the definition of this macro. Equivalent costs
6448 should probably only be given to addresses with different numbers of
6449 registers on machines with lots of registers.
6450 @end deftypefn
6451
6452 @node Scheduling
6453 @section Adjusting the Instruction Scheduler
6454
6455 The instruction scheduler may need a fair amount of machine-specific
6456 adjustment in order to produce good code. GCC provides several target
6457 hooks for this purpose. It is usually enough to define just a few of
6458 them: try the first ones in this list first.
6459
6460 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE (void)
6461 This hook returns the maximum number of instructions that can ever
6462 issue at the same time on the target machine. The default is one.
6463 Although the insn scheduler can define itself the possibility of issue
6464 an insn on the same cycle, the value can serve as an additional
6465 constraint to issue insns on the same simulated processor cycle (see
6466 hooks @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER} and @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}).
6467 This value must be constant over the entire compilation. If you need
6468 it to vary depending on what the instructions are, you must use
6469 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}.
6470 @end deftypefn
6471
6472 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx @var{insn}, int @var{more})
6473 This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled an insn
6474 from the ready list. It should return the number of insns which can
6475 still be issued in the current cycle. The default is
6476 @samp{@w{@var{more} - 1}} for insns other than @code{CLOBBER} and
6477 @code{USE}, which normally are not counted against the issue rate.
6478 You should define this hook if some insns take more machine resources
6479 than others, so that fewer insns can follow them in the same cycle.
6480 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6481 debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6482 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{insn} is the instruction that
6483 was scheduled.
6484 @end deftypefn
6485
6486 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST (rtx @var{insn}, rtx @var{link}, rtx @var{dep_insn}, int @var{cost})
6487 This function corrects the value of @var{cost} based on the
6488 relationship between @var{insn} and @var{dep_insn} through the
6489 dependence @var{link}. It should return the new value. The default
6490 is to make no adjustment to @var{cost}. This can be used for example
6491 to specify to the scheduler using the traditional pipeline description
6492 that an output- or anti-dependence does not incur the same cost as a
6493 data-dependence. If the scheduler using the automaton based pipeline
6494 description, the cost of anti-dependence is zero and the cost of
6495 output-dependence is maximum of one and the difference of latency
6496 times of the first and the second insns. If these values are not
6497 acceptable, you could use the hook to modify them too. See also
6498 @pxref{Processor pipeline description}.
6499 @end deftypefn
6500
6501 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_PRIORITY (rtx @var{insn}, int @var{priority})
6502 This hook adjusts the integer scheduling priority @var{priority} of
6503 @var{insn}. It should return the new priority. Increase the priority to
6504 execute @var{insn} earlier, reduce the priority to execute @var{insn}
6505 later. Do not define this hook if you do not need to adjust the
6506 scheduling priorities of insns.
6507 @end deftypefn
6508
6509 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx *@var{ready}, int *@var{n_readyp}, int @var{clock})
6510 This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled the ready
6511 list, to allow the machine description to reorder it (for example to
6512 combine two small instructions together on @samp{VLIW} machines).
6513 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6514 debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6515 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{ready} is a pointer to the ready
6516 list of instructions that are ready to be scheduled. @var{n_readyp} is
6517 a pointer to the number of elements in the ready list. The scheduler
6518 reads the ready list in reverse order, starting with
6519 @var{ready}[@var{*n_readyp} @minus{} 1] and going to @var{ready}[0]. @var{clock}
6520 is the timer tick of the scheduler. You may modify the ready list and
6521 the number of ready insns. The return value is the number of insns that
6522 can issue this cycle; normally this is just @code{issue_rate}. See also
6523 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}.
6524 @end deftypefn
6525
6526 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2 (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx *@var{ready}, int *@var{n_readyp}, int @var{clock})
6527 Like @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}, but called at a different time. That
6528 function is called whenever the scheduler starts a new cycle. This one
6529 is called once per iteration over a cycle, immediately after
6530 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}; it can reorder the ready list and
6531 return the number of insns to be scheduled in the same cycle. Defining
6532 this hook can be useful if there are frequent situations where
6533 scheduling one insn causes other insns to become ready in the same
6534 cycle. These other insns can then be taken into account properly.
6535 @end deftypefn
6536
6537 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DEPENDENCIES_EVALUATION_HOOK (rtx @var{head}, rtx @var{tail})
6538 This hook is called after evaluation forward dependencies of insns in
6539 chain given by two parameter values (@var{head} and @var{tail}
6540 correspondingly) but before insns scheduling of the insn chain. For
6541 example, it can be used for better insn classification if it requires
6542 analysis of dependencies. This hook can use backward and forward
6543 dependencies of the insn scheduler because they are already
6544 calculated.
6545 @end deftypefn
6546
6547 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{max_ready})
6548 This hook is executed by the scheduler at the beginning of each block of
6549 instructions that are to be scheduled. @var{file} is either a null
6550 pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to. @var{verbose}
6551 is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6552 @var{max_ready} is the maximum number of insns in the current scheduling
6553 region that can be live at the same time. This can be used to allocate
6554 scratch space if it is needed, e.g.@: by @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}.
6555 @end deftypefn
6556
6557 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose})
6558 This hook is executed by the scheduler at the end of each block of
6559 instructions that are to be scheduled. It can be used to perform
6560 cleanup of any actions done by the other scheduling hooks. @var{file}
6561 is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output
6562 to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6563 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6564 @end deftypefn
6565
6566 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{old_max_uid})
6567 This hook is executed by the scheduler after function level initializations.
6568 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6569 @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6570 @var{old_max_uid} is the maximum insn uid when scheduling begins.
6571 @end deftypefn
6572
6573 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH_GLOBAL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose})
6574 This is the cleanup hook corresponding to @code{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL}.
6575 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6576 @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6577 @end deftypefn
6578
6579 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6580 The hook returns an RTL insn. The automaton state used in the
6581 pipeline hazard recognizer is changed as if the insn were scheduled
6582 when the new simulated processor cycle starts. Usage of the hook may
6583 simplify the automaton pipeline description for some @acronym{VLIW}
6584 processors. If the hook is defined, it is used only for the automaton
6585 based pipeline description. The default is not to change the state
6586 when the new simulated processor cycle starts.
6587 @end deftypefn
6588
6589 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6590 The hook can be used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6591 @end deftypefn
6592
6593 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6594 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6595 to changed the state as if the insn were scheduled when the new
6596 simulated processor cycle finishes.
6597 @end deftypefn
6598
6599 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6600 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but
6601 used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6602 @end deftypefn
6603
6604 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_ADVANCE_CYCLE (void)
6605 The hook to notify target that the current simulated cycle is about to finish.
6606 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6607 to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6608 state on a single insn is not enough.
6609 @end deftypefn
6610
6611 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_ADVANCE_CYCLE (void)
6612 The hook to notify target that new simulated cycle has just started.
6613 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6614 to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6615 state on a single insn is not enough.
6616 @end deftypefn
6617
6618 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD (void)
6619 This hook controls better choosing an insn from the ready insn queue
6620 for the @acronym{DFA}-based insn scheduler. Usually the scheduler
6621 chooses the first insn from the queue. If the hook returns a positive
6622 value, an additional scheduler code tries all permutations of
6623 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD ()}
6624 subsequent ready insns to choose an insn whose issue will result in
6625 maximal number of issued insns on the same cycle. For the
6626 @acronym{VLIW} processor, the code could actually solve the problem of
6627 packing simple insns into the @acronym{VLIW} insn. Of course, if the
6628 rules of @acronym{VLIW} packing are described in the automaton.
6629
6630 This code also could be used for superscalar @acronym{RISC}
6631 processors. Let us consider a superscalar @acronym{RISC} processor
6632 with 3 pipelines. Some insns can be executed in pipelines @var{A} or
6633 @var{B}, some insns can be executed only in pipelines @var{B} or
6634 @var{C}, and one insn can be executed in pipeline @var{B}. The
6635 processor may issue the 1st insn into @var{A} and the 2nd one into
6636 @var{B}. In this case, the 3rd insn will wait for freeing @var{B}
6637 until the next cycle. If the scheduler issues the 3rd insn the first,
6638 the processor could issue all 3 insns per cycle.
6639
6640 Actually this code demonstrates advantages of the automaton based
6641 pipeline hazard recognizer. We try quickly and easy many insn
6642 schedules to choose the best one.
6643
6644 The default is no multipass scheduling.
6645 @end deftypefn
6646
6647 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD (rtx @var{insn})
6648
6649 This hook controls what insns from the ready insn queue will be
6650 considered for the multipass insn scheduling. If the hook returns
6651 zero for @var{insn}, the insn will be not chosen to
6652 be issued.
6653
6654 The default is that any ready insns can be chosen to be issued.
6655 @end deftypefn
6656
6657 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_DFA_NEW_CYCLE (FILE *@var{dump}, int @var{verbose}, rtx @var{insn}, int @var{last_clock}, int @var{clock}, int *@var{sort_p})
6658 This hook is called by the insn scheduler before issuing @var{insn}
6659 on cycle @var{clock}. If the hook returns nonzero,
6660 @var{insn} is not issued on this processor cycle. Instead,
6661 the processor cycle is advanced. If *@var{sort_p}
6662 is zero, the insn ready queue is not sorted on the new cycle
6663 start as usually. @var{dump} and @var{verbose} specify the file and
6664 verbosity level to use for debugging output.
6665 @var{last_clock} and @var{clock} are, respectively, the
6666 processor cycle on which the previous insn has been issued,
6667 and the current processor cycle.
6668 @end deftypefn
6669
6670 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_IS_COSTLY_DEPENDENCE (struct _dep *@var{_dep}, int @var{cost}, int @var{distance})
6671 This hook is used to define which dependences are considered costly by
6672 the target, so costly that it is not advisable to schedule the insns that
6673 are involved in the dependence too close to one another. The parameters
6674 to this hook are as follows: The first parameter @var{_dep} is the dependence
6675 being evaluated. The second parameter @var{cost} is the cost of the
6676 dependence as estimated by the scheduler, and the third
6677 parameter @var{distance} is the distance in cycles between the two insns.
6678 The hook returns @code{true} if considering the distance between the two
6679 insns the dependence between them is considered costly by the target,
6680 and @code{false} otherwise.
6681
6682 Defining this hook can be useful in multiple-issue out-of-order machines,
6683 where (a) it's practically hopeless to predict the actual data/resource
6684 delays, however: (b) there's a better chance to predict the actual grouping
6685 that will be formed, and (c) correctly emulating the grouping can be very
6686 important. In such targets one may want to allow issuing dependent insns
6687 closer to one another---i.e., closer than the dependence distance; however,
6688 not in cases of ``costly dependences'', which this hooks allows to define.
6689 @end deftypefn
6690
6691 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_H_I_D_EXTENDED (void)
6692 This hook is called by the insn scheduler after emitting a new instruction to
6693 the instruction stream. The hook notifies a target backend to extend its
6694 per instruction data structures.
6695 @end deftypefn
6696
6697 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_SCHED_ALLOC_SCHED_CONTEXT (void)
6698 Return a pointer to a store large enough to hold target scheduling context.
6699 @end deftypefn
6700
6701 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc}, bool @var{clean_p})
6702 Initialize store pointed to by @var{tc} to hold target scheduling context.
6703 It @var{clean_p} is true then initialize @var{tc} as if scheduler is at the
6704 beginning of the block. Otherwise, copy the current context into @var{tc}.
6705 @end deftypefn
6706
6707 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
6708 Copy target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc} to the current context.
6709 @end deftypefn
6710
6711 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_CLEAR_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
6712 Deallocate internal data in target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6713 @end deftypefn
6714
6715 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FREE_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
6716 Deallocate a store for target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6717 @end deftypefn
6718
6719 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_SPECULATE_INSN (rtx @var{insn}, int @var{request}, rtx *@var{new_pat})
6720 This hook is called by the insn scheduler when @var{insn} has only
6721 speculative dependencies and therefore can be scheduled speculatively.
6722 The hook is used to check if the pattern of @var{insn} has a speculative
6723 version and, in case of successful check, to generate that speculative
6724 pattern. The hook should return 1, if the instruction has a speculative form,
6725 or @minus{}1, if it doesn't. @var{request} describes the type of requested
6726 speculation. If the return value equals 1 then @var{new_pat} is assigned
6727 the generated speculative pattern.
6728 @end deftypefn
6729
6730 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_NEEDS_BLOCK_P (int @var{dep_status})
6731 This hook is called by the insn scheduler during generation of recovery code
6732 for @var{insn}. It should return @code{true}, if the corresponding check
6733 instruction should branch to recovery code, or @code{false} otherwise.
6734 @end deftypefn
6735
6736 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_GEN_SPEC_CHECK (rtx @var{insn}, rtx @var{label}, int @var{mutate_p})
6737 This hook is called by the insn scheduler to generate a pattern for recovery
6738 check instruction. If @var{mutate_p} is zero, then @var{insn} is a
6739 speculative instruction for which the check should be generated.
6740 @var{label} is either a label of a basic block, where recovery code should
6741 be emitted, or a null pointer, when requested check doesn't branch to
6742 recovery code (a simple check). If @var{mutate_p} is nonzero, then
6743 a pattern for a branchy check corresponding to a simple check denoted by
6744 @var{insn} should be generated. In this case @var{label} can't be null.
6745 @end deftypefn
6746
6747 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD_SPEC (const_rtx @var{insn})
6748 This hook is used as a workaround for
6749 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD} not being
6750 called on the first instruction of the ready list. The hook is used to
6751 discard speculative instructions that stand first in the ready list from
6752 being scheduled on the current cycle. If the hook returns @code{false},
6753 @var{insn} will not be chosen to be issued.
6754 For non-speculative instructions,
6755 the hook should always return @code{true}. For example, in the ia64 backend
6756 the hook is used to cancel data speculative insns when the ALAT table
6757 is nearly full.
6758 @end deftypefn
6759
6760 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_FLAGS (struct spec_info_def *@var{spec_info})
6761 This hook is used by the insn scheduler to find out what features should be
6762 enabled/used.
6763 The structure *@var{spec_info} should be filled in by the target.
6764 The structure describes speculation types that can be used in the scheduler.
6765 @end deftypefn
6766
6767 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_SMS_RES_MII (struct ddg *@var{g})
6768 This hook is called by the swing modulo scheduler to calculate a
6769 resource-based lower bound which is based on the resources available in
6770 the machine and the resources required by each instruction. The target
6771 backend can use @var{g} to calculate such bound. A very simple lower
6772 bound will be used in case this hook is not implemented: the total number
6773 of instructions divided by the issue rate.
6774 @end deftypefn
6775
6776 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH (rtx @var{insn}, int @var{x})
6777 This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It returns true if dispatch scheduling
6778 is supported in hardware and the condition specified in the parameter is true.
6779 @end deftypefn
6780
6781 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH_DO (rtx @var{insn}, int @var{x})
6782 This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It performs the operation specified
6783 in its second parameter.
6784 @end deftypefn
6785
6786 @node Sections
6787 @section Dividing the Output into Sections (Texts, Data, @dots{})
6788 @c the above section title is WAY too long. maybe cut the part between
6789 @c the (...)? --mew 10feb93
6790
6791 An object file is divided into sections containing different types of
6792 data. In the most common case, there are three sections: the @dfn{text
6793 section}, which holds instructions and read-only data; the @dfn{data
6794 section}, which holds initialized writable data; and the @dfn{bss
6795 section}, which holds uninitialized data. Some systems have other kinds
6796 of sections.
6797
6798 @file{varasm.c} provides several well-known sections, such as
6799 @code{text_section}, @code{data_section} and @code{bss_section}.
6800 The normal way of controlling a @code{@var{foo}_section} variable
6801 is to define the associated @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macro,
6802 as described below. The macros are only read once, when @file{varasm.c}
6803 initializes itself, so their values must be run-time constants.
6804 They may however depend on command-line flags.
6805
6806 @emph{Note:} Some run-time files, such @file{crtstuff.c}, also make
6807 use of the @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macros, and expect them
6808 to be string literals.
6809
6810 Some assemblers require a different string to be written every time a
6811 section is selected. If your assembler falls into this category, you
6812 should define the @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS} hook and use
6813 @code{get_unnamed_section} to set up the sections.
6814
6815 You must always create a @code{text_section}, either by defining
6816 @code{TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or by initializing @code{text_section}
6817 in @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS}. The same is true of
6818 @code{data_section} and @code{DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP}. If you do not
6819 create a distinct @code{readonly_data_section}, the default is to
6820 reuse @code{text_section}.
6821
6822 All the other @file{varasm.c} sections are optional, and are null
6823 if the target does not provide them.
6824
6825 @defmac TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6826 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6827 assembler operation that should precede instructions and read-only data.
6828 Normally @code{"\t.text"} is right.
6829 @end defmac
6830
6831 @defmac HOT_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6832 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing most
6833 frequently executed functions of the program. If not defined, GCC will provide
6834 a default definition if the target supports named sections.
6835 @end defmac
6836
6837 @defmac UNLIKELY_EXECUTED_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6838 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing unlikely
6839 executed functions in the program.
6840 @end defmac
6841
6842 @defmac DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6843 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6844 assembler operation to identify the following data as writable initialized
6845 data. Normally @code{"\t.data"} is right.
6846 @end defmac
6847
6848 @defmac SDATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6849 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6850 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6851 initialized, writable small data.
6852 @end defmac
6853
6854 @defmac READONLY_DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6855 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6856 assembler operation to identify the following data as read-only initialized
6857 data.
6858 @end defmac
6859
6860 @defmac BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
6861 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6862 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6863 uninitialized global data. If not defined, and neither
6864 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS} nor @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} are defined,
6865 uninitialized global data will be output in the data section if
6866 @option{-fno-common} is passed, otherwise @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} will be
6867 used.
6868 @end defmac
6869
6870 @defmac SBSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
6871 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6872 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6873 uninitialized, writable small data.
6874 @end defmac
6875
6876 @defmac TLS_COMMON_ASM_OP
6877 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string containing the
6878 assembler operation to identify the following data as thread-local
6879 common data. The default is @code{".tls_common"}.
6880 @end defmac
6881
6882 @defmac TLS_SECTION_ASM_FLAG
6883 If defined, a C expression whose value is a character constant
6884 containing the flag used to mark a section as a TLS section. The
6885 default is @code{'T'}.
6886 @end defmac
6887
6888 @defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6889 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6890 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6891 initialization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
6892 not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{init_section}
6893 variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
6894 @end defmac
6895
6896 @defmac FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP
6897 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6898 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6899 finalization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
6900 not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{fini_section}
6901 variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
6902 @end defmac
6903
6904 @defmac INIT_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
6905 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6906 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6907 part of the @code{.init_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
6908 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
6909 both this macro and @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6910 @end defmac
6911
6912 @defmac FINI_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
6913 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6914 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6915 part of the @code{.fini_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
6916 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
6917 both this macro and @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6918 @end defmac
6919
6920 @defmac CRT_CALL_STATIC_FUNCTION (@var{section_op}, @var{function})
6921 If defined, an ASM statement that switches to a different section
6922 via @var{section_op}, calls @var{function}, and switches back to
6923 the text section. This is used in @file{crtstuff.c} if
6924 @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP} to calls
6925 to initialization and finalization functions from the init and fini
6926 sections. By default, this macro uses a simple function call. Some
6927 ports need hand-crafted assembly code to avoid dependencies on
6928 registers initialized in the function prologue or to ensure that
6929 constant pools don't end up too far way in the text section.
6930 @end defmac
6931
6932 @defmac TARGET_LIBGCC_SDATA_SECTION
6933 If defined, a string which names the section into which small
6934 variables defined in crtstuff and libgcc should go. This is useful
6935 when the target has options for optimizing access to small data, and
6936 you want the crtstuff and libgcc routines to be conservative in what
6937 they expect of your application yet liberal in what your application
6938 expects. For example, for targets with a @code{.sdata} section (like
6939 MIPS), you could compile crtstuff with @code{-G 0} so that it doesn't
6940 require small data support from your application, but use this macro
6941 to put small data into @code{.sdata} so that your application can
6942 access these variables whether it uses small data or not.
6943 @end defmac
6944
6945 @defmac FORCE_CODE_SECTION_ALIGN
6946 If defined, an ASM statement that aligns a code section to some
6947 arbitrary boundary. This is used to force all fragments of the
6948 @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections to have to same alignment
6949 and thus prevent the linker from having to add any padding.
6950 @end defmac
6951
6952 @defmac JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
6953 Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if jump
6954 tables (for @code{tablejump} insns) should be output in the text
6955 section, along with the assembler instructions. Otherwise, the
6956 readonly data section is used.
6957
6958 This macro is irrelevant if there is no separate readonly data section.
6959 @end defmac
6960
6961 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS (void)
6962 Define this hook if you need to do something special to set up the
6963 @file{varasm.c} sections, or if your target has some special sections
6964 of its own that you need to create.
6965
6966 GCC calls this hook after processing the command line, but before writing
6967 any assembly code, and before calling any of the section-returning hooks
6968 described below.
6969 @end deftypefn
6970
6971 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_RELOC_RW_MASK (void)
6972 Return a mask describing how relocations should be treated when
6973 selecting sections. Bit 1 should be set if global relocations
6974 should be placed in a read-write section; bit 0 should be set if
6975 local relocations should be placed in a read-write section.
6976
6977 The default version of this function returns 3 when @option{-fpic}
6978 is in effect, and 0 otherwise. The hook is typically redefined
6979 when the target cannot support (some kinds of) dynamic relocations
6980 in read-only sections even in executables.
6981 @end deftypefn
6982
6983 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION (tree @var{exp}, int @var{reloc}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align})
6984 Return the section into which @var{exp} should be placed. You can
6985 assume that @var{exp} is either a @code{VAR_DECL} node or a constant of
6986 some sort. @var{reloc} indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp}
6987 requires link-time relocations. Bit 0 is set when variable contains
6988 local relocations only, while bit 1 is set for global relocations.
6989 @var{align} is the constant alignment in bits.
6990
6991 The default version of this function takes care of putting read-only
6992 variables in @code{readonly_data_section}.
6993
6994 See also @var{USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS}.
6995 @end deftypefn
6996
6997 @defmac USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS
6998 Define this macro if you wish TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION to be called
6999 for @code{FUNCTION_DECL}s as well as for variables and constants.
7000
7001 In the case of a @code{FUNCTION_DECL}, @var{reloc} will be zero if the
7002 function has been determined to be likely to be called, and nonzero if
7003 it is unlikely to be called.
7004 @end defmac
7005
7006 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_UNIQUE_SECTION (tree @var{decl}, int @var{reloc})
7007 Build up a unique section name, expressed as a @code{STRING_CST} node,
7008 and assign it to @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
7009 As with @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION}, @var{reloc} indicates whether
7010 the initial value of @var{exp} requires link-time relocations.
7011
7012 The default version of this function appends the symbol name to the
7013 ELF section name that would normally be used for the symbol. For
7014 example, the function @code{foo} would be placed in @code{.text.foo}.
7015 Whatever the actual target object format, this is often good enough.
7016 @end deftypefn
7017
7018 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_RODATA_SECTION (tree @var{decl})
7019 Return the readonly data section associated with
7020 @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
7021 The default version of this function selects @code{.gnu.linkonce.r.name} if
7022 the function's section is @code{.gnu.linkonce.t.name}, @code{.rodata.name}
7023 if function is in @code{.text.name}, and the normal readonly-data section
7024 otherwise.
7025 @end deftypefn
7026
7027 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_SELECT_RTX_SECTION (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align})
7028 Return the section into which a constant @var{x}, of mode @var{mode},
7029 should be placed. You can assume that @var{x} is some kind of
7030 constant in RTL@. The argument @var{mode} is redundant except in the
7031 case of a @code{const_int} rtx. @var{align} is the constant alignment
7032 in bits.
7033
7034 The default version of this function takes care of putting symbolic
7035 constants in @code{flag_pic} mode in @code{data_section} and everything
7036 else in @code{readonly_data_section}.
7037 @end deftypefn
7038
7039 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MANGLE_DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (tree @var{decl}, tree @var{id})
7040 Define this hook if you need to postprocess the assembler name generated
7041 by target-independent code. The @var{id} provided to this hook will be
7042 the computed name (e.g., the macro @code{DECL_NAME} of the @var{decl} in C,
7043 or the mangled name of the @var{decl} in C++). The return value of the
7044 hook is an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE} for the appropriate mangled name on
7045 your target system. The default implementation of this hook just
7046 returns the @var{id} provided.
7047 @end deftypefn
7048
7049 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO (tree @var{decl}, rtx @var{rtl}, int @var{new_decl_p})
7050 Define this hook if references to a symbol or a constant must be
7051 treated differently depending on something about the variable or
7052 function named by the symbol (such as what section it is in).
7053
7054 The hook is executed immediately after rtl has been created for
7055 @var{decl}, which may be a variable or function declaration or
7056 an entry in the constant pool. In either case, @var{rtl} is the
7057 rtl in question. Do @emph{not} use @code{DECL_RTL (@var{decl})}
7058 in this hook; that field may not have been initialized yet.
7059
7060 In the case of a constant, it is safe to assume that the rtl is
7061 a @code{mem} whose address is a @code{symbol_ref}. Most decls
7062 will also have this form, but that is not guaranteed. Global
7063 register variables, for instance, will have a @code{reg} for their
7064 rtl. (Normally the right thing to do with such unusual rtl is
7065 leave it alone.)
7066
7067 The @var{new_decl_p} argument will be true if this is the first time
7068 that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} has been invoked on this decl. It will
7069 be false for subsequent invocations, which will happen for duplicate
7070 declarations. Whether or not anything must be done for the duplicate
7071 declaration depends on whether the hook examines @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.
7072 @var{new_decl_p} is always true when the hook is called for a constant.
7073
7074 @cindex @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}, in @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7075 The usual thing for this hook to do is to record flags in the
7076 @code{symbol_ref}, using @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG} or @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7077 Historically, the name string was modified if it was necessary to
7078 encode more than one bit of information, but this practice is now
7079 discouraged; use @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7080
7081 The default definition of this hook, @code{default_encode_section_info}
7082 in @file{varasm.c}, sets a number of commonly-useful bits in
7083 @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}. Check whether the default does what you need
7084 before overriding it.
7085 @end deftypefn
7086
7087 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING (const char *@var{name})
7088 Decode @var{name} and return the real name part, sans
7089 the characters that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7090 may have added.
7091 @end deftypefn
7092
7093 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P (const_tree @var{exp})
7094 Returns true if @var{exp} should be placed into a ``small data'' section.
7095 The default version of this hook always returns false.
7096 @end deftypefn
7097
7098 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SRODATA_SECTION
7099 Contains the value true if the target places read-only
7100 ``small data'' into a separate section. The default value is false.
7101 @end deftypevr
7102
7103 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE (void)
7104 It returns true if target wants profile code emitted before prologue.
7105
7106 The default version of this hook use the target macro
7107 @code{PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE}.
7108 @end deftypefn
7109
7110 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_BINDS_LOCAL_P (const_tree @var{exp})
7111 Returns true if @var{exp} names an object for which name resolution
7112 rules must resolve to the current ``module'' (dynamic shared library
7113 or executable image).
7114
7115 The default version of this hook implements the name resolution rules
7116 for ELF, which has a looser model of global name binding than other
7117 currently supported object file formats.
7118 @end deftypefn
7119
7120 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_TLS
7121 Contains the value true if the target supports thread-local storage.
7122 The default value is false.
7123 @end deftypevr
7124
7125
7126 @node PIC
7127 @section Position Independent Code
7128 @cindex position independent code
7129 @cindex PIC
7130
7131 This section describes macros that help implement generation of position
7132 independent code. Simply defining these macros is not enough to
7133 generate valid PIC; you must also add support to the hook
7134 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} and to the macro
7135 @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}, as well as @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS}. You
7136 must modify the definition of @samp{movsi} to do something appropriate
7137 when the source operand contains a symbolic address. You may also
7138 need to alter the handling of switch statements so that they use
7139 relative addresses.
7140 @c i rearranged the order of the macros above to try to force one of
7141 @c them to the next line, to eliminate an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
7142
7143 @defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
7144 The register number of the register used to address a table of static
7145 data addresses in memory. In some cases this register is defined by a
7146 processor's ``application binary interface'' (ABI)@. When this macro
7147 is defined, RTL is generated for this register once, as with the stack
7148 pointer and frame pointer registers. If this macro is not defined, it
7149 is up to the machine-dependent files to allocate such a register (if
7150 necessary). Note that this register must be fixed when in use (e.g.@:
7151 when @code{flag_pic} is true).
7152 @end defmac
7153
7154 @defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
7155 A C expression that is nonzero if the register defined by
7156 @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is clobbered by calls. If not defined,
7157 the default is zero. Do not define
7158 this macro if @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is not defined.
7159 @end defmac
7160
7161 @defmac LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (@var{x})
7162 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate immediate
7163 operand on the target machine when generating position independent code.
7164 You can assume that @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not
7165 check this. You can also assume @var{flag_pic} is true, so you need not
7166 check it either. You need not define this macro if all constants
7167 (including @code{SYMBOL_REF}) can be immediate operands when generating
7168 position independent code.
7169 @end defmac
7170
7171 @node Assembler Format
7172 @section Defining the Output Assembler Language
7173
7174 This section describes macros whose principal purpose is to describe how
7175 to write instructions in assembler language---rather than what the
7176 instructions do.
7177
7178 @menu
7179 * File Framework:: Structural information for the assembler file.
7180 * Data Output:: Output of constants (numbers, strings, addresses).
7181 * Uninitialized Data:: Output of uninitialized variables.
7182 * Label Output:: Output and generation of labels.
7183 * Initialization:: General principles of initialization
7184 and termination routines.
7185 * Macros for Initialization::
7186 Specific macros that control the handling of
7187 initialization and termination routines.
7188 * Instruction Output:: Output of actual instructions.
7189 * Dispatch Tables:: Output of jump tables.
7190 * Exception Region Output:: Output of exception region code.
7191 * Alignment Output:: Pseudo ops for alignment and skipping data.
7192 @end menu
7193
7194 @node File Framework
7195 @subsection The Overall Framework of an Assembler File
7196 @cindex assembler format
7197 @cindex output of assembler code
7198
7199 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7200 This describes the overall framework of an assembly file.
7201
7202 @findex default_file_start
7203 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FILE_START (void)
7204 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects to
7205 find at the beginning of a file. The default behavior is controlled
7206 by two flags, documented below. Unless your target's assembler is
7207 quite unusual, if you override the default, you should call
7208 @code{default_file_start} at some point in your target hook. This
7209 lets other target files rely on these variables.
7210 @end deftypefn
7211
7212 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_APP_OFF
7213 If this flag is true, the text of the macro @code{ASM_APP_OFF} will be
7214 printed as the very first line in the assembly file, unless
7215 @option{-fverbose-asm} is in effect. (If that macro has been defined
7216 to the empty string, this variable has no effect.) With the normal
7217 definition of @code{ASM_APP_OFF}, the effect is to notify the GNU
7218 assembler that it need not bother stripping comments or extra
7219 whitespace from its input. This allows it to work a bit faster.
7220
7221 The default is false. You should not set it to true unless you have
7222 verified that your port does not generate any extra whitespace or
7223 comments that will cause GAS to issue errors in NO_APP mode.
7224 @end deftypevr
7225
7226 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_FILE_DIRECTIVE
7227 If this flag is true, @code{output_file_directive} will be called
7228 for the primary source file, immediately after printing
7229 @code{ASM_APP_OFF} (if that is enabled). Most ELF assemblers expect
7230 this to be done. The default is false.
7231 @end deftypevr
7232
7233 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FILE_END (void)
7234 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7235 to find at the end of a file. The default is to output nothing.
7236 @end deftypefn
7237
7238 @deftypefun void file_end_indicate_exec_stack ()
7239 Some systems use a common convention, the @samp{.note.GNU-stack}
7240 special section, to indicate whether or not an object file relies on
7241 the stack being executable. If your system uses this convention, you
7242 should define @code{TARGET_ASM_FILE_END} to this function. If you
7243 need to do other things in that hook, have your hook function call
7244 this function.
7245 @end deftypefun
7246
7247 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_LTO_START (void)
7248 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7249 to find at the start of an LTO section. The default is to output
7250 nothing.
7251 @end deftypefn
7252
7253 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_LTO_END (void)
7254 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7255 to find at the end of an LTO section. The default is to output
7256 nothing.
7257 @end deftypefn
7258
7259 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_CODE_END (void)
7260 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which is needed before emitting
7261 unwind info and debug info at the end of a file. Some targets emit
7262 here PIC setup thunks that cannot be emitted at the end of file,
7263 because they couldn't have unwind info then. The default is to output
7264 nothing.
7265 @end deftypefn
7266
7267 @defmac ASM_COMMENT_START
7268 A C string constant describing how to begin a comment in the target
7269 assembler language. The compiler assumes that the comment will end at
7270 the end of the line.
7271 @end defmac
7272
7273 @defmac ASM_APP_ON
7274 A C string constant for text to be output before each @code{asm}
7275 statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7276 @code{"#APP"}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
7277 assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it must check the lines
7278 that follow for all valid assembler constructs.
7279 @end defmac
7280
7281 @defmac ASM_APP_OFF
7282 A C string constant for text to be output after each @code{asm}
7283 statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7284 @code{"#NO_APP"}, which tells the GNU assembler to resume making the
7285 time-saving assumptions that are valid for ordinary compiler output.
7286 @end defmac
7287
7288 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7289 A C statement to output COFF information or DWARF debugging information
7290 which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to
7291 the stdio stream @var{stream}.
7292
7293 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
7294 for the file format in use is appropriate.
7295 @end defmac
7296
7297 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (FILE *@var{file}, const char *@var{name})
7298 Output COFF information or DWARF debugging information which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to the stdio stream @var{file}.
7299
7300 This target hook need not be defined if the standard form of output for the file format in use is appropriate.
7301 @end deftypefn
7302
7303 @defmac OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING (@var{stream}, @var{string})
7304 A C statement to output the string @var{string} to the stdio stream
7305 @var{stream}. If you do not call the function @code{output_quoted_string}
7306 in your config files, GCC will only call it to output filenames to
7307 the assembler source. So you can use it to canonicalize the format
7308 of the filename using this macro.
7309 @end defmac
7310
7311 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT (@var{stream}, @var{string})
7312 A C statement to output something to the assembler file to handle a
7313 @samp{#ident} directive containing the text @var{string}. If this
7314 macro is not defined, nothing is output for a @samp{#ident} directive.
7315 @end defmac
7316
7317 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION (const char *@var{name}, unsigned int @var{flags}, tree @var{decl})
7318 Output assembly directives to switch to section @var{name}. The section
7319 should have attributes as specified by @var{flags}, which is a bit mask
7320 of the @code{SECTION_*} flags defined in @file{output.h}. If @var{decl}
7321 is non-NULL, it is the @code{VAR_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_DECL} with which
7322 this section is associated.
7323 @end deftypefn
7324
7325 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS
7326 This flag is true if the target supports @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}.
7327 @end deftypevr
7328
7329 @anchor{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}
7330 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS
7331 This flag is true if we can create zeroed data by switching to a BSS
7332 section and then using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} to allocate the space.
7333 This is true on most ELF targets.
7334 @end deftypevr
7335
7336 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS (tree @var{decl}, const char *@var{name}, int @var{reloc})
7337 Choose a set of section attributes for use by @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}
7338 based on a variable or function decl, a section name, and whether or not the
7339 declaration's initializer may contain runtime relocations. @var{decl} may be
7340 null, in which case read-write data should be assumed.
7341
7342 The default version of this function handles choosing code vs data,
7343 read-only vs read-write data, and @code{flag_pic}. You should only
7344 need to override this if your target has special flags that might be
7345 set via @code{__attribute__}.
7346 @end deftypefn
7347
7348 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES (print_switch_type @var{type}, const char *@var{text})
7349 Provides the target with the ability to record the gcc command line
7350 switches that have been passed to the compiler, and options that are
7351 enabled. The @var{type} argument specifies what is being recorded.
7352 It can take the following values:
7353
7354 @table @gcctabopt
7355 @item SWITCH_TYPE_PASSED
7356 @var{text} is a command line switch that has been set by the user.
7357
7358 @item SWITCH_TYPE_ENABLED
7359 @var{text} is an option which has been enabled. This might be as a
7360 direct result of a command line switch, or because it is enabled by
7361 default or because it has been enabled as a side effect of a different
7362 command line switch. For example, the @option{-O2} switch enables
7363 various different individual optimization passes.
7364
7365 @item SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE
7366 @var{text} is either NULL or some descriptive text which should be
7367 ignored. If @var{text} is NULL then it is being used to warn the
7368 target hook that either recording is starting or ending. The first
7369 time @var{type} is SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE and @var{text} is NULL, the
7370 warning is for start up and the second time the warning is for
7371 wind down. This feature is to allow the target hook to make any
7372 necessary preparations before it starts to record switches and to
7373 perform any necessary tidying up after it has finished recording
7374 switches.
7375
7376 @item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_START
7377 This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7378
7379 @item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_END
7380 This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7381 @end table
7382
7383 The hook's return value must be zero. Other return values may be
7384 supported in the future.
7385
7386 By default this hook is set to NULL, but an example implementation is
7387 provided for ELF based targets. Called @var{elf_record_gcc_switches},
7388 it records the switches as ASCII text inside a new, string mergeable
7389 section in the assembler output file. The name of the new section is
7390 provided by the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION} target
7391 hook.
7392 @end deftypefn
7393
7394 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION
7395 This is the name of the section that will be created by the example
7396 ELF implementation of the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES} target
7397 hook.
7398 @end deftypevr
7399
7400 @need 2000
7401 @node Data Output
7402 @subsection Output of Data
7403
7404
7405 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP
7406 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP
7407 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP
7408 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP
7409 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_TI_OP
7410 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP
7411 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP
7412 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP
7413 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_TI_OP
7414 These hooks specify assembly directives for creating certain kinds
7415 of integer object. The @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} directive creates a
7416 byte-sized object, the @code{TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP} one creates an
7417 aligned two-byte object, and so on. Any of the hooks may be
7418 @code{NULL}, indicating that no suitable directive is available.
7419
7420 The compiler will print these strings at the start of a new line,
7421 followed immediately by the object's initial value. In most cases,
7422 the string should contain a tab, a pseudo-op, and then another tab.
7423 @end deftypevr
7424
7425 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_INTEGER (rtx @var{x}, unsigned int @var{size}, int @var{aligned_p})
7426 The @code{assemble_integer} function uses this hook to output an
7427 integer object. @var{x} is the object's value, @var{size} is its size
7428 in bytes and @var{aligned_p} indicates whether it is aligned. The
7429 function should return @code{true} if it was able to output the
7430 object. If it returns false, @code{assemble_integer} will try to
7431 split the object into smaller parts.
7432
7433 The default implementation of this hook will use the
7434 @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} family of strings, returning @code{false}
7435 when the relevant string is @code{NULL}.
7436 @end deftypefn
7437
7438 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA (FILE *@var{file}, rtx @var{x})
7439 A target hook to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that @code{output_addr_const}
7440 can't deal with, and output assembly code to @var{file} corresponding to
7441 the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to allow machine-dependent
7442 @code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
7443
7444 If target hook fails to recognize a pattern, it must return @code{false},
7445 so that a standard error message is printed. If it prints an error message
7446 itself, by calling, for example, @code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just
7447 return @code{true}.
7448 @end deftypefn
7449
7450 @defmac OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{fail})
7451 A C statement to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that
7452 @code{output_addr_const} can't deal with, and output assembly code to
7453 @var{stream} corresponding to the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to
7454 allow machine-dependent @code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
7455
7456 If @code{OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA} fails to recognize a pattern, it must
7457 @code{goto fail}, so that a standard error message is printed. If it
7458 prints an error message itself, by calling, for example,
7459 @code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just complete normally.
7460 @end defmac
7461
7462 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII (@var{stream}, @var{ptr}, @var{len})
7463 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7464 instruction to assemble a string constant containing the @var{len}
7465 bytes at @var{ptr}. @var{ptr} will be a C expression of type
7466 @code{char *} and @var{len} a C expression of type @code{int}.
7467
7468 If the assembler has a @code{.ascii} pseudo-op as found in the
7469 Berkeley Unix assembler, do not define the macro
7470 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII}.
7471 @end defmac
7472
7473 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FDESC (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{n})
7474 A C statement to output word @var{n} of a function descriptor for
7475 @var{decl}. This must be defined if @code{TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS}
7476 is defined, and is otherwise unused.
7477 @end defmac
7478
7479 @defmac CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
7480 You may define this macro as a C expression. You should define the
7481 expression to have a nonzero value if GCC should output the constant
7482 pool for a function before the code for the function, or a zero value if
7483 GCC should output the constant pool after the function. If you do
7484 not define this macro, the usual case, GCC will output the constant
7485 pool before the function.
7486 @end defmac
7487
7488 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE (@var{file}, @var{funname}, @var{fundecl}, @var{size})
7489 A C statement to output assembler commands to define the start of the
7490 constant pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving
7491 the name of the function. Should the return type of the function
7492 be required, it can be obtained via @var{fundecl}. @var{size}
7493 is the size, in bytes, of the constant pool that will be written
7494 immediately after this call.
7495
7496 If no constant-pool prefix is required, the usual case, this macro need
7497 not be defined.
7498 @end defmac
7499
7500 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY (@var{file}, @var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{align}, @var{labelno}, @var{jumpto})
7501 A C statement (with or without semicolon) to output a constant in the
7502 constant pool, if it needs special treatment. (This macro need not do
7503 anything for RTL expressions that can be output normally.)
7504
7505 The argument @var{file} is the standard I/O stream to output the
7506 assembler code on. @var{x} is the RTL expression for the constant to
7507 output, and @var{mode} is the machine mode (in case @var{x} is a
7508 @samp{const_int}). @var{align} is the required alignment for the value
7509 @var{x}; you should output an assembler directive to force this much
7510 alignment.
7511
7512 The argument @var{labelno} is a number to use in an internal label for
7513 the address of this pool entry. The definition of this macro is
7514 responsible for outputting the label definition at the proper place.
7515 Here is how to do this:
7516
7517 @smallexample
7518 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} (@var{file}, "LC", @var{labelno});
7519 @end smallexample
7520
7521 When you output a pool entry specially, you should end with a
7522 @code{goto} to the label @var{jumpto}. This will prevent the same pool
7523 entry from being output a second time in the usual manner.
7524
7525 You need not define this macro if it would do nothing.
7526 @end defmac
7527
7528 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE (@var{file} @var{funname} @var{fundecl} @var{size})
7529 A C statement to output assembler commands to at the end of the constant
7530 pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving the name of the
7531 function. Should the return type of the function be required, you can
7532 obtain it via @var{fundecl}. @var{size} is the size, in bytes, of the
7533 constant pool that GCC wrote immediately before this call.
7534
7535 If no constant-pool epilogue is required, the usual case, you need not
7536 define this macro.
7537 @end defmac
7538
7539 @defmac IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR (@var{C}, @var{STR})
7540 Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if @var{C} is
7541 used as a logical line separator by the assembler. @var{STR} points
7542 to the position in the string where @var{C} was found; this can be used if
7543 a line separator uses multiple characters.
7544
7545 If you do not define this macro, the default is that only
7546 the character @samp{;} is treated as a logical line separator.
7547 @end defmac
7548
7549 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_OPEN_PAREN
7550 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_CLOSE_PAREN
7551 These target hooks are C string constants, describing the syntax in the
7552 assembler for grouping arithmetic expressions. If not overridden, they
7553 default to normal parentheses, which is correct for most assemblers.
7554 @end deftypevr
7555
7556 These macros are provided by @file{real.h} for writing the definitions
7557 of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE} and the like:
7558
7559 @defmac REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7560 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7561 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7562 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7563 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL64 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7564 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL128 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7565 These translate @var{x}, of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, to the
7566 target's floating point representation, and store its bit pattern in
7567 the variable @var{l}. For @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE} and
7568 @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32}, this variable should be a
7569 simple @code{long int}. For the others, it should be an array of
7570 @code{long int}. The number of elements in this array is determined
7571 by the size of the desired target floating point data type: 32 bits of
7572 it go in each @code{long int} array element. Each array element holds
7573 32 bits of the result, even if @code{long int} is wider than 32 bits
7574 on the host machine.
7575
7576 The array element values are designed so that you can print them out
7577 using @code{fprintf} in the order they should appear in the target
7578 machine's memory.
7579 @end defmac
7580
7581 @node Uninitialized Data
7582 @subsection Output of Uninitialized Variables
7583
7584 Each of the macros in this section is used to do the whole job of
7585 outputting a single uninitialized variable.
7586
7587 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7588 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7589 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a common-label named
7590 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7591 is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants. It is
7592 possible that @var{size} may be zero, for instance if a struct with no
7593 other member than a zero-length array is defined. In this case, the
7594 backend must output a symbol definition that allocates at least one
7595 byte, both so that the address of the resulting object does not compare
7596 equal to any other, and because some object formats cannot even express
7597 the concept of a zero-sized common symbol, as that is how they represent
7598 an ordinary undefined external.
7599
7600 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7601 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7602 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7603
7604 This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7605 common global variables are output.
7606 @end defmac
7607
7608 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7609 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} except takes the required alignment as a
7610 separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7611 place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, and gives you more flexibility in
7612 handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7613 as the number of bits.
7614 @end defmac
7615
7616 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7617 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} except that @var{decl} of the
7618 variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
7619 is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
7620 in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} and
7621 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON}. Define this macro when you need to see
7622 the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
7623 @end defmac
7624
7625 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7626 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7627 @var{stream} the assembler definition of uninitialized global @var{decl} named
7628 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7629 is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
7630
7631 Try to use function @code{asm_output_bss} defined in @file{varasm.c} when
7632 defining this macro. If unable, use the expression
7633 @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name itself;
7634 before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax for defining
7635 the name, and a newline.
7636
7637 There are two ways of handling global BSS@. One is to define either
7638 this macro or its aligned counterpart, @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS}.
7639 The other is to have @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION} return a
7640 switchable BSS section (@pxref{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}).
7641 You do not need to do both.
7642
7643 Some languages do not have @code{common} data, and require a
7644 non-common form of global BSS in order to handle uninitialized globals
7645 efficiently. C++ is one example of this. However, if the target does
7646 not support global BSS, the front end may choose to make globals
7647 common in order to save space in the object file.
7648 @end defmac
7649
7650 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7651 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS} except takes the required alignment as a
7652 separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7653 place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS}, and gives you more flexibility in
7654 handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7655 as the number of bits.
7656
7657 Try to use function @code{asm_output_aligned_bss} defined in file
7658 @file{varasm.c} when defining this macro.
7659 @end defmac
7660
7661 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7662 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7663 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a local-common-label named
7664 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7665 is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
7666
7667 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7668 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7669 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7670
7671 This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7672 static variables are output.
7673 @end defmac
7674
7675 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7676 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL} except takes the required alignment as a
7677 separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7678 place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, and gives you more flexibility in
7679 handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7680 as the number of bits.
7681 @end defmac
7682
7683 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7684 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL} except that @var{decl} of the
7685 variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
7686 is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
7687 in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DECL} and
7688 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL}. Define this macro when you need to see
7689 the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
7690 @end defmac
7691
7692 @node Label Output
7693 @subsection Output and Generation of Labels
7694
7695 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7696 This is about outputting labels.
7697
7698 @findex assemble_name
7699 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7700 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7701 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name}.
7702 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7703 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7704 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7705 definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7706 @end defmac
7707
7708 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7709 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7710 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name} of
7711 a function.
7712 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7713 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7714 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7715 definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7716
7717 If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
7718 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7719 @end defmac
7720
7721 @findex assemble_name_raw
7722 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7723 Identical to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}, except that @var{name} is known
7724 to refer to a compiler-generated label. The default definition uses
7725 @code{assemble_name_raw}, which is like @code{assemble_name} except
7726 that it is more efficient.
7727 @end defmac
7728
7729 @defmac SIZE_ASM_OP
7730 A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7731 size of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7732 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.size\t"}; on other
7733 systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7734
7735 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definitions
7736 of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE}
7737 for your system. If you need your own custom definitions of those
7738 macros, or if you do not need explicit symbol sizes at all, do not
7739 define this macro.
7740 @end defmac
7741
7742 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size})
7743 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7744 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the size of the
7745 symbol @var{name} is @var{size}. @var{size} is a @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}.
7746 If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7747 provided.
7748 @end defmac
7749
7750 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7751 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7752 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler to calculate the size of
7753 the symbol @var{name} by subtracting its address from the current
7754 address.
7755
7756 If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7757 provided. The default assumes that the assembler recognizes a special
7758 @samp{.} symbol as referring to the current address, and can calculate
7759 the difference between this and another symbol. If your assembler does
7760 not recognize @samp{.} or cannot do calculations with it, you will need
7761 to redefine @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} to use some other technique.
7762 @end defmac
7763
7764 @defmac TYPE_ASM_OP
7765 A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7766 type of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7767 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.type\t"}; on other
7768 systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7769
7770 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7771 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7772 custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7773 types at all, do not define this macro.
7774 @end defmac
7775
7776 @defmac TYPE_OPERAND_FMT
7777 A C string which specifies (using @code{printf} syntax) the format of
7778 the second operand to @code{TYPE_ASM_OP}. On systems that use ELF, the
7779 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"@@%s"}; on other systems,
7780 the default is not to define this macro.
7781
7782 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7783 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7784 custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7785 types at all, do not define this macro.
7786 @end defmac
7787
7788 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{type})
7789 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7790 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the type of the
7791 symbol @var{name} is @var{type}. @var{type} is a C string; currently,
7792 that string is always either @samp{"function"} or @samp{"object"}, but
7793 you should not count on this.
7794
7795 If you define @code{TYPE_ASM_OP} and @code{TYPE_OPERAND_FMT}, a default
7796 definition of this macro is provided.
7797 @end defmac
7798
7799 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7800 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7801 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
7802 function which is being defined. This macro is responsible for
7803 outputting the label definition (perhaps using
7804 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}). The argument @var{decl} is the
7805 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
7806
7807 If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
7808 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}).
7809
7810 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
7811 of this macro.
7812 @end defmac
7813
7814 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7815 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7816 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a function
7817 which is being defined. The argument @var{name} is the name of the
7818 function. The argument @var{decl} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node
7819 representing the function.
7820
7821 If this macro is not defined, then the function size is not defined.
7822
7823 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
7824 of this macro.
7825 @end defmac
7826
7827 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7828 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7829 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of an
7830 initialized variable which is being defined. This macro must output the
7831 label definition (perhaps using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}). The argument
7832 @var{decl} is the @code{VAR_DECL} tree node representing the variable.
7833
7834 If this macro is not defined, then the variable name is defined in the
7835 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7836
7837 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7838 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition of this macro.
7839 @end defmac
7840
7841 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DECLARE_CONSTANT_NAME (FILE *@var{file}, const char *@var{name}, const_tree @var{expr}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
7842 A target hook to output to the stdio stream @var{file} any text necessary
7843 for declaring the name @var{name} of a constant which is being defined. This
7844 target hook is responsible for outputting the label definition (perhaps using
7845 @code{assemble_label}). The argument @var{exp} is the value of the constant,
7846 and @var{size} is the size of the constant in bytes. The @var{name}
7847 will be an internal label.
7848
7849 The default version of this target hook, define the @var{name} in the
7850 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{assemble_label}).
7851
7852 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in this target hook.
7853 @end deftypefn
7854
7855 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_REGISTER_GLOBAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{regno}, @var{name})
7856 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7857 @var{stream} any text necessary for claiming a register @var{regno}
7858 for a global variable @var{decl} with name @var{name}.
7859
7860 If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
7861 nothing.
7862 @end defmac
7863
7864 @defmac ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{toplevel}, @var{atend})
7865 A C statement (sans semicolon) to finish up declaring a variable name
7866 once the compiler has processed its initializer fully and thus has had a
7867 chance to determine the size of an array when controlled by an
7868 initializer. This is used on systems where it's necessary to declare
7869 something about the size of the object.
7870
7871 If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
7872 nothing.
7873
7874 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7875 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition of this macro.
7876 @end defmac
7877
7878 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{name})
7879 This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
7880 @var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} global;
7881 that is, available for reference from other files.
7882
7883 The default implementation relies on a proper definition of
7884 @code{GLOBAL_ASM_OP}.
7885 @end deftypefn
7886
7887 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_DECL_NAME (FILE *@var{stream}, tree @var{decl})
7888 This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
7889 @var{stream} some commands that will make the name associated with @var{decl}
7890 global; that is, available for reference from other files.
7891
7892 The default implementation uses the TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL target hook.
7893 @end deftypefn
7894
7895 @defmac ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7896 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7897 @var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} weak;
7898 that is, available for reference from other files but only used if
7899 no other definition is available. Use the expression
7900 @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name
7901 itself; before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax
7902 for making that name weak, and a newline.
7903
7904 If you don't define this macro or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}, GCC will not
7905 support weak symbols and you should not define the @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK}
7906 macro.
7907 @end defmac
7908
7909 @defmac ASM_WEAKEN_DECL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
7910 Combines (and replaces) the function of @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} and
7911 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS}, allowing access to the associated function
7912 or variable decl. If @var{value} is not @code{NULL}, this C statement
7913 should output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code which
7914 defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
7915 @var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it should output commands
7916 to make @var{name} weak.
7917 @end defmac
7918
7919 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAKREF (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
7920 Outputs a directive that enables @var{name} to be used to refer to
7921 symbol @var{value} with weak-symbol semantics. @code{decl} is the
7922 declaration of @code{name}.
7923 @end defmac
7924
7925 @defmac SUPPORTS_WEAK
7926 A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports weak symbols.
7927
7928 If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
7929 definition. If either @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}
7930 is defined, the default definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is
7931 @samp{0}. Define this macro if you want to control weak symbol support
7932 with a compiler flag such as @option{-melf}.
7933 @end defmac
7934
7935 @defmac MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY (@var{decl})
7936 A C statement (sans semicolon) to mark @var{decl} to be emitted as a
7937 public symbol such that extra copies in multiple translation units will
7938 be discarded by the linker. Define this macro if your object file
7939 format provides support for this concept, such as the @samp{COMDAT}
7940 section flags in the Microsoft Windows PE/COFF format, and this support
7941 requires changes to @var{decl}, such as putting it in a separate section.
7942 @end defmac
7943
7944 @defmac SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
7945 A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports one-only
7946 semantics.
7947
7948 If you don't define this macro, @file{varasm.c} provides a default
7949 definition. If @code{MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY} is defined, the default
7950 definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}. Define this macro if
7951 you want to control one-only symbol support with a compiler flag, or if
7952 setting the @code{DECL_ONE_ONLY} flag is enough to mark a declaration to
7953 be emitted as one-only.
7954 @end defmac
7955
7956 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_VISIBILITY (tree @var{decl}, int @var{visibility})
7957 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} some
7958 commands that will make the symbol(s) associated with @var{decl} have
7959 hidden, protected or internal visibility as specified by @var{visibility}.
7960 @end deftypefn
7961
7962 @defmac TARGET_WEAK_NOT_IN_ARCHIVE_TOC
7963 A C expression that evaluates to true if the target's linker expects
7964 that weak symbols do not appear in a static archive's table of contents.
7965 The default is @code{0}.
7966
7967 Leaving weak symbols out of an archive's table of contents means that,
7968 if a symbol will only have a definition in one translation unit and
7969 will have undefined references from other translation units, that
7970 symbol should not be weak. Defining this macro to be nonzero will
7971 thus have the effect that certain symbols that would normally be weak
7972 (explicit template instantiations, and vtables for polymorphic classes
7973 with noninline key methods) will instead be nonweak.
7974
7975 The C++ ABI requires this macro to be zero. Define this macro for
7976 targets where full C++ ABI compliance is impossible and where linker
7977 restrictions require weak symbols to be left out of a static archive's
7978 table of contents.
7979 @end defmac
7980
7981 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name})
7982 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7983 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name of an external
7984 symbol named @var{name} which is referenced in this compilation but
7985 not defined. The value of @var{decl} is the tree node for the
7986 declaration.
7987
7988 This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
7989 The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
7990 @end defmac
7991
7992 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL (rtx @var{symref})
7993 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
7994 pseudo-op to declare a library function name external. The name of the
7995 library function is given by @var{symref}, which is a @code{symbol_ref}.
7996 @end deftypefn
7997
7998 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_MARK_DECL_PRESERVED (const char *@var{symbol})
7999 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
8000 directive to annotate @var{symbol} as used. The Darwin target uses the
8001 .no_dead_code_strip directive.
8002 @end deftypefn
8003
8004 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8005 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8006 @var{stream} a reference in assembler syntax to a label named
8007 @var{name}. This should add @samp{_} to the front of the name, if that
8008 is customary on your operating system, as it is in most Berkeley Unix
8009 systems. This macro is used in @code{assemble_name}.
8010 @end defmac
8011
8012 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SYMBOL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{sym})
8013 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to
8014 @code{SYMBOL_REF} @var{sym}. If not defined, @code{assemble_name}
8015 will be used to output the name of the symbol. This macro may be used
8016 to modify the way a symbol is referenced depending on information
8017 encoded by @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}.
8018 @end defmac
8019
8020 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{buf})
8021 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to @var{buf}, the
8022 result of @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}. If not defined,
8023 @code{assemble_name} will be used to output the name of the symbol.
8024 This macro is not used by @code{output_asm_label}, or the @code{%l}
8025 specifier that calls it; the intention is that this macro should be set
8026 when it is necessary to output a label differently when its address is
8027 being taken.
8028 @end defmac
8029
8030 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_INTERNAL_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{prefix}, unsigned long @var{labelno})
8031 A function to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a label whose
8032 name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{labelno}.
8033
8034 It is absolutely essential that these labels be distinct from the labels
8035 used for user-level functions and variables. Otherwise, certain programs
8036 will have name conflicts with internal labels.
8037
8038 It is desirable to exclude internal labels from the symbol table of the
8039 object file. Most assemblers have a naming convention for labels that
8040 should be excluded; on many systems, the letter @samp{L} at the
8041 beginning of a label has this effect. You should find out what
8042 convention your system uses, and follow it.
8043
8044 The default version of this function utilizes @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}.
8045 @end deftypefn
8046
8047 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8048 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a debug info
8049 label whose name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number
8050 @var{num}. This is useful for VLIW targets, where debug info labels
8051 may need to be treated differently than branch target labels. On some
8052 systems, branch target labels must be at the beginning of instruction
8053 bundles, but debug info labels can occur in the middle of instruction
8054 bundles.
8055
8056 If this macro is not defined, then @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} will be
8057 used.
8058 @end defmac
8059
8060 @defmac ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{string}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8061 A C statement to store into the string @var{string} a label whose name
8062 is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{num}.
8063
8064 This string, when output subsequently by @code{assemble_name}, should
8065 produce the output that @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} would produce
8066 with the same @var{prefix} and @var{num}.
8067
8068 If the string begins with @samp{*}, then @code{assemble_name} will
8069 output the rest of the string unchanged. It is often convenient for
8070 @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL} to use @samp{*} in this way. If the
8071 string doesn't start with @samp{*}, then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} gets
8072 to output the string, and may change it. (Of course,
8073 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} is also part of your machine description, so
8074 you should know what it does on your machine.)
8075 @end defmac
8076
8077 @defmac ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME (@var{outvar}, @var{name}, @var{number})
8078 A C expression to assign to @var{outvar} (which is a variable of type
8079 @code{char *}) a newly allocated string made from the string
8080 @var{name} and the number @var{number}, with some suitable punctuation
8081 added. Use @code{alloca} to get space for the string.
8082
8083 The string will be used as an argument to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to
8084 produce an assembler label for an internal static variable whose name is
8085 @var{name}. Therefore, the string must be such as to result in valid
8086 assembler code. The argument @var{number} is different each time this
8087 macro is executed; it prevents conflicts between similarly-named
8088 internal static variables in different scopes.
8089
8090 Ideally this string should not be a valid C identifier, to prevent any
8091 conflict with the user's own symbols. Most assemblers allow periods
8092 or percent signs in assembler symbols; putting at least one of these
8093 between the name and the number will suffice.
8094
8095 If this macro is not defined, a default definition will be provided
8096 which is correct for most systems.
8097 @end defmac
8098
8099 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8100 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8101 which defines (equates) the symbol @var{name} to have the value @var{value}.
8102
8103 @findex SET_ASM_OP
8104 If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8105 correct for most systems.
8106 @end defmac
8107
8108 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS (@var{stream}, @var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8109 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8110 which defines (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name}
8111 to have the value of the tree node @var{decl_of_value}. This macro will
8112 be used in preference to @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} if it is defined and if
8113 the tree nodes are available.
8114
8115 @findex SET_ASM_OP
8116 If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8117 correct for most systems.
8118 @end defmac
8119
8120 @defmac TARGET_DEFERRED_OUTPUT_DEFS (@var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8121 A C statement that evaluates to true if the assembler code which defines
8122 (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name} to have the value
8123 of the tree node @var{decl_of_value} should be emitted near the end of the
8124 current compilation unit. The default is to not defer output of defines.
8125 This macro affects defines output by @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} and
8126 @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS}.
8127 @end defmac
8128
8129 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8130 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8131 which defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
8132 @var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it defines @var{name} as
8133 an undefined weak symbol.
8134
8135 Define this macro if the target only supports weak aliases; define
8136 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} instead if possible.
8137 @end defmac
8138
8139 @defmac OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL (@var{buf}, @var{is_inst}, @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name}, @var{sel_name})
8140 Define this macro to override the default assembler names used for
8141 Objective-C methods.
8142
8143 The default name is a unique method number followed by the name of the
8144 class (e.g.@: @samp{_1_Foo}). For methods in categories, the name of
8145 the category is also included in the assembler name (e.g.@:
8146 @samp{_1_Foo_Bar}).
8147
8148 These names are safe on most systems, but make debugging difficult since
8149 the method's selector is not present in the name. Therefore, particular
8150 systems define other ways of computing names.
8151
8152 @var{buf} is an expression of type @code{char *} which gives you a
8153 buffer in which to store the name; its length is as long as
8154 @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name} and @var{sel_name} put together, plus
8155 50 characters extra.
8156
8157 The argument @var{is_inst} specifies whether the method is an instance
8158 method or a class method; @var{class_name} is the name of the class;
8159 @var{cat_name} is the name of the category (or @code{NULL} if the method is not
8160 in a category); and @var{sel_name} is the name of the selector.
8161
8162 On systems where the assembler can handle quoted names, you can use this
8163 macro to provide more human-readable names.
8164 @end defmac
8165
8166 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_CLASS_REFERENCE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8167 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8168 @var{stream} commands to declare that the label @var{name} is an
8169 Objective-C class reference. This is only needed for targets whose
8170 linkers have special support for NeXT-style runtimes.
8171 @end defmac
8172
8173 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_UNRESOLVED_REFERENCE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8174 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8175 @var{stream} commands to declare that the label @var{name} is an
8176 unresolved Objective-C class reference. This is only needed for targets
8177 whose linkers have special support for NeXT-style runtimes.
8178 @end defmac
8179
8180 @node Initialization
8181 @subsection How Initialization Functions Are Handled
8182 @cindex initialization routines
8183 @cindex termination routines
8184 @cindex constructors, output of
8185 @cindex destructors, output of
8186
8187 The compiled code for certain languages includes @dfn{constructors}
8188 (also called @dfn{initialization routines})---functions to initialize
8189 data in the program when the program is started. These functions need
8190 to be called before the program is ``started''---that is to say, before
8191 @code{main} is called.
8192
8193 Compiling some languages generates @dfn{destructors} (also called
8194 @dfn{termination routines}) that should be called when the program
8195 terminates.
8196
8197 To make the initialization and termination functions work, the compiler
8198 must output something in the assembler code to cause those functions to
8199 be called at the appropriate time. When you port the compiler to a new
8200 system, you need to specify how to do this.
8201
8202 There are two major ways that GCC currently supports the execution of
8203 initialization and termination functions. Each way has two variants.
8204 Much of the structure is common to all four variations.
8205
8206 @findex __CTOR_LIST__
8207 @findex __DTOR_LIST__
8208 The linker must build two lists of these functions---a list of
8209 initialization functions, called @code{__CTOR_LIST__}, and a list of
8210 termination functions, called @code{__DTOR_LIST__}.
8211
8212 Each list always begins with an ignored function pointer (which may hold
8213 0, @minus{}1, or a count of the function pointers after it, depending on
8214 the environment). This is followed by a series of zero or more function
8215 pointers to constructors (or destructors), followed by a function
8216 pointer containing zero.
8217
8218 Depending on the operating system and its executable file format, either
8219 @file{crtstuff.c} or @file{libgcc2.c} traverses these lists at startup
8220 time and exit time. Constructors are called in reverse order of the
8221 list; destructors in forward order.
8222
8223 The best way to handle static constructors works only for object file
8224 formats which provide arbitrarily-named sections. A section is set
8225 aside for a list of constructors, and another for a list of destructors.
8226 Traditionally these are called @samp{.ctors} and @samp{.dtors}. Each
8227 object file that defines an initialization function also puts a word in
8228 the constructor section to point to that function. The linker
8229 accumulates all these words into one contiguous @samp{.ctors} section.
8230 Termination functions are handled similarly.
8231
8232 This method will be chosen as the default by @file{target-def.h} if
8233 @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is defined. A target that does not
8234 support arbitrary sections, but does support special designated
8235 constructor and destructor sections may define @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8236 and @code{DTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP} to achieve the same effect.
8237
8238 When arbitrary sections are available, there are two variants, depending
8239 upon how the code in @file{crtstuff.c} is called. On systems that
8240 support a @dfn{.init} section which is executed at program startup,
8241 parts of @file{crtstuff.c} are compiled into that section. The
8242 program is linked by the @command{gcc} driver like this:
8243
8244 @smallexample
8245 ld -o @var{output_file} crti.o crtbegin.o @dots{} -lgcc crtend.o crtn.o
8246 @end smallexample
8247
8248 The prologue of a function (@code{__init}) appears in the @code{.init}
8249 section of @file{crti.o}; the epilogue appears in @file{crtn.o}. Likewise
8250 for the function @code{__fini} in the @dfn{.fini} section. Normally these
8251 files are provided by the operating system or by the GNU C library, but
8252 are provided by GCC for a few targets.
8253
8254 The objects @file{crtbegin.o} and @file{crtend.o} are (for most targets)
8255 compiled from @file{crtstuff.c}. They contain, among other things, code
8256 fragments within the @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections that branch
8257 to routines in the @code{.text} section. The linker will pull all parts
8258 of a section together, which results in a complete @code{__init} function
8259 that invokes the routines we need at startup.
8260
8261 To use this variant, you must define the @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8262 macro properly.
8263
8264 If no init section is available, when GCC compiles any function called
8265 @code{main} (or more accurately, any function designated as a program
8266 entry point by the language front end calling @code{expand_main_function}),
8267 it inserts a procedure call to @code{__main} as the first executable code
8268 after the function prologue. The @code{__main} function is defined
8269 in @file{libgcc2.c} and runs the global constructors.
8270
8271 In file formats that don't support arbitrary sections, there are again
8272 two variants. In the simplest variant, the GNU linker (GNU @code{ld})
8273 and an `a.out' format must be used. In this case,
8274 @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} is defined to produce a @code{.stabs}
8275 entry of type @samp{N_SETT}, referencing the name @code{__CTOR_LIST__},
8276 and with the address of the void function containing the initialization
8277 code as its value. The GNU linker recognizes this as a request to add
8278 the value to a @dfn{set}; the values are accumulated, and are eventually
8279 placed in the executable as a vector in the format described above, with
8280 a leading (ignored) count and a trailing zero element.
8281 @code{TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR} is handled similarly. Since no init
8282 section is available, the absence of @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} causes
8283 the compilation of @code{main} to call @code{__main} as above, starting
8284 the initialization process.
8285
8286 The last variant uses neither arbitrary sections nor the GNU linker.
8287 This is preferable when you want to do dynamic linking and when using
8288 file formats which the GNU linker does not support, such as `ECOFF'@. In
8289 this case, @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is false, initialization and
8290 termination functions are recognized simply by their names. This requires
8291 an extra program in the linkage step, called @command{collect2}. This program
8292 pretends to be the linker, for use with GCC; it does its job by running
8293 the ordinary linker, but also arranges to include the vectors of
8294 initialization and termination functions. These functions are called
8295 via @code{__main} as described above. In order to use this method,
8296 @code{use_collect2} must be defined in the target in @file{config.gcc}.
8297
8298 @ifinfo
8299 The following section describes the specific macros that control and
8300 customize the handling of initialization and termination functions.
8301 @end ifinfo
8302
8303 @node Macros for Initialization
8304 @subsection Macros Controlling Initialization Routines
8305
8306 Here are the macros that control how the compiler handles initialization
8307 and termination functions:
8308
8309 @defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
8310 If defined, a C string constant, including spacing, for the assembler
8311 operation to identify the following data as initialization code. If not
8312 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. When you are
8313 using special sections for initialization and termination functions, this
8314 macro also controls how @file{crtstuff.c} and @file{libgcc2.c} arrange to
8315 run the initialization functions.
8316 @end defmac
8317
8318 @defmac HAS_INIT_SECTION
8319 If defined, @code{main} will not call @code{__main} as described above.
8320 This macro should be defined for systems that control start-up code
8321 on a symbol-by-symbol basis, such as OSF/1, and should not
8322 be defined explicitly for systems that support @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
8323 @end defmac
8324
8325 @defmac LD_INIT_SWITCH
8326 If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8327 the following symbol is an initialization routine.
8328 @end defmac
8329
8330 @defmac LD_FINI_SWITCH
8331 If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8332 the following symbol is a finalization routine.
8333 @end defmac
8334
8335 @defmac COLLECT_SHARED_INIT_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8336 If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8337 automatically called when a shared library is loaded. The function
8338 should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8339 the object format requires an explicit initialization function, then a
8340 function called @code{_GLOBAL__DI} will be generated.
8341
8342 This function and the following one are used by collect2 when linking a
8343 shared library that needs constructors or destructors, or has DWARF2
8344 exception tables embedded in the code.
8345 @end defmac
8346
8347 @defmac COLLECT_SHARED_FINI_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8348 If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8349 automatically called when a shared library is unloaded. The function
8350 should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8351 the object format requires an explicit finalization function, then a
8352 function called @code{_GLOBAL__DD} will be generated.
8353 @end defmac
8354
8355 @defmac INVOKE__main
8356 If defined, @code{main} will call @code{__main} despite the presence of
8357 @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}. This macro should be defined for systems
8358 where the init section is not actually run automatically, but is still
8359 useful for collecting the lists of constructors and destructors.
8360 @end defmac
8361
8362 @defmac SUPPORTS_INIT_PRIORITY
8363 If nonzero, the C++ @code{init_priority} attribute is supported and the
8364 compiler should emit instructions to control the order of initialization
8365 of objects. If zero, the compiler will issue an error message upon
8366 encountering an @code{init_priority} attribute.
8367 @end defmac
8368
8369 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS
8370 This value is true if the target supports some ``native'' method of
8371 collecting constructors and destructors to be run at startup and exit.
8372 It is false if we must use @command{collect2}.
8373 @end deftypevr
8374
8375 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
8376 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code to arrange to call
8377 the function referenced by @var{symbol} at initialization time.
8378
8379 Assume that @var{symbol} is a @code{SYMBOL_REF} for a function taking
8380 no arguments and with no return value. If the target supports initialization
8381 priorities, @var{priority} is a value between 0 and @code{MAX_INIT_PRIORITY};
8382 otherwise it must be @code{DEFAULT_INIT_PRIORITY}.
8383
8384 If this macro is not defined by the target, a suitable default will
8385 be chosen if (1) the target supports arbitrary section names, (2) the
8386 target defines @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}, or (3) @code{USE_COLLECT2}
8387 is not defined.
8388 @end deftypefn
8389
8390 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
8391 This is like @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} but used for termination
8392 functions rather than initialization functions.
8393 @end deftypefn
8394
8395 If @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is true, the initialization routine
8396 generated for the generated object file will have static linkage.
8397
8398 If your system uses @command{collect2} as the means of processing
8399 constructors, then that program normally uses @command{nm} to scan
8400 an object file for constructor functions to be called.
8401
8402 On certain kinds of systems, you can define this macro to make
8403 @command{collect2} work faster (and, in some cases, make it work at all):
8404
8405 @defmac OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
8406 Define this macro if the system uses COFF (Common Object File Format)
8407 object files, so that @command{collect2} can assume this format and scan
8408 object files directly for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
8409
8410 This macro is effective only in a native compiler; @command{collect2} as
8411 part of a cross compiler always uses @command{nm} for the target machine.
8412 @end defmac
8413
8414 @defmac REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
8415 Define this macro as a C string constant containing the file name to use
8416 to execute @command{nm}. The default is to search the path normally for
8417 @command{nm}.
8418
8419 If your system supports shared libraries and has a program to list the
8420 dynamic dependencies of a given library or executable, you can define
8421 these macros to enable support for running initialization and
8422 termination functions in shared libraries:
8423 @end defmac
8424
8425 @defmac LDD_SUFFIX
8426 Define this macro to a C string constant containing the name of the program
8427 which lists dynamic dependencies, like @command{"ldd"} under SunOS 4.
8428 @end defmac
8429
8430 @defmac PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT (@var{ptr})
8431 Define this macro to be C code that extracts filenames from the output
8432 of the program denoted by @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. @var{ptr} is a variable
8433 of type @code{char *} that points to the beginning of a line of output
8434 from @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. If the line lists a dynamic dependency, the
8435 code must advance @var{ptr} to the beginning of the filename on that
8436 line. Otherwise, it must set @var{ptr} to @code{NULL}.
8437 @end defmac
8438
8439 @defmac SHLIB_SUFFIX
8440 Define this macro to a C string constant containing the default shared
8441 library extension of the target (e.g., @samp{".so"}). @command{collect2}
8442 strips version information after this suffix when generating global
8443 constructor and destructor names. This define is only needed on targets
8444 that use @command{collect2} to process constructors and destructors.
8445 @end defmac
8446
8447 @node Instruction Output
8448 @subsection Output of Assembler Instructions
8449
8450 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8451 This describes assembler instruction output.
8452
8453 @defmac REGISTER_NAMES
8454 A C initializer containing the assembler's names for the machine
8455 registers, each one as a C string constant. This is what translates
8456 register numbers in the compiler into assembler language.
8457 @end defmac
8458
8459 @defmac ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
8460 If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a name
8461 and a register number. This macro defines additional names for hard
8462 registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in declarations to refer
8463 to registers using alternate names.
8464 @end defmac
8465
8466 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE (@var{stream}, @var{ptr})
8467 Define this macro if you are using an unusual assembler that
8468 requires different names for the machine instructions.
8469
8470 The definition is a C statement or statements which output an
8471 assembler instruction opcode to the stdio stream @var{stream}. The
8472 macro-operand @var{ptr} is a variable of type @code{char *} which
8473 points to the opcode name in its ``internal'' form---the form that is
8474 written in the machine description. The definition should output the
8475 opcode name to @var{stream}, performing any translation you desire, and
8476 increment the variable @var{ptr} to point at the end of the opcode
8477 so that it will not be output twice.
8478
8479 In fact, your macro definition may process less than the entire opcode
8480 name, or more than the opcode name; but if you want to process text
8481 that includes @samp{%}-sequences to substitute operands, you must take
8482 care of the substitution yourself. Just be sure to increment
8483 @var{ptr} over whatever text should not be output normally.
8484
8485 @findex recog_data.operand
8486 If you need to look at the operand values, they can be found as the
8487 elements of @code{recog_data.operand}.
8488
8489 If the macro definition does nothing, the instruction is output
8490 in the usual way.
8491 @end defmac
8492
8493 @defmac FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN (@var{insn}, @var{opvec}, @var{noperands})
8494 If defined, a C statement to be executed just prior to the output of
8495 assembler code for @var{insn}, to modify the extracted operands so
8496 they will be output differently.
8497
8498 Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8499 extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8500 elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8501 The contents of this vector are what will be used to convert the insn
8502 template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler output
8503 by changing the contents of the vector.
8504
8505 This macro is useful when various assembler syntaxes share a single
8506 file of instruction patterns; by defining this macro differently, you
8507 can cause a large class of instructions to be output differently (such
8508 as with rearranged operands). Naturally, variations in assembler
8509 syntax affecting individual insn patterns ought to be handled by
8510 writing conditional output routines in those patterns.
8511
8512 If this macro is not defined, it is equivalent to a null statement.
8513 @end defmac
8514
8515 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FINAL_POSTSCAN_INSN (FILE *@var{file}, rtx @var{insn}, rtx *@var{opvec}, int @var{noperands})
8516 If defined, this target hook is a function which is executed just after the
8517 output of assembler code for @var{insn}, to change the mode of the assembler
8518 if necessary.
8519
8520 Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8521 extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8522 elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8523 The contents of this vector are what was used to convert the insn
8524 template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler mode
8525 by checking the contents of the vector.
8526 @end deftypefn
8527
8528 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{code})
8529 A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8530 assembler syntax for an instruction operand @var{x}. @var{x} is an
8531 RTL expression.
8532
8533 @var{code} is a value that can be used to specify one of several ways
8534 of printing the operand. It is used when identical operands must be
8535 printed differently depending on the context. @var{code} comes from
8536 the @samp{%} specification that was used to request printing of the
8537 operand. If the specification was just @samp{%@var{digit}} then
8538 @var{code} is 0; if the specification was @samp{%@var{ltr}
8539 @var{digit}} then @var{code} is the ASCII code for @var{ltr}.
8540
8541 @findex reg_names
8542 If @var{x} is a register, this macro should print the register's name.
8543 The names can be found in an array @code{reg_names} whose type is
8544 @code{char *[]}. @code{reg_names} is initialized from
8545 @code{REGISTER_NAMES}.
8546
8547 When the machine description has a specification @samp{%@var{punct}}
8548 (a @samp{%} followed by a punctuation character), this macro is called
8549 with a null pointer for @var{x} and the punctuation character for
8550 @var{code}.
8551 @end defmac
8552
8553 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P (@var{code})
8554 A C expression which evaluates to true if @var{code} is a valid
8555 punctuation character for use in the @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro. If
8556 @code{PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P} is not defined, it means that no
8557 punctuation characters (except for the standard one, @samp{%}) are used
8558 in this way.
8559 @end defmac
8560
8561 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS (@var{stream}, @var{x})
8562 A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8563 assembler syntax for an instruction operand that is a memory reference
8564 whose address is @var{x}. @var{x} is an RTL expression.
8565
8566 @cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} usage
8567 On some machines, the syntax for a symbolic address depends on the
8568 section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the hook
8569 @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information into the
8570 @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. @xref{Assembler
8571 Format}.
8572 @end defmac
8573
8574 @findex dbr_sequence_length
8575 @defmac DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND (@var{file})
8576 A C statement, to be executed after all slot-filler instructions have
8577 been output. If necessary, call @code{dbr_sequence_length} to
8578 determine the number of slots filled in a sequence (zero if not
8579 currently outputting a sequence), to decide how many no-ops to output,
8580 or whatever.
8581
8582 Don't define this macro if it has nothing to do, but it is helpful in
8583 reading assembly output if the extent of the delay sequence is made
8584 explicit (e.g.@: with white space).
8585 @end defmac
8586
8587 @findex final_sequence
8588 Note that output routines for instructions with delay slots must be
8589 prepared to deal with not being output as part of a sequence
8590 (i.e.@: when the scheduling pass is not run, or when no slot fillers could be
8591 found.) The variable @code{final_sequence} is null when not
8592 processing a sequence, otherwise it contains the @code{sequence} rtx
8593 being output.
8594
8595 @findex asm_fprintf
8596 @defmac REGISTER_PREFIX
8597 @defmacx LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
8598 @defmacx USER_LABEL_PREFIX
8599 @defmacx IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
8600 If defined, C string expressions to be used for the @samp{%R}, @samp{%L},
8601 @samp{%U}, and @samp{%I} options of @code{asm_fprintf} (see
8602 @file{final.c}). These are useful when a single @file{md} file must
8603 support multiple assembler formats. In that case, the various @file{tm.h}
8604 files can define these macros differently.
8605 @end defmac
8606
8607 @defmac ASM_FPRINTF_EXTENSIONS (@var{file}, @var{argptr}, @var{format})
8608 If defined this macro should expand to a series of @code{case}
8609 statements which will be parsed inside the @code{switch} statement of
8610 the @code{asm_fprintf} function. This allows targets to define extra
8611 printf formats which may useful when generating their assembler
8612 statements. Note that uppercase letters are reserved for future
8613 generic extensions to asm_fprintf, and so are not available to target
8614 specific code. The output file is given by the parameter @var{file}.
8615 The varargs input pointer is @var{argptr} and the rest of the format
8616 string, starting the character after the one that is being switched
8617 upon, is pointed to by @var{format}.
8618 @end defmac
8619
8620 @defmac ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
8621 If your target supports multiple dialects of assembler language (such as
8622 different opcodes), define this macro as a C expression that gives the
8623 numeric index of the assembler language dialect to use, with zero as the
8624 first variant.
8625
8626 If this macro is defined, you may use constructs of the form
8627 @smallexample
8628 @samp{@{option0|option1|option2@dots{}@}}
8629 @end smallexample
8630 @noindent
8631 in the output templates of patterns (@pxref{Output Template}) or in the
8632 first argument of @code{asm_fprintf}. This construct outputs
8633 @samp{option0}, @samp{option1}, @samp{option2}, etc., if the value of
8634 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} is zero, one, two, etc. Any special characters
8635 within these strings retain their usual meaning. If there are fewer
8636 alternatives within the braces than the value of
8637 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT}, the construct outputs nothing.
8638
8639 If you do not define this macro, the characters @samp{@{}, @samp{|} and
8640 @samp{@}} do not have any special meaning when used in templates or
8641 operands to @code{asm_fprintf}.
8642
8643 Define the macros @code{REGISTER_PREFIX}, @code{LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX},
8644 @code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX} and @code{IMMEDIATE_PREFIX} if you can express
8645 the variations in assembler language syntax with that mechanism. Define
8646 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} and use the @samp{@{option0|option1@}} syntax
8647 if the syntax variant are larger and involve such things as different
8648 opcodes or operand order.
8649 @end defmac
8650
8651 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
8652 A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8653 which will push hard register number @var{regno} onto the stack.
8654 The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8655 profiling.
8656 @end defmac
8657
8658 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
8659 A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8660 which will pop hard register number @var{regno} off of the stack.
8661 The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8662 profiling.
8663 @end defmac
8664
8665 @node Dispatch Tables
8666 @subsection Output of Dispatch Tables
8667
8668 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8669 This concerns dispatch tables.
8670
8671 @cindex dispatch table
8672 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{body}, @var{value}, @var{rel})
8673 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8674 pseudo-instruction to generate a difference between two labels.
8675 @var{value} and @var{rel} are the numbers of two internal labels. The
8676 definitions of these labels are output using
8677 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}, and they must be printed in the same
8678 way here. For example,
8679
8680 @smallexample
8681 fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d-L%d\n",
8682 @var{value}, @var{rel})
8683 @end smallexample
8684
8685 You must provide this macro on machines where the addresses in a
8686 dispatch table are relative to the table's own address. If defined, GCC
8687 will also use this macro on all machines when producing PIC@.
8688 @var{body} is the body of the @code{ADDR_DIFF_VEC}; it is provided so that the
8689 mode and flags can be read.
8690 @end defmac
8691
8692 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
8693 This macro should be provided on machines where the addresses
8694 in a dispatch table are absolute.
8695
8696 The definition should be a C statement to output to the stdio stream
8697 @var{stream} an assembler pseudo-instruction to generate a reference to
8698 a label. @var{value} is the number of an internal label whose
8699 definition is output using @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
8700 For example,
8701
8702 @smallexample
8703 fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d\n", @var{value})
8704 @end smallexample
8705 @end defmac
8706
8707 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num}, @var{table})
8708 Define this if the label before a jump-table needs to be output
8709 specially. The first three arguments are the same as for
8710 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}; the fourth argument is the
8711 jump-table which follows (a @code{jump_insn} containing an
8712 @code{addr_vec} or @code{addr_diff_vec}).
8713
8714 This feature is used on system V to output a @code{swbeg} statement
8715 for the table.
8716
8717 If this macro is not defined, these labels are output with
8718 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
8719 @end defmac
8720
8721 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END (@var{stream}, @var{num}, @var{table})
8722 Define this if something special must be output at the end of a
8723 jump-table. The definition should be a C statement to be executed
8724 after the assembler code for the table is written. It should write
8725 the appropriate code to stdio stream @var{stream}. The argument
8726 @var{table} is the jump-table insn, and @var{num} is the label-number
8727 of the preceding label.
8728
8729 If this macro is not defined, nothing special is output at the end of
8730 the jump-table.
8731 @end defmac
8732
8733 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_UNWIND_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, tree @var{decl}, int @var{for_eh}, int @var{empty})
8734 This target hook emits a label at the beginning of each FDE@. It
8735 should be defined on targets where FDEs need special labels, and it
8736 should write the appropriate label, for the FDE associated with the
8737 function declaration @var{decl}, to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
8738 The third argument, @var{for_eh}, is a boolean: true if this is for an
8739 exception table. The fourth argument, @var{empty}, is a boolean:
8740 true if this is a placeholder label for an omitted FDE@.
8741
8742 The default is that FDEs are not given nonlocal labels.
8743 @end deftypefn
8744
8745 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_TABLE_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream})
8746 This target hook emits a label at the beginning of the exception table.
8747 It should be defined on targets where it is desirable for the table
8748 to be broken up according to function.
8749
8750 The default is that no label is emitted.
8751 @end deftypefn
8752
8753 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_PERSONALITY (rtx @var{personality})
8754 If the target implements @code{TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT}, this hook may be used to emit a directive to install a personality hook into the unwind info. This hook should not be used if dwarf2 unwind info is used.
8755 @end deftypefn
8756
8757 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT (FILE *@var{stream}, rtx @var{insn})
8758 This target hook emits assembly directives required to unwind the
8759 given instruction. This is only used when @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
8760 returns @code{UI_TARGET}.
8761 @end deftypefn
8762
8763 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT_BEFORE_INSN
8764 True if the @code{TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT} hook should be called before the assembly for @var{insn} has been emitted, false if the hook should be called afterward.
8765 @end deftypevr
8766
8767 @node Exception Region Output
8768 @subsection Assembler Commands for Exception Regions
8769
8770 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8771
8772 This describes commands marking the start and the end of an exception
8773 region.
8774
8775 @defmac EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
8776 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing
8777 exception handling frame unwind information. If not defined, GCC will
8778 provide a default definition if the target supports named sections.
8779 @file{crtstuff.c} uses this macro to switch to the appropriate section.
8780
8781 You should define this symbol if your target supports DWARF 2 frame
8782 unwind information and the default definition does not work.
8783 @end defmac
8784
8785 @defmac EH_FRAME_IN_DATA_SECTION
8786 If defined, DWARF 2 frame unwind information will be placed in the
8787 data section even though the target supports named sections. This
8788 might be necessary, for instance, if the system linker does garbage
8789 collection and sections cannot be marked as not to be collected.
8790
8791 Do not define this macro unless @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is
8792 also defined.
8793 @end defmac
8794
8795 @defmac EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY
8796 Define this macro to 1 if your target is such that no frame unwind
8797 information encoding used with non-PIC code will ever require a
8798 runtime relocation, but the linker may not support merging read-only
8799 and read-write sections into a single read-write section.
8800 @end defmac
8801
8802 @defmac MASK_RETURN_ADDR
8803 An rtx used to mask the return address found via @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX}, so
8804 that it does not contain any extraneous set bits in it.
8805 @end defmac
8806
8807 @defmac DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
8808 Define this macro to 0 if your target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8809 information, but it does not yet work with exception handling.
8810 Otherwise, if your target supports this information (if it defines
8811 @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either @code{UNALIGNED_INT_ASM_OP}
8812 or @code{OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF}), GCC will provide a default definition of 1.
8813 @end defmac
8814
8815 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum unwind_info_type} TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO (void)
8816 This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for exception handling
8817 by the target. If the target has ABI specified unwind tables, the hook
8818 should return @code{UI_TARGET}. If the target is to use the
8819 @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling scheme, the hook
8820 should return @code{UI_SJLJ}. If the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8821 information, the hook should return @code{UI_DWARF2}.
8822
8823 A target may, if exceptions are disabled, choose to return @code{UI_NONE}.
8824 This may end up simplifying other parts of target-specific code. The
8825 default implementation of this hook never returns @code{UI_NONE}.
8826
8827 Note that the value returned by this hook should be constant. It should
8828 not depend on anything except command-line switches. In particular, the
8829 setting @code{UI_SJLJ} must be fixed at compiler start-up as C pre-processor
8830 macros and builtin functions related to exception handling are set up
8831 depending on this setting.
8832
8833 The default implementation of the hook first honors the
8834 @option{--enable-sjlj-exceptions} configure option, then
8835 @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO}, and finally defaults to @code{UI_SJLJ}.
8836 @end deftypefn
8837
8838 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_UNWIND_TABLES_DEFAULT
8839 This variable should be set to @code{true} if the target ABI requires unwinding
8840 tables even when exceptions are not used.
8841 @end deftypevr
8842
8843 @defmac MUST_USE_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS
8844 This macro need only be defined if @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO} is
8845 runtime-variable. In that case, @file{except.h} cannot correctly
8846 determine the corresponding definition of @code{MUST_USE_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS},
8847 so the target must provide it directly.
8848 @end defmac
8849
8850 @defmac DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP
8851 Define this macro to 1 if the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based scheme
8852 should use the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp} functions from the C library
8853 instead of the @code{__builtin_setjmp}/@code{__builtin_longjmp} machinery.
8854 @end defmac
8855
8856 @defmac DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
8857 This macro need only be defined if the target might save registers in the
8858 function prologue at an offset to the stack pointer that is not aligned to
8859 @code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. The definition should be the negative minimum
8860 alignment if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and the positive
8861 minimum alignment otherwise. @xref{SDB and DWARF}. Only applicable if
8862 the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind information.
8863 @end defmac
8864
8865 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_TERMINATE_DW2_EH_FRAME_INFO
8866 Contains the value true if the target should add a zero word onto the
8867 end of a Dwarf-2 frame info section when used for exception handling.
8868 Default value is false if @code{EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME} is defined, and
8869 true otherwise.
8870 @end deftypevr
8871
8872 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_DWARF_REGISTER_SPAN (rtx @var{reg})
8873 Given a register, this hook should return a parallel of registers to
8874 represent where to find the register pieces. Define this hook if the
8875 register and its mode are represented in Dwarf in non-contiguous
8876 locations, or if the register should be represented in more than one
8877 register in Dwarf. Otherwise, this hook should return @code{NULL_RTX}.
8878 If not defined, the default is to return @code{NULL_RTX}.
8879 @end deftypefn
8880
8881 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_DWARF_REG_SIZES_EXTRA (tree @var{address})
8882 If some registers are represented in Dwarf-2 unwind information in
8883 multiple pieces, define this hook to fill in information about the
8884 sizes of those pieces in the table used by the unwinder at runtime.
8885 It will be called by @code{expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes} after
8886 filling in a single size corresponding to each hard register;
8887 @var{address} is the address of the table.
8888 @end deftypefn
8889
8890 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_TTYPE (rtx @var{sym})
8891 This hook is used to output a reference from a frame unwinding table to
8892 the type_info object identified by @var{sym}. It should return @code{true}
8893 if the reference was output. Returning @code{false} will cause the
8894 reference to be output using the normal Dwarf2 routines.
8895 @end deftypefn
8896
8897 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ARM_EABI_UNWINDER
8898 This flag should be set to @code{true} on targets that use an ARM EABI
8899 based unwinding library, and @code{false} on other targets. This effects
8900 the format of unwinding tables, and how the unwinder in entered after
8901 running a cleanup. The default is @code{false}.
8902 @end deftypevr
8903
8904 @node Alignment Output
8905 @subsection Assembler Commands for Alignment
8906
8907 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8908 This describes commands for alignment.
8909
8910 @defmac JUMP_ALIGN (@var{label})
8911 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which is
8912 a common destination of jumps and has no fallthru incoming edge.
8913
8914 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8915 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
8916 define the macro.
8917
8918 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
8919 to set the variable @var{align_jumps} in the target's
8920 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
8921 selection in @var{align_jumps} in a @code{JUMP_ALIGN} implementation.
8922 @end defmac
8923
8924 @defmac LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER (@var{label})
8925 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
8926 a @code{BARRIER}.
8927
8928 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8929 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
8930 define the macro.
8931 @end defmac
8932
8933 @defmac LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER_MAX_SKIP
8934 The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying
8935 @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER}. This works only if
8936 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
8937 @end defmac
8938
8939 @defmac LOOP_ALIGN (@var{label})
8940 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
8941 a @code{NOTE_INSN_LOOP_BEG} note.
8942
8943 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8944 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
8945 define the macro.
8946
8947 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
8948 to set the variable @code{align_loops} in the target's
8949 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
8950 selection in @code{align_loops} in a @code{LOOP_ALIGN} implementation.
8951 @end defmac
8952
8953 @defmac LOOP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
8954 The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LOOP_ALIGN}.
8955 This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
8956 @end defmac
8957
8958 @defmac LABEL_ALIGN (@var{label})
8959 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}.
8960 If @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER} / @code{LOOP_ALIGN} specify a different alignment,
8961 the maximum of the specified values is used.
8962
8963 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
8964 to set the variable @code{align_labels} in the target's
8965 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
8966 selection in @code{align_labels} in a @code{LABEL_ALIGN} implementation.
8967 @end defmac
8968
8969 @defmac LABEL_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
8970 The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LABEL_ALIGN}.
8971 This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
8972 @end defmac
8973
8974 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP (@var{stream}, @var{nbytes})
8975 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8976 instruction to advance the location counter by @var{nbytes} bytes.
8977 Those bytes should be zero when loaded. @var{nbytes} will be a C
8978 expression of type @code{unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT}.
8979 @end defmac
8980
8981 @defmac ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
8982 Define this macro if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} should not be used in the
8983 text section because it fails to put zeros in the bytes that are skipped.
8984 This is true on many Unix systems, where the pseudo--op to skip bytes
8985 produces no-op instructions rather than zeros when used in the text
8986 section.
8987 @end defmac
8988
8989 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power})
8990 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8991 command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
8992 @var{power} bytes. @var{power} will be a C expression of type @code{int}.
8993 @end defmac
8994
8995 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN_WITH_NOP (@var{stream}, @var{power})
8996 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN}, except that the ``nop'' instruction is used
8997 for padding, if necessary.
8998 @end defmac
8999
9000 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power}, @var{max_skip})
9001 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9002 command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
9003 @var{power} bytes, but only if @var{max_skip} or fewer bytes are needed to
9004 satisfy the alignment request. @var{power} and @var{max_skip} will be
9005 a C expression of type @code{int}.
9006 @end defmac
9007
9008 @need 3000
9009 @node Debugging Info
9010 @section Controlling Debugging Information Format
9011
9012 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9013 This describes how to specify debugging information.
9014
9015 @menu
9016 * All Debuggers:: Macros that affect all debugging formats uniformly.
9017 * DBX Options:: Macros enabling specific options in DBX format.
9018 * DBX Hooks:: Hook macros for varying DBX format.
9019 * File Names and DBX:: Macros controlling output of file names in DBX format.
9020 * SDB and DWARF:: Macros for SDB (COFF) and DWARF formats.
9021 * VMS Debug:: Macros for VMS debug format.
9022 @end menu
9023
9024 @node All Debuggers
9025 @subsection Macros Affecting All Debugging Formats
9026
9027 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9028 These macros affect all debugging formats.
9029
9030 @defmac DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})
9031 A C expression that returns the DBX register number for the compiler
9032 register number @var{regno}. In the default macro provided, the value
9033 of this expression will be @var{regno} itself. But sometimes there are
9034 some registers that the compiler knows about and DBX does not, or vice
9035 versa. In such cases, some register may need to have one number in the
9036 compiler and another for DBX@.
9037
9038 If two registers have consecutive numbers inside GCC, and they can be
9039 used as a pair to hold a multiword value, then they @emph{must} have
9040 consecutive numbers after renumbering with @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER}.
9041 Otherwise, debuggers will be unable to access such a pair, because they
9042 expect register pairs to be consecutive in their own numbering scheme.
9043
9044 If you find yourself defining @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER} in way that
9045 does not preserve register pairs, then what you must do instead is
9046 redefine the actual register numbering scheme.
9047 @end defmac
9048
9049 @defmac DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET (@var{x})
9050 A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an automatic
9051 variable having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The default
9052 computation assumes that @var{x} is based on the frame-pointer and
9053 gives the offset from the frame-pointer. This is required for targets
9054 that produce debugging output for DBX or COFF-style debugging output
9055 for SDB and allow the frame-pointer to be eliminated when the
9056 @option{-g} options is used.
9057 @end defmac
9058
9059 @defmac DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET (@var{offset}, @var{x})
9060 A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an argument
9061 having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The nominal offset is
9062 @var{offset}.
9063 @end defmac
9064
9065 @defmac PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
9066 A C expression that returns the type of debugging output GCC should
9067 produce when the user specifies just @option{-g}. Define
9068 this if you have arranged for GCC to support more than one format of
9069 debugging output. Currently, the allowable values are @code{DBX_DEBUG},
9070 @code{SDB_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF2_DEBUG},
9071 @code{XCOFF_DEBUG}, @code{VMS_DEBUG}, and @code{VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG}.
9072
9073 When the user specifies @option{-ggdb}, GCC normally also uses the
9074 value of this macro to select the debugging output format, but with two
9075 exceptions. If @code{DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO} is defined, GCC uses the
9076 value @code{DWARF2_DEBUG}. Otherwise, if @code{DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO} is
9077 defined, GCC uses @code{DBX_DEBUG}.
9078
9079 The value of this macro only affects the default debugging output; the
9080 user can always get a specific type of output by using @option{-gstabs},
9081 @option{-gcoff}, @option{-gdwarf-2}, @option{-gxcoff}, or @option{-gvms}.
9082 @end defmac
9083
9084 @node DBX Options
9085 @subsection Specific Options for DBX Output
9086
9087 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9088 These are specific options for DBX output.
9089
9090 @defmac DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
9091 Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for DBX
9092 in response to the @option{-g} option.
9093 @end defmac
9094
9095 @defmac XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
9096 Define this macro if GCC should produce XCOFF format debugging output
9097 in response to the @option{-g} option. This is a variant of DBX format.
9098 @end defmac
9099
9100 @defmac DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
9101 Define this macro to control whether GCC should by default generate
9102 GDB's extended version of DBX debugging information (assuming DBX-format
9103 debugging information is enabled at all). If you don't define the
9104 macro, the default is 1: always generate the extended information
9105 if there is any occasion to.
9106 @end defmac
9107
9108 @defmac DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
9109 Define this macro if all @code{.stabs} commands should be output while
9110 in the text section.
9111 @end defmac
9112
9113 @defmac ASM_STABS_OP
9114 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9115 use instead of @code{"\t.stabs\t"} to define an ordinary debugging symbol.
9116 If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabs\t"} is used. This macro
9117 applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9118 @end defmac
9119
9120 @defmac ASM_STABD_OP
9121 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9122 use instead of @code{"\t.stabd\t"} to define a debugging symbol whose
9123 value is the current location. If you don't define this macro,
9124 @code{"\t.stabd\t"} is used. This macro applies only to DBX debugging
9125 information format.
9126 @end defmac
9127
9128 @defmac ASM_STABN_OP
9129 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9130 use instead of @code{"\t.stabn\t"} to define a debugging symbol with no
9131 name. If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabn\t"} is used. This
9132 macro applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9133 @end defmac
9134
9135 @defmac DBX_NO_XREFS
9136 Define this macro if DBX on your system does not support the construct
9137 @samp{xs@var{tagname}}. On some systems, this construct is used to
9138 describe a forward reference to a structure named @var{tagname}.
9139 On other systems, this construct is not supported at all.
9140 @end defmac
9141
9142 @defmac DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
9143 A symbol name in DBX-format debugging information is normally
9144 continued (split into two separate @code{.stabs} directives) when it
9145 exceeds a certain length (by default, 80 characters). On some
9146 operating systems, DBX requires this splitting; on others, splitting
9147 must not be done. You can inhibit splitting by defining this macro
9148 with the value zero. You can override the default splitting-length by
9149 defining this macro as an expression for the length you desire.
9150 @end defmac
9151
9152 @defmac DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
9153 Normally continuation is indicated by adding a @samp{\} character to
9154 the end of a @code{.stabs} string when a continuation follows. To use
9155 a different character instead, define this macro as a character
9156 constant for the character you want to use. Do not define this macro
9157 if backslash is correct for your system.
9158 @end defmac
9159
9160 @defmac DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
9161 Define this macro if it is necessary to go to the data section before
9162 outputting the @samp{.stabs} pseudo-op for a non-global static
9163 variable.
9164 @end defmac
9165
9166 @defmac DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
9167 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9168 for a typedef. The default is @code{N_LSYM}.
9169 @end defmac
9170
9171 @defmac DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
9172 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9173 for a static variable located in the text section. DBX format does not
9174 provide any ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_FUN}.
9175 @end defmac
9176
9177 @defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
9178 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9179 for a parameter passed in registers. DBX format does not provide any
9180 ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_RSYM}.
9181 @end defmac
9182
9183 @defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
9184 The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a parameter
9185 passed in registers. DBX format does not customarily provide any way to
9186 do this. The default is @code{'P'}.
9187 @end defmac
9188
9189 @defmac DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
9190 Define this macro if the DBX information for a function and its
9191 arguments should precede the assembler code for the function. Normally,
9192 in DBX format, the debugging information entirely follows the assembler
9193 code.
9194 @end defmac
9195
9196 @defmac DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9197 Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol describing
9198 the scope of a block (@code{N_LBRAC} or @code{N_RBRAC}) should be
9199 relative to the start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses
9200 an absolute address.
9201 @end defmac
9202
9203 @defmac DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9204 Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol indicating
9205 the current line number (@code{N_SLINE}) should be relative to the
9206 start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses an absolute address.
9207 @end defmac
9208
9209 @defmac DBX_USE_BINCL
9210 Define this macro if GCC should generate @code{N_BINCL} and
9211 @code{N_EINCL} stabs for included header files, as on Sun systems. This
9212 macro also directs GCC to output a type number as a pair of a file
9213 number and a type number within the file. Normally, GCC does not
9214 generate @code{N_BINCL} or @code{N_EINCL} stabs, and it outputs a single
9215 number for a type number.
9216 @end defmac
9217
9218 @node DBX Hooks
9219 @subsection Open-Ended Hooks for DBX Format
9220
9221 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9222 These are hooks for DBX format.
9223
9224 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9225 Define this macro to say how to output to @var{stream} the debugging
9226 information for the start of a scope level for variable names. The
9227 argument @var{name} is the name of an assembler symbol (for use with
9228 @code{assemble_name}) whose value is the address where the scope begins.
9229 @end defmac
9230
9231 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_RBRAC (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9232 Like @code{DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC}, but for the end of a scope level.
9233 @end defmac
9234
9235 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NFUN (@var{stream}, @var{lscope_label}, @var{decl})
9236 Define this macro if the target machine requires special handling to
9237 output an @code{N_FUN} entry for the function @var{decl}.
9238 @end defmac
9239
9240 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line}, @var{counter})
9241 A C statement to output DBX debugging information before code for line
9242 number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9243 @var{stream}. @var{counter} is the number of time the macro was
9244 invoked, including the current invocation; it is intended to generate
9245 unique labels in the assembly output.
9246
9247 This macro should not be defined if the default output is correct, or
9248 if it can be made correct by defining @code{DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE}.
9249 @end defmac
9250
9251 @defmac NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
9252 Some stabs encapsulation formats (in particular ECOFF), cannot handle the
9253 @code{.stabs "",N_FUN,,0,0,Lscope-function-1} gdb dbx extension construct.
9254 On those machines, define this macro to turn this feature off without
9255 disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9256 @end defmac
9257
9258 @defmac NO_DBX_BNSYM_ENSYM
9259 Some assemblers cannot handle the @code{.stabd BNSYM/ENSYM,0,0} gdb dbx
9260 extension construct. On those machines, define this macro to turn this
9261 feature off without disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9262 @end defmac
9263
9264 @node File Names and DBX
9265 @subsection File Names in DBX Format
9266
9267 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9268 This describes file names in DBX format.
9269
9270 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9271 A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
9272 @var{stream}, which indicates that file @var{name} is the main source
9273 file---the file specified as the input file for compilation.
9274 This macro is called only once, at the beginning of compilation.
9275
9276 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
9277 for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
9278
9279 It may be necessary to refer to a label equal to the beginning of the
9280 text section. You can use @samp{assemble_name (stream, ltext_label_name)}
9281 to do so. If you do this, you must also set the variable
9282 @var{used_ltext_label_name} to @code{true}.
9283 @end defmac
9284
9285 @defmac NO_DBX_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY
9286 Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9287 of the current directory for compilation and current source language at
9288 the beginning of the file.
9289 @end defmac
9290
9291 @defmac NO_DBX_GCC_MARKER
9292 Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9293 that this object file was compiled by GCC@. The default is to emit
9294 an @code{N_OPT} stab at the beginning of every source file, with
9295 @samp{gcc2_compiled.} for the string and value 0.
9296 @end defmac
9297
9298 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9299 A C statement to output DBX debugging information at the end of
9300 compilation of the main source file @var{name}. Output should be
9301 written to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
9302
9303 If you don't define this macro, nothing special is output at the end
9304 of compilation, which is correct for most machines.
9305 @end defmac
9306
9307 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NULL_N_SO_AT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END
9308 Define this macro @emph{instead of} defining
9309 @code{DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END}, if what needs to be output at
9310 the end of compilation is an @code{N_SO} stab with an empty string,
9311 whose value is the highest absolute text address in the file.
9312 @end defmac
9313
9314 @need 2000
9315 @node SDB and DWARF
9316 @subsection Macros for SDB and DWARF Output
9317
9318 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9319 Here are macros for SDB and DWARF output.
9320
9321 @defmac SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO
9322 Define this macro if GCC should produce COFF-style debugging output
9323 for SDB in response to the @option{-g} option.
9324 @end defmac
9325
9326 @defmac DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
9327 Define this macro if GCC should produce dwarf version 2 format
9328 debugging output in response to the @option{-g} option.
9329
9330 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_DWARF_CALLING_CONVENTION (const_tree @var{function})
9331 Define this to enable the dwarf attribute @code{DW_AT_calling_convention} to
9332 be emitted for each function. Instead of an integer return the enum
9333 value for the @code{DW_CC_} tag.
9334 @end deftypefn
9335
9336 To support optional call frame debugging information, you must also
9337 define @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either set
9338 @code{RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P} on the prologue insns if you use RTL for the
9339 prologue, or call @code{dwarf2out_def_cfa} and @code{dwarf2out_reg_save}
9340 as appropriate from @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} if you don't.
9341 @end defmac
9342
9343 @defmac DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
9344 Define this macro to a nonzero value if GCC should always output
9345 Dwarf 2 frame information. If @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
9346 (@pxref{Exception Region Output}) returns @code{UI_DWARF2}, and
9347 exceptions are enabled, GCC will output this information not matter
9348 how you define @code{DWARF2_FRAME_INFO}.
9349 @end defmac
9350
9351 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum unwind_info_type} TARGET_DEBUG_UNWIND_INFO (void)
9352 This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for describing frame
9353 unwind information to the debugger. Normally the hook will return
9354 @code{UI_DWARF2} if DWARF 2 debug information is enabled, and
9355 return @code{UI_NONE} otherwise.
9356
9357 A target may return @code{UI_DWARF2} even when DWARF 2 debug information
9358 is disabled in order to always output DWARF 2 frame information.
9359
9360 A target may return @code{UI_TARGET} if it has ABI specified unwind tables.
9361 This will suppress generation of the normal debug frame unwind information.
9362 @end deftypefn
9363
9364 @defmac DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
9365 Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the assembler can generate Dwarf 2
9366 line debug info sections. This will result in much more compact line number
9367 tables, and hence is desirable if it works.
9368 @end defmac
9369
9370 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_WANT_DEBUG_PUB_SECTIONS
9371 True if the @code{.debug_pubtypes} and @code{.debug_pubnames} sections should be emitted. These sections are not used on most platforms, and in particular GDB does not use them.
9372 @end deftypevr
9373
9374 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9375 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9376 @var{lab1} minus @var{lab2}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9377 @end defmac
9378
9379 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_VMS_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9380 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9381 between the two given labels in system defined units, e.g. instruction
9382 slots on IA64 VMS, using an integer of the given size.
9383 @end defmac
9384
9385 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_OFFSET (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label}, @var{section})
9386 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a
9387 section-relative reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the
9388 given @var{size}. The label is known to be defined in the given @var{section}.
9389 @end defmac
9390
9391 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_PCREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
9392 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a self-relative
9393 reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9394 @end defmac
9395
9396 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF (@var{label})
9397 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a reference to
9398 the DWARF table identifier @var{label} from the current section. This
9399 is used on some systems to avoid garbage collecting a DWARF table which
9400 is referenced by a function.
9401 @end defmac
9402
9403 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{size}, rtx @var{x})
9404 If defined, this target hook is a function which outputs a DTP-relative
9405 reference to the given TLS symbol of the specified size.
9406 @end deftypefn
9407
9408 @defmac PUT_SDB_@dots{}
9409 Define these macros to override the assembler syntax for the special
9410 SDB assembler directives. See @file{sdbout.c} for a list of these
9411 macros and their arguments. If the standard syntax is used, you need
9412 not define them yourself.
9413 @end defmac
9414
9415 @defmac SDB_DELIM
9416 Some assemblers do not support a semicolon as a delimiter, even between
9417 SDB assembler directives. In that case, define this macro to be the
9418 delimiter to use (usually @samp{\n}). It is not necessary to define
9419 a new set of @code{PUT_SDB_@var{op}} macros if this is the only change
9420 required.
9421 @end defmac
9422
9423 @defmac SDB_ALLOW_UNKNOWN_REFERENCES
9424 Define this macro to allow references to unknown structure,
9425 union, or enumeration tags to be emitted. Standard COFF does not
9426 allow handling of unknown references, MIPS ECOFF has support for
9427 it.
9428 @end defmac
9429
9430 @defmac SDB_ALLOW_FORWARD_REFERENCES
9431 Define this macro to allow references to structure, union, or
9432 enumeration tags that have not yet been seen to be handled. Some
9433 assemblers choke if forward tags are used, while some require it.
9434 @end defmac
9435
9436 @defmac SDB_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line})
9437 A C statement to output SDB debugging information before code for line
9438 number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9439 @var{stream}. The default is to emit an @code{.ln} directive.
9440 @end defmac
9441
9442 @need 2000
9443 @node VMS Debug
9444 @subsection Macros for VMS Debug Format
9445
9446 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9447 Here are macros for VMS debug format.
9448
9449 @defmac VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
9450 Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for VMS
9451 in response to the @option{-g} option. The default behavior for VMS
9452 is to generate minimal debug info for a traceback in the absence of
9453 @option{-g} unless explicitly overridden with @option{-g0}. This
9454 behavior is controlled by @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} and
9455 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}.
9456 @end defmac
9457
9458 @node Floating Point
9459 @section Cross Compilation and Floating Point
9460 @cindex cross compilation and floating point
9461 @cindex floating point and cross compilation
9462
9463 While all modern machines use twos-complement representation for integers,
9464 there are a variety of representations for floating point numbers. This
9465 means that in a cross-compiler the representation of floating point numbers
9466 in the compiled program may be different from that used in the machine
9467 doing the compilation.
9468
9469 Because different representation systems may offer different amounts of
9470 range and precision, all floating point constants must be represented in
9471 the target machine's format. Therefore, the cross compiler cannot
9472 safely use the host machine's floating point arithmetic; it must emulate
9473 the target's arithmetic. To ensure consistency, GCC always uses
9474 emulation to work with floating point values, even when the host and
9475 target floating point formats are identical.
9476
9477 The following macros are provided by @file{real.h} for the compiler to
9478 use. All parts of the compiler which generate or optimize
9479 floating-point calculations must use these macros. They may evaluate
9480 their operands more than once, so operands must not have side effects.
9481
9482 @defmac REAL_VALUE_TYPE
9483 The C data type to be used to hold a floating point value in the target
9484 machine's format. Typically this is a @code{struct} containing an
9485 array of @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}, but all code should treat it as an opaque
9486 quantity.
9487 @end defmac
9488
9489 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9490 Compares for equality the two values, @var{x} and @var{y}. If the target
9491 floating point format supports negative zeroes and/or NaNs,
9492 @samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (-0.0, 0.0)} is true, and
9493 @samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (NaN, NaN)} is false.
9494 @end deftypefn
9495
9496 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_LESS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9497 Tests whether @var{x} is less than @var{y}.
9498 @end deftypefn
9499
9500 @deftypefn Macro HOST_WIDE_INT REAL_VALUE_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9501 Truncates @var{x} to a signed integer, rounding toward zero.
9502 @end deftypefn
9503
9504 @deftypefn Macro {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9505 Truncates @var{x} to an unsigned integer, rounding toward zero. If
9506 @var{x} is negative, returns zero.
9507 @end deftypefn
9508
9509 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ATOF (const char *@var{string}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
9510 Converts @var{string} into a floating point number in the target machine's
9511 representation for mode @var{mode}. This routine can handle both
9512 decimal and hexadecimal floating point constants, using the syntax
9513 defined by the C language for both.
9514 @end deftypefn
9515
9516 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_NEGATIVE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9517 Returns 1 if @var{x} is negative (including negative zero), 0 otherwise.
9518 @end deftypefn
9519
9520 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISINF (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9521 Determines whether @var{x} represents infinity (positive or negative).
9522 @end deftypefn
9523
9524 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISNAN (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9525 Determines whether @var{x} represents a ``NaN'' (not-a-number).
9526 @end deftypefn
9527
9528 @deftypefn Macro void REAL_ARITHMETIC (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{output}, enum tree_code @var{code}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9529 Calculates an arithmetic operation on the two floating point values
9530 @var{x} and @var{y}, storing the result in @var{output} (which must be a
9531 variable).
9532
9533 The operation to be performed is specified by @var{code}. Only the
9534 following codes are supported: @code{PLUS_EXPR}, @code{MINUS_EXPR},
9535 @code{MULT_EXPR}, @code{RDIV_EXPR}, @code{MAX_EXPR}, @code{MIN_EXPR}.
9536
9537 If @code{REAL_ARITHMETIC} is asked to evaluate division by zero and the
9538 target's floating point format cannot represent infinity, it will call
9539 @code{abort}. Callers should check for this situation first, using
9540 @code{MODE_HAS_INFINITIES}. @xref{Storage Layout}.
9541 @end deftypefn
9542
9543 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_NEGATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9544 Returns the negative of the floating point value @var{x}.
9545 @end deftypefn
9546
9547 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ABS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9548 Returns the absolute value of @var{x}.
9549 @end deftypefn
9550
9551 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_TRUNCATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{mode}, enum machine_mode @var{x})
9552 Truncates the floating point value @var{x} to fit in @var{mode}. The
9553 return value is still a full-size @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, but it has an
9554 appropriate bit pattern to be output as a floating constant whose
9555 precision accords with mode @var{mode}.
9556 @end deftypefn
9557
9558 @deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_TO_INT (HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9559 Converts a floating point value @var{x} into a double-precision integer
9560 which is then stored into @var{low} and @var{high}. If the value is not
9561 integral, it is truncated.
9562 @end deftypefn
9563
9564 @deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_FROM_INT (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
9565 Converts a double-precision integer found in @var{low} and @var{high},
9566 into a floating point value which is then stored into @var{x}. The
9567 value is truncated to fit in mode @var{mode}.
9568 @end deftypefn
9569
9570 @node Mode Switching
9571 @section Mode Switching Instructions
9572 @cindex mode switching
9573 The following macros control mode switching optimizations:
9574
9575 @defmac OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING (@var{entity})
9576 Define this macro if the port needs extra instructions inserted for mode
9577 switching in an optimizing compilation.
9578
9579 For an example, the SH4 can perform both single and double precision
9580 floating point operations, but to perform a single precision operation,
9581 the FPSCR PR bit has to be cleared, while for a double precision
9582 operation, this bit has to be set. Changing the PR bit requires a general
9583 purpose register as a scratch register, hence these FPSCR sets have to
9584 be inserted before reload, i.e.@: you can't put this into instruction emitting
9585 or @code{TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG}.
9586
9587 You can have multiple entities that are mode-switched, and select at run time
9588 which entities actually need it. @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} should
9589 return nonzero for any @var{entity} that needs mode-switching.
9590 If you define this macro, you also have to define
9591 @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, @code{MODE_NEEDED},
9592 @code{MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE} and @code{EMIT_MODE_SET}.
9593 @code{MODE_AFTER}, @code{MODE_ENTRY}, and @code{MODE_EXIT}
9594 are optional.
9595 @end defmac
9596
9597 @defmac NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING
9598 If you define @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING}, you have to define this as
9599 initializer for an array of integers. Each initializer element
9600 N refers to an entity that needs mode switching, and specifies the number
9601 of different modes that might need to be set for this entity.
9602 The position of the initializer in the initializer---starting counting at
9603 zero---determines the integer that is used to refer to the mode-switched
9604 entity in question.
9605 In macros that take mode arguments / yield a mode result, modes are
9606 represented as numbers 0 @dots{} N @minus{} 1. N is used to specify that no mode
9607 switch is needed / supplied.
9608 @end defmac
9609
9610 @defmac MODE_NEEDED (@var{entity}, @var{insn})
9611 @var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If
9612 @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} is defined, you must define this macro to
9613 return an integer value not larger than the corresponding element in
9614 @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, to denote the mode that @var{entity} must
9615 be switched into prior to the execution of @var{insn}.
9616 @end defmac
9617
9618 @defmac MODE_AFTER (@var{mode}, @var{insn})
9619 If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{insn} during
9620 mode switching. It determines the mode that an insn results in (if
9621 different from the incoming mode).
9622 @end defmac
9623
9624 @defmac MODE_ENTRY (@var{entity})
9625 If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
9626 mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
9627 @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function entry. If @code{MODE_ENTRY}
9628 is defined then @code{MODE_EXIT} must be defined.
9629 @end defmac
9630
9631 @defmac MODE_EXIT (@var{entity})
9632 If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
9633 mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
9634 @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function exit. If @code{MODE_EXIT}
9635 is defined then @code{MODE_ENTRY} must be defined.
9636 @end defmac
9637
9638 @defmac MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE (@var{entity}, @var{n})
9639 This macro specifies the order in which modes for @var{entity} are processed.
9640 0 is the highest priority, @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING[@var{entity}] - 1} the
9641 lowest. The value of the macro should be an integer designating a mode
9642 for @var{entity}. For any fixed @var{entity}, @code{mode_priority_to_mode}
9643 (@var{entity}, @var{n}) shall be a bijection in 0 @dots{}
9644 @code{num_modes_for_mode_switching[@var{entity}] - 1}.
9645 @end defmac
9646
9647 @defmac EMIT_MODE_SET (@var{entity}, @var{mode}, @var{hard_regs_live})
9648 Generate one or more insns to set @var{entity} to @var{mode}.
9649 @var{hard_reg_live} is the set of hard registers live at the point where
9650 the insn(s) are to be inserted.
9651 @end defmac
9652
9653 @node Target Attributes
9654 @section Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}
9655 @cindex target attributes
9656 @cindex machine attributes
9657 @cindex attributes, target-specific
9658
9659 Target-specific attributes may be defined for functions, data and types.
9660 These are described using the following target hooks; they also need to
9661 be documented in @file{extend.texi}.
9662
9663 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const struct attribute_spec *} TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE
9664 If defined, this target hook points to an array of @samp{struct
9665 attribute_spec} (defined in @file{tree.h}) specifying the machine
9666 specific attributes for this target and some of the restrictions on the
9667 entities to which these attributes are applied and the arguments they
9668 take.
9669 @end deftypevr
9670
9671 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TAKES_IDENTIFIER_P (const_tree @var{name})
9672 If defined, this target hook is a function which returns true if the
9673 machine-specific attribute named @var{name} expects an identifier
9674 given as its first argument to be passed on as a plain identifier, not
9675 subjected to name lookup. If this is not defined, the default is
9676 false for all machine-specific attributes.
9677 @end deftypefn
9678
9679 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (const_tree @var{type1}, const_tree @var{type2})
9680 If defined, this target hook is a function which returns zero if the attributes on
9681 @var{type1} and @var{type2} are incompatible, one if they are compatible,
9682 and two if they are nearly compatible (which causes a warning to be
9683 generated). If this is not defined, machine-specific attributes are
9684 supposed always to be compatible.
9685 @end deftypefn
9686
9687 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_DEFAULT_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type})
9688 If defined, this target hook is a function which assigns default attributes to
9689 the newly defined @var{type}.
9690 @end deftypefn
9691
9692 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type1}, tree @var{type2})
9693 Define this target hook if the merging of type attributes needs special
9694 handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9695 @code{TYPE_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{type1} and @var{type2}. It is assumed
9696 that @code{comptypes} has already been called and returned 1. This
9697 function may call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent
9698 merging.
9699 @end deftypefn
9700
9701 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{olddecl}, tree @var{newdecl})
9702 Define this target hook if the merging of decl attributes needs special
9703 handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9704 @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{olddecl} and @var{newdecl}.
9705 @var{newdecl} is a duplicate declaration of @var{olddecl}. Examples of
9706 when this is needed are when one attribute overrides another, or when an
9707 attribute is nullified by a subsequent definition. This function may
9708 call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent merging.
9709
9710 @findex TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
9711 If the only target-specific handling you require is @samp{dllimport}
9712 for Microsoft Windows targets, you should define the macro
9713 @code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES} to @code{1}. The compiler
9714 will then define a function called
9715 @code{merge_dllimport_decl_attributes} which can then be defined as
9716 the expansion of @code{TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. You can also
9717 add @code{handle_dll_attribute} in the attribute table for your port
9718 to perform initial processing of the @samp{dllimport} and
9719 @samp{dllexport} attributes. This is done in @file{i386/cygwin.h} and
9720 @file{i386/i386.c}, for example.
9721 @end deftypefn
9722
9723 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VALID_DLLIMPORT_ATTRIBUTE_P (const_tree @var{decl})
9724 @var{decl} is a variable or function with @code{__attribute__((dllimport))} specified. Use this hook if the target needs to add extra validation checks to @code{handle_dll_attribute}.
9725 @end deftypefn
9726
9727 @defmac TARGET_DECLSPEC
9728 Define this macro to a nonzero value if you want to treat
9729 @code{__declspec(X)} as equivalent to @code{__attribute((X))}. By
9730 default, this behavior is enabled only for targets that define
9731 @code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. The current implementation
9732 of @code{__declspec} is via a built-in macro, but you should not rely
9733 on this implementation detail.
9734 @end defmac
9735
9736 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{node}, tree *@var{attr_ptr})
9737 Define this target hook if you want to be able to add attributes to a decl
9738 when it is being created. This is normally useful for back ends which
9739 wish to implement a pragma by using the attributes which correspond to
9740 the pragma's effect. The @var{node} argument is the decl which is being
9741 created. The @var{attr_ptr} argument is a pointer to the attribute list
9742 for this decl. The list itself should not be modified, since it may be
9743 shared with other decls, but attributes may be chained on the head of
9744 the list and @code{*@var{attr_ptr}} modified to point to the new
9745 attributes, or a copy of the list may be made if further changes are
9746 needed.
9747 @end deftypefn
9748
9749 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_ATTRIBUTE_INLINABLE_P (const_tree @var{fndecl})
9750 @cindex inlining
9751 This target hook returns @code{true} if it is ok to inline @var{fndecl}
9752 into the current function, despite its having target-specific
9753 attributes, @code{false} otherwise. By default, if a function has a
9754 target specific attribute attached to it, it will not be inlined.
9755 @end deftypefn
9756
9757 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P (tree @var{fndecl}, tree @var{name}, tree @var{args}, int @var{flags})
9758 This hook is called to parse the @code{attribute(option("..."))}, and
9759 it allows the function to set different target machine compile time
9760 options for the current function that might be different than the
9761 options specified on the command line. The hook should return
9762 @code{true} if the options are valid.
9763
9764 The hook should set the @var{DECL_FUNCTION_SPECIFIC_TARGET} field in
9765 the function declaration to hold a pointer to a target specific
9766 @var{struct cl_target_option} structure.
9767 @end deftypefn
9768
9769 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_SAVE (struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
9770 This hook is called to save any additional target specific information
9771 in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for function specific
9772 options.
9773 @xref{Option file format}.
9774 @end deftypefn
9775
9776 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_RESTORE (struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
9777 This hook is called to restore any additional target specific
9778 information in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for
9779 function specific options.
9780 @end deftypefn
9781
9782 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_PRINT (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{indent}, struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
9783 This hook is called to print any additional target specific
9784 information in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for
9785 function specific options.
9786 @end deftypefn
9787
9788 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_PRAGMA_PARSE (tree @var{args}, tree @var{pop_target})
9789 This target hook parses the options for @code{#pragma GCC option} to
9790 set the machine specific options for functions that occur later in the
9791 input stream. The options should be the same as handled by the
9792 @code{TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P} hook.
9793 @end deftypefn
9794
9795 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE (void)
9796 Sometimes certain combinations of command options do not make sense on
9797 a particular target machine. You can override the hook
9798 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} to take account of this. This hooks is called
9799 once just after all the command options have been parsed.
9800
9801 Don't use this hook to turn on various extra optimizations for
9802 @option{-O}. That is what @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} is for.
9803
9804 If you need to do something whenever the optimization level is
9805 changed via the optimize attribute or pragma, see
9806 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}
9807 @end deftypefn
9808
9809 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_INLINE_P (tree @var{caller}, tree @var{callee})
9810 This target hook returns @code{false} if the @var{caller} function
9811 cannot inline @var{callee}, based on target specific information. By
9812 default, inlining is not allowed if the callee function has function
9813 specific target options and the caller does not use the same options.
9814 @end deftypefn
9815
9816 @node Emulated TLS
9817 @section Emulating TLS
9818 @cindex Emulated TLS
9819
9820 For targets whose psABI does not provide Thread Local Storage via
9821 specific relocations and instruction sequences, an emulation layer is
9822 used. A set of target hooks allows this emulation layer to be
9823 configured for the requirements of a particular target. For instance
9824 the psABI may in fact specify TLS support in terms of an emulation
9825 layer.
9826
9827 The emulation layer works by creating a control object for every TLS
9828 object. To access the TLS object, a lookup function is provided
9829 which, when given the address of the control object, will return the
9830 address of the current thread's instance of the TLS object.
9831
9832 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_GET_ADDRESS
9833 Contains the name of the helper function that uses a TLS control
9834 object to locate a TLS instance. The default causes libgcc's
9835 emulated TLS helper function to be used.
9836 @end deftypevr
9837
9838 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_REGISTER_COMMON
9839 Contains the name of the helper function that should be used at
9840 program startup to register TLS objects that are implicitly
9841 initialized to zero. If this is @code{NULL}, all TLS objects will
9842 have explicit initializers. The default causes libgcc's emulated TLS
9843 registration function to be used.
9844 @end deftypevr
9845
9846 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_SECTION
9847 Contains the name of the section in which TLS control variables should
9848 be placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in
9849 any section.
9850 @end deftypevr
9851
9852 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_SECTION
9853 Contains the name of the section in which TLS initializers should be
9854 placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in any
9855 section.
9856 @end deftypevr
9857
9858 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_PREFIX
9859 Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS control variable names.
9860 The default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
9861 @end deftypevr
9862
9863 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_PREFIX
9864 Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS initializer objects. The
9865 default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
9866 @end deftypevr
9867
9868 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_FIELDS (tree @var{type}, tree *@var{name})
9869 Specifies a function that generates the FIELD_DECLs for a TLS control
9870 object type. @var{type} is the RECORD_TYPE the fields are for and
9871 @var{name} should be filled with the structure tag, if the default of
9872 @code{__emutls_object} is unsuitable. The default creates a type suitable
9873 for libgcc's emulated TLS function.
9874 @end deftypefn
9875
9876 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_INIT (tree @var{var}, tree @var{decl}, tree @var{tmpl_addr})
9877 Specifies a function that generates the CONSTRUCTOR to initialize a
9878 TLS control object. @var{var} is the TLS control object, @var{decl}
9879 is the TLS object and @var{tmpl_addr} is the address of the
9880 initializer. The default initializes libgcc's emulated TLS control object.
9881 @end deftypefn
9882
9883 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_ALIGN_FIXED
9884 Specifies whether the alignment of TLS control variable objects is
9885 fixed and should not be increased as some backends may do to optimize
9886 single objects. The default is false.
9887 @end deftypevr
9888
9889 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_EMUTLS_DEBUG_FORM_TLS_ADDRESS
9890 Specifies whether a DWARF @code{DW_OP_form_tls_address} location descriptor
9891 may be used to describe emulated TLS control objects.
9892 @end deftypevr
9893
9894 @node MIPS Coprocessors
9895 @section Defining coprocessor specifics for MIPS targets.
9896 @cindex MIPS coprocessor-definition macros
9897
9898 The MIPS specification allows MIPS implementations to have as many as 4
9899 coprocessors, each with as many as 32 private registers. GCC supports
9900 accessing these registers and transferring values between the registers
9901 and memory using asm-ized variables. For example:
9902
9903 @smallexample
9904 register unsigned int cp0count asm ("c0r1");
9905 unsigned int d;
9906
9907 d = cp0count + 3;
9908 @end smallexample
9909
9910 (``c0r1'' is the default name of register 1 in coprocessor 0; alternate
9911 names may be added as described below, or the default names may be
9912 overridden entirely in @code{SUBTARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}.)
9913
9914 Coprocessor registers are assumed to be epilogue-used; sets to them will
9915 be preserved even if it does not appear that the register is used again
9916 later in the function.
9917
9918 Another note: according to the MIPS spec, coprocessor 1 (if present) is
9919 the FPU@. One accesses COP1 registers through standard mips
9920 floating-point support; they are not included in this mechanism.
9921
9922 There is one macro used in defining the MIPS coprocessor interface which
9923 you may want to override in subtargets; it is described below.
9924
9925 @defmac ALL_COP_ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
9926 A comma-separated list (with leading comma) of pairs describing the
9927 alternate names of coprocessor registers. The format of each entry should be
9928 @smallexample
9929 @{ @var{alternatename}, @var{register_number}@}
9930 @end smallexample
9931 Default: empty.
9932 @end defmac
9933
9934 @node PCH Target
9935 @section Parameters for Precompiled Header Validity Checking
9936 @cindex parameters, precompiled headers
9937
9938 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY (size_t *@var{sz})
9939 This hook returns a pointer to the data needed by
9940 @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} and sets
9941 @samp{*@var{sz}} to the size of the data in bytes.
9942 @end deftypefn
9943
9944 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_PCH_VALID_P (const void *@var{data}, size_t @var{sz})
9945 This hook checks whether the options used to create a PCH file are
9946 compatible with the current settings. It returns @code{NULL}
9947 if so and a suitable error message if not. Error messages will
9948 be presented to the user and must be localized using @samp{_(@var{msg})}.
9949
9950 @var{data} is the data that was returned by @code{TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY}
9951 when the PCH file was created and @var{sz} is the size of that data in bytes.
9952 It's safe to assume that the data was created by the same version of the
9953 compiler, so no format checking is needed.
9954
9955 The default definition of @code{default_pch_valid_p} should be
9956 suitable for most targets.
9957 @end deftypefn
9958
9959 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_CHECK_PCH_TARGET_FLAGS (int @var{pch_flags})
9960 If this hook is nonnull, the default implementation of
9961 @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} will use it to check for compatible values
9962 of @code{target_flags}. @var{pch_flags} specifies the value that
9963 @code{target_flags} had when the PCH file was created. The return
9964 value is the same as for @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P}.
9965 @end deftypefn
9966
9967 @node C++ ABI
9968 @section C++ ABI parameters
9969 @cindex parameters, c++ abi
9970
9971 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_GUARD_TYPE (void)
9972 Define this hook to override the integer type used for guard variables.
9973 These are used to implement one-time construction of static objects. The
9974 default is long_long_integer_type_node.
9975 @end deftypefn
9976
9977 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_GUARD_MASK_BIT (void)
9978 This hook determines how guard variables are used. It should return
9979 @code{false} (the default) if the first byte should be used. A return value of
9980 @code{true} indicates that only the least significant bit should be used.
9981 @end deftypefn
9982
9983 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_GET_COOKIE_SIZE (tree @var{type})
9984 This hook returns the size of the cookie to use when allocating an array
9985 whose elements have the indicated @var{type}. Assumes that it is already
9986 known that a cookie is needed. The default is
9987 @code{max(sizeof (size_t), alignof(type))}, as defined in section 2.7 of the
9988 IA64/Generic C++ ABI@.
9989 @end deftypefn
9990
9991 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_COOKIE_HAS_SIZE (void)
9992 This hook should return @code{true} if the element size should be stored in
9993 array cookies. The default is to return @code{false}.
9994 @end deftypefn
9995
9996 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_CXX_IMPORT_EXPORT_CLASS (tree @var{type}, int @var{import_export})
9997 If defined by a backend this hook allows the decision made to export
9998 class @var{type} to be overruled. Upon entry @var{import_export}
9999 will contain 1 if the class is going to be exported, @minus{}1 if it is going
10000 to be imported and 0 otherwise. This function should return the
10001 modified value and perform any other actions necessary to support the
10002 backend's targeted operating system.
10003 @end deftypefn
10004
10005 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_CDTOR_RETURNS_THIS (void)
10006 This hook should return @code{true} if constructors and destructors return
10007 the address of the object created/destroyed. The default is to return
10008 @code{false}.
10009 @end deftypefn
10010
10011 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_KEY_METHOD_MAY_BE_INLINE (void)
10012 This hook returns true if the key method for a class (i.e., the method
10013 which, if defined in the current translation unit, causes the virtual
10014 table to be emitted) may be an inline function. Under the standard
10015 Itanium C++ ABI the key method may be an inline function so long as
10016 the function is not declared inline in the class definition. Under
10017 some variants of the ABI, an inline function can never be the key
10018 method. The default is to return @code{true}.
10019 @end deftypefn
10020
10021 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CXX_DETERMINE_CLASS_DATA_VISIBILITY (tree @var{decl})
10022 @var{decl} is a virtual table, virtual table table, typeinfo object, or other similar implicit class data object that will be emitted with external linkage in this translation unit. No ELF visibility has been explicitly specified. If the target needs to specify a visibility other than that of the containing class, use this hook to set @code{DECL_VISIBILITY} and @code{DECL_VISIBILITY_SPECIFIED}.
10023 @end deftypefn
10024
10025 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_CLASS_DATA_ALWAYS_COMDAT (void)
10026 This hook returns true (the default) if virtual tables and other
10027 similar implicit class data objects are always COMDAT if they have
10028 external linkage. If this hook returns false, then class data for
10029 classes whose virtual table will be emitted in only one translation
10030 unit will not be COMDAT.
10031 @end deftypefn
10032
10033 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_LIBRARY_RTTI_COMDAT (void)
10034 This hook returns true (the default) if the RTTI information for
10035 the basic types which is defined in the C++ runtime should always
10036 be COMDAT, false if it should not be COMDAT.
10037 @end deftypefn
10038
10039 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_USE_AEABI_ATEXIT (void)
10040 This hook returns true if @code{__aeabi_atexit} (as defined by the ARM EABI)
10041 should be used to register static destructors when @option{-fuse-cxa-atexit}
10042 is in effect. The default is to return false to use @code{__cxa_atexit}.
10043 @end deftypefn
10044
10045 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_USE_ATEXIT_FOR_CXA_ATEXIT (void)
10046 This hook returns true if the target @code{atexit} function can be used
10047 in the same manner as @code{__cxa_atexit} to register C++ static
10048 destructors. This requires that @code{atexit}-registered functions in
10049 shared libraries are run in the correct order when the libraries are
10050 unloaded. The default is to return false.
10051 @end deftypefn
10052
10053 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CXX_ADJUST_CLASS_AT_DEFINITION (tree @var{type})
10054 @var{type} is a C++ class (i.e., RECORD_TYPE or UNION_TYPE) that has just been defined. Use this hook to make adjustments to the class (eg, tweak visibility or perform any other required target modifications).
10055 @end deftypefn
10056
10057 @node Named Address Spaces
10058 @section Adding support for named address spaces
10059 @cindex named address spaces
10060
10061 The draft technical report of the ISO/IEC JTC1 S22 WG14 N1275
10062 standards committee, @cite{Programming Languages - C - Extensions to
10063 support embedded processors}, specifies a syntax for embedded
10064 processors to specify alternate address spaces. You can configure a
10065 GCC port to support section 5.1 of the draft report to add support for
10066 address spaces other than the default address space. These address
10067 spaces are new keywords that are similar to the @code{volatile} and
10068 @code{const} type attributes.
10069
10070 Pointers to named address spaces can have a different size than
10071 pointers to the generic address space.
10072
10073 For example, the SPU port uses the @code{__ea} address space to refer
10074 to memory in the host processor, rather than memory local to the SPU
10075 processor. Access to memory in the @code{__ea} address space involves
10076 issuing DMA operations to move data between the host processor and the
10077 local processor memory address space. Pointers in the @code{__ea}
10078 address space are either 32 bits or 64 bits based on the
10079 @option{-mea32} or @option{-mea64} switches (native SPU pointers are
10080 always 32 bits).
10081
10082 Internally, address spaces are represented as a small integer in the
10083 range 0 to 15 with address space 0 being reserved for the generic
10084 address space.
10085
10086 To register a named address space qualifier keyword with the C front end,
10087 the target may call the @code{c_register_addr_space} routine. For example,
10088 the SPU port uses the following to declare @code{__ea} as the keyword for
10089 named address space #1:
10090 @smallexample
10091 #define ADDR_SPACE_EA 1
10092 c_register_addr_space ("__ea", ADDR_SPACE_EA);
10093 @end smallexample
10094
10095 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE (addr_space_t @var{address_space})
10096 Define this to return the machine mode to use for pointers to
10097 @var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10098 The default version of this hook returns @code{ptr_mode} for the
10099 generic address space only.
10100 @end deftypefn
10101
10102 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE (addr_space_t @var{address_space})
10103 Define this to return the machine mode to use for addresses in
10104 @var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10105 The default version of this hook returns @code{Pmode} for the
10106 generic address space only.
10107 @end deftypefn
10108
10109 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_VALID_POINTER_MODE (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as})
10110 Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
10111 with machine mode @var{mode} to address space @var{as}. This target
10112 hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE} target hook,
10113 except that it includes explicit named address space support. The default
10114 version of this hook returns true for the modes returned by either the
10115 @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE} or @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE}
10116 target hooks for the given address space.
10117 @end deftypefn
10118
10119 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{exp}, bool @var{strict}, addr_space_t @var{as})
10120 Define this to return true if @var{exp} is a valid address for mode
10121 @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. The @var{strict}
10122 parameter says whether strict addressing is in effect after reload has
10123 finished. This target hook is the same as the
10124 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} target hook, except that it includes
10125 explicit named address space support.
10126 @end deftypefn
10127
10128 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x}, rtx @var{oldx}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as})
10129 Define this to modify an invalid address @var{x} to be a valid address
10130 with mode @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. This target
10131 hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} target hook,
10132 except that it includes explicit named address space support.
10133 @end deftypefn
10134
10135 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P (addr_space_t @var{superset}, addr_space_t @var{subset})
10136 Define this to return whether the @var{subset} named address space is
10137 contained within the @var{superset} named address space. Pointers to
10138 a named address space that is a subset of another named address space
10139 will be converted automatically without a cast if used together in
10140 arithmetic operations. Pointers to a superset address space can be
10141 converted to pointers to a subset address space via explicit casts.
10142 @end deftypefn
10143
10144 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_CONVERT (rtx @var{op}, tree @var{from_type}, tree @var{to_type})
10145 Define this to convert the pointer expression represented by the RTL
10146 @var{op} with type @var{from_type} that points to a named address
10147 space to a new pointer expression with type @var{to_type} that points
10148 to a different named address space. When this hook it called, it is
10149 guaranteed that one of the two address spaces is a subset of the other,
10150 as determined by the @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P} target hook.
10151 @end deftypefn
10152
10153 @node Misc
10154 @section Miscellaneous Parameters
10155 @cindex parameters, miscellaneous
10156
10157 @c prevent bad page break with this line
10158 Here are several miscellaneous parameters.
10159
10160 @defmac HAS_LONG_COND_BRANCH
10161 Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10162 has conditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10163 conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10164 blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10165 set to false, gcc will convert any conditional branches that attempt
10166 to cross between sections into unconditional branches or indirect jumps.
10167 @end defmac
10168
10169 @defmac HAS_LONG_UNCOND_BRANCH
10170 Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10171 has unconditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10172 conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10173 blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10174 set to false, gcc will convert any unconditional branches that attempt
10175 to cross between sections into indirect jumps.
10176 @end defmac
10177
10178 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_MODE
10179 An alias for a machine mode name. This is the machine mode that
10180 elements of a jump-table should have.
10181 @end defmac
10182
10183 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE (@var{min_offset}, @var{max_offset}, @var{body})
10184 Optional: return the preferred mode for an @code{addr_diff_vec}
10185 when the minimum and maximum offset are known. If you define this,
10186 it enables extra code in branch shortening to deal with @code{addr_diff_vec}.
10187 To make this work, you also have to define @code{INSN_ALIGN} and
10188 make the alignment for @code{addr_diff_vec} explicit.
10189 The @var{body} argument is provided so that the offset_unsigned and scale
10190 flags can be updated.
10191 @end defmac
10192
10193 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
10194 Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate when jump-tables
10195 should contain relative addresses. You need not define this macro if
10196 jump-tables never contain relative addresses, or jump-tables should
10197 contain relative addresses only when @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fPIC}
10198 is in effect.
10199 @end defmac
10200
10201 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD (void)
10202 This function return the smallest number of different values for which it
10203 is best to use a jump-table instead of a tree of conditional branches.
10204 The default is four for machines with a @code{casesi} instruction and
10205 five otherwise. This is best for most machines.
10206 @end deftypefn
10207
10208 @defmac CASE_USE_BIT_TESTS
10209 Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate whether C switch
10210 statements may be implemented by a sequence of bit tests. This is
10211 advantageous on processors that can efficiently implement left shift
10212 of 1 by the number of bits held in a register, but inappropriate on
10213 targets that would require a loop. By default, this macro returns
10214 @code{true} if the target defines an @code{ashlsi3} pattern, and
10215 @code{false} otherwise.
10216 @end defmac
10217
10218 @defmac WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
10219 Define this macro if operations between registers with integral mode
10220 smaller than a word are always performed on the entire register.
10221 Most RISC machines have this property and most CISC machines do not.
10222 @end defmac
10223
10224 @defmac LOAD_EXTEND_OP (@var{mem_mode})
10225 Define this macro to be a C expression indicating when insns that read
10226 memory in @var{mem_mode}, an integral mode narrower than a word, set the
10227 bits outside of @var{mem_mode} to be either the sign-extension or the
10228 zero-extension of the data read. Return @code{SIGN_EXTEND} for values
10229 of @var{mem_mode} for which the
10230 insn sign-extends, @code{ZERO_EXTEND} for which it zero-extends, and
10231 @code{UNKNOWN} for other modes.
10232
10233 This macro is not called with @var{mem_mode} non-integral or with a width
10234 greater than or equal to @code{BITS_PER_WORD}, so you may return any
10235 value in this case. Do not define this macro if it would always return
10236 @code{UNKNOWN}. On machines where this macro is defined, you will normally
10237 define it as the constant @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{ZERO_EXTEND}.
10238
10239 You may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN} value even if for some hard registers
10240 the sign extension is not performed, if for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS}
10241 of these hard registers @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero
10242 when the @var{from} mode is @var{mem_mode} and the @var{to} mode is any
10243 integral mode larger than this but not larger than @code{word_mode}.
10244
10245 You must return @code{UNKNOWN} if for some hard registers that allow this
10246 mode, @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} says that they cannot change to
10247 @code{word_mode}, but that they can change to another integral mode that
10248 is larger then @var{mem_mode} but still smaller than @code{word_mode}.
10249 @end defmac
10250
10251 @defmac SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
10252 Define this macro if loading short immediate values into registers sign
10253 extends.
10254 @end defmac
10255
10256 @defmac FIXUNS_TRUNC_LIKE_FIX_TRUNC
10257 Define this macro if the same instructions that convert a floating
10258 point number to a signed fixed point number also convert validly to an
10259 unsigned one.
10260 @end defmac
10261
10262 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_MIN_DIVISIONS_FOR_RECIP_MUL (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
10263 When @option{-ffast-math} is in effect, GCC tries to optimize
10264 divisions by the same divisor, by turning them into multiplications by
10265 the reciprocal. This target hook specifies the minimum number of divisions
10266 that should be there for GCC to perform the optimization for a variable
10267 of mode @var{mode}. The default implementation returns 3 if the machine
10268 has an instruction for the division, and 2 if it does not.
10269 @end deftypefn
10270
10271 @defmac MOVE_MAX
10272 The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10273 between memory and registers or between two memory locations.
10274 @end defmac
10275
10276 @defmac MAX_MOVE_MAX
10277 The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10278 between memory and registers or between two memory locations. If this
10279 is undefined, the default is @code{MOVE_MAX}. Otherwise, it is the
10280 constant value that is the largest value that @code{MOVE_MAX} can have
10281 at run-time.
10282 @end defmac
10283
10284 @defmac SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
10285 A C expression that is nonzero if on this machine the number of bits
10286 actually used for the count of a shift operation is equal to the number
10287 of bits needed to represent the size of the object being shifted. When
10288 this macro is nonzero, the compiler will assume that it is safe to omit
10289 a sign-extend, zero-extend, and certain bitwise `and' instructions that
10290 truncates the count of a shift operation. On machines that have
10291 instructions that act on bit-fields at variable positions, which may
10292 include `bit test' instructions, a nonzero @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10293 also enables deletion of truncations of the values that serve as
10294 arguments to bit-field instructions.
10295
10296 If both types of instructions truncate the count (for shifts) and
10297 position (for bit-field operations), or if no variable-position bit-field
10298 instructions exist, you should define this macro.
10299
10300 However, on some machines, such as the 80386 and the 680x0, truncation
10301 only applies to shift operations and not the (real or pretended)
10302 bit-field operations. Define @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} to be zero on
10303 such machines. Instead, add patterns to the @file{md} file that include
10304 the implied truncation of the shift instructions.
10305
10306 You need not define this macro if it would always have the value of zero.
10307 @end defmac
10308
10309 @anchor{TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK}
10310 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
10311 This function describes how the standard shift patterns for @var{mode}
10312 deal with shifts by negative amounts or by more than the width of the mode.
10313 @xref{shift patterns}.
10314
10315 On many machines, the shift patterns will apply a mask @var{m} to the
10316 shift count, meaning that a fixed-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y} is
10317 equivalent to an arbitrary-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y & m}. If
10318 this is true for mode @var{mode}, the function should return @var{m},
10319 otherwise it should return 0. A return value of 0 indicates that no
10320 particular behavior is guaranteed.
10321
10322 Note that, unlike @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}, this function does
10323 @emph{not} apply to general shift rtxes; it applies only to instructions
10324 that are generated by the named shift patterns.
10325
10326 The default implementation of this function returns
10327 @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE (@var{mode}) - 1} if @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10328 and 0 otherwise. This definition is always safe, but if
10329 @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} is false, and some shift patterns
10330 nevertheless truncate the shift count, you may get better code
10331 by overriding it.
10332 @end deftypefn
10333
10334 @defmac TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (@var{outprec}, @var{inprec})
10335 A C expression which is nonzero if on this machine it is safe to
10336 ``convert'' an integer of @var{inprec} bits to one of @var{outprec}
10337 bits (where @var{outprec} is smaller than @var{inprec}) by merely
10338 operating on it as if it had only @var{outprec} bits.
10339
10340 On many machines, this expression can be 1.
10341
10342 @c rearranged this, removed the phrase "it is reported that". this was
10343 @c to fix an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
10344 When @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} returns 1 for a pair of sizes for
10345 modes for which @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P} is 0, suboptimal code can result.
10346 If this is the case, making @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} return 0 in
10347 such cases may improve things.
10348 @end defmac
10349
10350 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, enum machine_mode @var{rep_mode})
10351 The representation of an integral mode can be such that the values
10352 are always extended to a wider integral mode. Return
10353 @code{SIGN_EXTEND} if values of @var{mode} are represented in
10354 sign-extended form to @var{rep_mode}. Return @code{UNKNOWN}
10355 otherwise. (Currently, none of the targets use zero-extended
10356 representation this way so unlike @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP},
10357 @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} is expected to return either
10358 @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{UNKNOWN}. Also no target extends
10359 @var{mode} to @var{rep_mode} so that @var{rep_mode} is not the next
10360 widest integral mode and currently we take advantage of this fact.)
10361
10362 Similarly to @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP} you may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN}
10363 value even if the extension is not performed on certain hard registers
10364 as long as for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS} of these hard registers
10365 @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero.
10366
10367 Note that @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} and @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP}
10368 describe two related properties. If you define
10369 @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (mode, word_mode)} you probably also want
10370 to define @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP (mode)} to return the same type of
10371 extension.
10372
10373 In order to enforce the representation of @code{mode},
10374 @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} should return false when truncating to
10375 @code{mode}.
10376 @end deftypefn
10377
10378 @defmac STORE_FLAG_VALUE
10379 A C expression describing the value returned by a comparison operator
10380 with an integral mode and stored by a store-flag instruction
10381 (@samp{cstore@var{mode}4}) when the condition is true. This description must
10382 apply to @emph{all} the @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} patterns and all the
10383 comparison operators whose results have a @code{MODE_INT} mode.
10384
10385 A value of 1 or @minus{}1 means that the instruction implementing the
10386 comparison operator returns exactly 1 or @minus{}1 when the comparison is true
10387 and 0 when the comparison is false. Otherwise, the value indicates
10388 which bits of the result are guaranteed to be 1 when the comparison is
10389 true. This value is interpreted in the mode of the comparison
10390 operation, which is given by the mode of the first operand in the
10391 @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} pattern. Either the low bit or the sign bit of
10392 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} be on. Presently, only those bits are used by
10393 the compiler.
10394
10395 If @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is neither 1 or @minus{}1, the compiler will
10396 generate code that depends only on the specified bits. It can also
10397 replace comparison operators with equivalent operations if they cause
10398 the required bits to be set, even if the remaining bits are undefined.
10399 For example, on a machine whose comparison operators return an
10400 @code{SImode} value and where @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is defined as
10401 @samp{0x80000000}, saying that just the sign bit is relevant, the
10402 expression
10403
10404 @smallexample
10405 (ne:SI (and:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{power-of-2})) (const_int 0))
10406 @end smallexample
10407
10408 @noindent
10409 can be converted to
10410
10411 @smallexample
10412 (ashift:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{n}))
10413 @end smallexample
10414
10415 @noindent
10416 where @var{n} is the appropriate shift count to move the bit being
10417 tested into the sign bit.
10418
10419 There is no way to describe a machine that always sets the low-order bit
10420 for a true value, but does not guarantee the value of any other bits,
10421 but we do not know of any machine that has such an instruction. If you
10422 are trying to port GCC to such a machine, include an instruction to
10423 perform a logical-and of the result with 1 in the pattern for the
10424 comparison operators and let us know at @email{gcc@@gcc.gnu.org}.
10425
10426 Often, a machine will have multiple instructions that obtain a value
10427 from a comparison (or the condition codes). Here are rules to guide the
10428 choice of value for @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}, and hence the instructions
10429 to be used:
10430
10431 @itemize @bullet
10432 @item
10433 Use the shortest sequence that yields a valid definition for
10434 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}. It is more efficient for the compiler to
10435 ``normalize'' the value (convert it to, e.g., 1 or 0) than for the
10436 comparison operators to do so because there may be opportunities to
10437 combine the normalization with other operations.
10438
10439 @item
10440 For equal-length sequences, use a value of 1 or @minus{}1, with @minus{}1 being
10441 slightly preferred on machines with expensive jumps and 1 preferred on
10442 other machines.
10443
10444 @item
10445 As a second choice, choose a value of @samp{0x80000001} if instructions
10446 exist that set both the sign and low-order bits but do not define the
10447 others.
10448
10449 @item
10450 Otherwise, use a value of @samp{0x80000000}.
10451 @end itemize
10452
10453 Many machines can produce both the value chosen for
10454 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} and its negation in the same number of
10455 instructions. On those machines, you should also define a pattern for
10456 those cases, e.g., one matching
10457
10458 @smallexample
10459 (set @var{A} (neg:@var{m} (ne:@var{m} @var{B} @var{C})))
10460 @end smallexample
10461
10462 Some machines can also perform @code{and} or @code{plus} operations on
10463 condition code values with less instructions than the corresponding
10464 @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} insn followed by @code{and} or @code{plus}. On those
10465 machines, define the appropriate patterns. Use the names @code{incscc}
10466 and @code{decscc}, respectively, for the patterns which perform
10467 @code{plus} or @code{minus} operations on condition code values. See
10468 @file{rs6000.md} for some examples. The GNU Superoptizer can be used to
10469 find such instruction sequences on other machines.
10470
10471 If this macro is not defined, the default value, 1, is used. You need
10472 not define @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} if the machine has no store-flag
10473 instructions, or if the value generated by these instructions is 1.
10474 @end defmac
10475
10476 @defmac FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10477 A C expression that gives a nonzero @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} value that is
10478 returned when comparison operators with floating-point results are true.
10479 Define this macro on machines that have comparison operations that return
10480 floating-point values. If there are no such operations, do not define
10481 this macro.
10482 @end defmac
10483
10484 @defmac VECTOR_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10485 A C expression that gives a rtx representing the nonzero true element
10486 for vector comparisons. The returned rtx should be valid for the inner
10487 mode of @var{mode} which is guaranteed to be a vector mode. Define
10488 this macro on machines that have vector comparison operations that
10489 return a vector result. If there are no such operations, do not define
10490 this macro. Typically, this macro is defined as @code{const1_rtx} or
10491 @code{constm1_rtx}. This macro may return @code{NULL_RTX} to prevent
10492 the compiler optimizing such vector comparison operations for the
10493 given mode.
10494 @end defmac
10495
10496 @defmac CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10497 @defmacx CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10498 A C expression that indicates whether the architecture defines a value
10499 for @code{clz} or @code{ctz} with a zero operand.
10500 A result of @code{0} indicates the value is undefined.
10501 If the value is defined for only the RTL expression, the macro should
10502 evaluate to @code{1}; if the value applies also to the corresponding optab
10503 entry (which is normally the case if it expands directly into
10504 the corresponding RTL), then the macro should evaluate to @code{2}.
10505 In the cases where the value is defined, @var{value} should be set to
10506 this value.
10507
10508 If this macro is not defined, the value of @code{clz} or
10509 @code{ctz} at zero is assumed to be undefined.
10510
10511 This macro must be defined if the target's expansion for @code{ffs}
10512 relies on a particular value to get correct results. Otherwise it
10513 is not necessary, though it may be used to optimize some corner cases, and
10514 to provide a default expansion for the @code{ffs} optab.
10515
10516 Note that regardless of this macro the ``definedness'' of @code{clz}
10517 and @code{ctz} at zero do @emph{not} extend to the builtin functions
10518 visible to the user. Thus one may be free to adjust the value at will
10519 to match the target expansion of these operations without fear of
10520 breaking the API@.
10521 @end defmac
10522
10523 @defmac Pmode
10524 An alias for the machine mode for pointers. On most machines, define
10525 this to be the integer mode corresponding to the width of a hardware
10526 pointer; @code{SImode} on 32-bit machine or @code{DImode} on 64-bit machines.
10527 On some machines you must define this to be one of the partial integer
10528 modes, such as @code{PSImode}.
10529
10530 The width of @code{Pmode} must be at least as large as the value of
10531 @code{POINTER_SIZE}. If it is not equal, you must define the macro
10532 @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED} to specify how pointers are extended
10533 to @code{Pmode}.
10534 @end defmac
10535
10536 @defmac FUNCTION_MODE
10537 An alias for the machine mode used for memory references to functions
10538 being called, in @code{call} RTL expressions. On most CISC machines,
10539 where an instruction can begin at any byte address, this should be
10540 @code{QImode}. On most RISC machines, where all instructions have fixed
10541 size and alignment, this should be a mode with the same size and alignment
10542 as the machine instruction words - typically @code{SImode} or @code{HImode}.
10543 @end defmac
10544
10545 @defmac STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS
10546 In normal operation, the preprocessor expands @code{__STDC__} to the
10547 constant 1, to signify that GCC conforms to ISO Standard C@. On some
10548 hosts, like Solaris, the system compiler uses a different convention,
10549 where @code{__STDC__} is normally 0, but is 1 if the user specifies
10550 strict conformance to the C Standard.
10551
10552 Defining @code{STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS} makes GNU CPP follows the host
10553 convention when processing system header files, but when processing user
10554 files @code{__STDC__} will always expand to 1.
10555 @end defmac
10556
10557 @defmac NO_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
10558 Define this macro if the system header files support C++ as well as C@.
10559 This macro inhibits the usual method of using system header files in
10560 C++, which is to pretend that the file's contents are enclosed in
10561 @samp{extern "C" @{@dots{}@}}.
10562 @end defmac
10563
10564 @findex #pragma
10565 @findex pragma
10566 @defmac REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS ()
10567 Define this macro if you want to implement any target-specific pragmas.
10568 If defined, it is a C expression which makes a series of calls to
10569 @code{c_register_pragma} or @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion}
10570 for each pragma. The macro may also do any
10571 setup required for the pragmas.
10572
10573 The primary reason to define this macro is to provide compatibility with
10574 other compilers for the same target. In general, we discourage
10575 definition of target-specific pragmas for GCC@.
10576
10577 If the pragma can be implemented by attributes then you should consider
10578 defining the target hook @samp{TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES} as well.
10579
10580 Preprocessor macros that appear on pragma lines are not expanded. All
10581 @samp{#pragma} directives that do not match any registered pragma are
10582 silently ignored, unless the user specifies @option{-Wunknown-pragmas}.
10583 @end defmac
10584
10585 @deftypefun void c_register_pragma (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
10586 @deftypefunx void c_register_pragma_with_expansion (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
10587
10588 Each call to @code{c_register_pragma} or
10589 @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} establishes one pragma. The
10590 @var{callback} routine will be called when the preprocessor encounters a
10591 pragma of the form
10592
10593 @smallexample
10594 #pragma [@var{space}] @var{name} @dots{}
10595 @end smallexample
10596
10597 @var{space} is the case-sensitive namespace of the pragma, or
10598 @code{NULL} to put the pragma in the global namespace. The callback
10599 routine receives @var{pfile} as its first argument, which can be passed
10600 on to cpplib's functions if necessary. You can lex tokens after the
10601 @var{name} by calling @code{pragma_lex}. Tokens that are not read by the
10602 callback will be silently ignored. The end of the line is indicated by
10603 a token of type @code{CPP_EOF}. Macro expansion occurs on the
10604 arguments of pragmas registered with
10605 @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} but not on the arguments of
10606 pragmas registered with @code{c_register_pragma}.
10607
10608 Note that the use of @code{pragma_lex} is specific to the C and C++
10609 compilers. It will not work in the Java or Fortran compilers, or any
10610 other language compilers for that matter. Thus if @code{pragma_lex} is going
10611 to be called from target-specific code, it must only be done so when
10612 building the C and C++ compilers. This can be done by defining the
10613 variables @code{c_target_objs} and @code{cxx_target_objs} in the
10614 target entry in the @file{config.gcc} file. These variables should name
10615 the target-specific, language-specific object file which contains the
10616 code that uses @code{pragma_lex}. Note it will also be necessary to add a
10617 rule to the makefile fragment pointed to by @code{tmake_file} that shows
10618 how to build this object file.
10619 @end deftypefun
10620
10621 @findex #pragma
10622 @findex pragma
10623 @defmac HANDLE_SYSV_PRAGMA
10624 Define this macro (to a value of 1) if you want the System V style
10625 pragmas @samp{#pragma pack(<n>)} and @samp{#pragma weak <name>
10626 [=<value>]} to be supported by gcc.
10627
10628 The pack pragma specifies the maximum alignment (in bytes) of fields
10629 within a structure, in much the same way as the @samp{__aligned__} and
10630 @samp{__packed__} @code{__attribute__}s do. A pack value of zero resets
10631 the behavior to the default.
10632
10633 A subtlety for Microsoft Visual C/C++ style bit-field packing
10634 (e.g.@: -mms-bitfields) for targets that support it:
10635 When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size
10636 of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent
10637 bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record,
10638 and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same
10639 chunk of 32 bits. However, if the size changes, a new field of that
10640 size is allocated).
10641
10642 If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used,
10643 the latter will take precedence. If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is
10644 used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take
10645 precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure
10646 may affect its placement.
10647
10648 The weak pragma only works if @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK} and
10649 @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} are defined. If enabled it allows the creation
10650 of specifically named weak labels, optionally with a value.
10651 @end defmac
10652
10653 @findex #pragma
10654 @findex pragma
10655 @defmac HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_PUSH_POP
10656 Define this macro (to a value of 1) if you want to support the Win32
10657 style pragmas @samp{#pragma pack(push[,@var{n}])} and @samp{#pragma
10658 pack(pop)}. The @samp{pack(push,[@var{n}])} pragma specifies the maximum
10659 alignment (in bytes) of fields within a structure, in much the same way as
10660 the @samp{__aligned__} and @samp{__packed__} @code{__attribute__}s do. A
10661 pack value of zero resets the behavior to the default. Successive
10662 invocations of this pragma cause the previous values to be stacked, so
10663 that invocations of @samp{#pragma pack(pop)} will return to the previous
10664 value.
10665 @end defmac
10666
10667 @defmac HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_WITH_EXPANSION
10668 Define this macro, as well as
10669 @code{HANDLE_SYSV_PRAGMA}, if macros should be expanded in the
10670 arguments of @samp{#pragma pack}.
10671 @end defmac
10672
10673 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HANDLE_PRAGMA_EXTERN_PREFIX
10674 True if @code{#pragma extern_prefix} is to be supported.
10675 @end deftypevr
10676
10677 @defmac TARGET_DEFAULT_PACK_STRUCT
10678 If your target requires a structure packing default other than 0 (meaning
10679 the machine default), define this macro to the necessary value (in bytes).
10680 This must be a value that would also be valid to use with
10681 @samp{#pragma pack()} (that is, a small power of two).
10682 @end defmac
10683
10684 @defmac DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
10685 Define this macro to control use of the character @samp{$} in
10686 identifier names for the C family of languages. 0 means @samp{$} is
10687 not allowed by default; 1 means it is allowed. 1 is the default;
10688 there is no need to define this macro in that case.
10689 @end defmac
10690
10691 @defmac NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
10692 Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
10693 @samp{$} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in
10694 G++ have @samp{$} in the identifiers. If this macro is defined,
10695 @samp{.} is used instead.
10696 @end defmac
10697
10698 @defmac NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
10699 Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
10700 @samp{.} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in G++
10701 have names that use @samp{.}. If this macro is defined, these names
10702 are rewritten to avoid @samp{.}.
10703 @end defmac
10704
10705 @defmac INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
10706 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10707 delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10708 even if they appear to use a resource set or clobbered in @var{insn}.
10709 @var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}; GCC knows that
10710 every @code{call_insn} has this behavior. On machines where some @code{insn}
10711 or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and hence has this behavior,
10712 you should define this macro.
10713
10714 You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
10715 @end defmac
10716
10717 @defmac INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
10718 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10719 delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10720 even if they appear to set or clobber a resource referenced in @var{insn}.
10721 @var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}. On machines where
10722 some @code{insn} or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and its operands
10723 are registers whose use is actually in the subroutine it calls, you should
10724 define this macro. Doing so allows the delay slot scheduler to move
10725 instructions which copy arguments into the argument registers into the delay
10726 slot of @var{insn}.
10727
10728 You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
10729 @end defmac
10730
10731 @defmac MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
10732 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if, in some cases,
10733 global symbols from one translation unit may not be bound to undefined
10734 symbols in another translation unit without user intervention. For
10735 instance, under Microsoft Windows symbols must be explicitly imported
10736 from shared libraries (DLLs).
10737
10738 You need not define this macro if it would always evaluate to zero.
10739 @end defmac
10740
10741 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MD_ASM_CLOBBERS (tree @var{outputs}, tree @var{inputs}, tree @var{clobbers})
10742 This target hook should add to @var{clobbers} @code{STRING_CST} trees for
10743 any hard regs the port wishes to automatically clobber for an asm.
10744 It should return the result of the last @code{tree_cons} used to add a
10745 clobber. The @var{outputs}, @var{inputs} and @var{clobber} lists are the
10746 corresponding parameters to the asm and may be inspected to avoid
10747 clobbering a register that is an input or output of the asm. You can use
10748 @code{tree_overlaps_hard_reg_set}, declared in @file{tree.h}, to test
10749 for overlap with regards to asm-declared registers.
10750 @end deftypefn
10751
10752 @defmac MATH_LIBRARY
10753 Define this macro as a C string constant for the linker argument to link
10754 in the system math library, minus the initial @samp{"-l"}, or
10755 @samp{""} if the target does not have a
10756 separate math library.
10757
10758 You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"m"} is wrong.
10759 @end defmac
10760
10761 @defmac LIBRARY_PATH_ENV
10762 Define this macro as a C string constant for the environment variable that
10763 specifies where the linker should look for libraries.
10764
10765 You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"LIBRARY_PATH"}
10766 is wrong.
10767 @end defmac
10768
10769 @defmac TARGET_POSIX_IO
10770 Define this macro if the target supports the following POSIX@ file
10771 functions, access, mkdir and file locking with fcntl / F_SETLKW@.
10772 Defining @code{TARGET_POSIX_IO} will enable the test coverage code
10773 to use file locking when exiting a program, which avoids race conditions
10774 if the program has forked. It will also create directories at run-time
10775 for cross-profiling.
10776 @end defmac
10777
10778 @defmac MAX_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTE
10779
10780 A C expression for the maximum number of instructions to execute via
10781 conditional execution instructions instead of a branch. A value of
10782 @code{BRANCH_COST}+1 is the default if the machine does not use cc0, and
10783 1 if it does use cc0.
10784 @end defmac
10785
10786 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
10787 Used if the target needs to perform machine-dependent modifications on the
10788 conditionals used for turning basic blocks into conditionally executed code.
10789 @var{ce_info} points to a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which
10790 contains information about the currently processed blocks. @var{true_expr}
10791 and @var{false_expr} are the tests that are used for converting the
10792 then-block and the else-block, respectively. Set either @var{true_expr} or
10793 @var{false_expr} to a null pointer if the tests cannot be converted.
10794 @end defmac
10795
10796 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_MULTIPLE_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{bb}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
10797 Like @code{IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS}, but used when converting more complicated
10798 if-statements into conditions combined by @code{and} and @code{or} operations.
10799 @var{bb} contains the basic block that contains the test that is currently
10800 being processed and about to be turned into a condition.
10801 @end defmac
10802
10803 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN (@var{ce_info}, @var{pattern}, @var{insn})
10804 A C expression to modify the @var{PATTERN} of an @var{INSN} that is to
10805 be converted to conditional execution format. @var{ce_info} points to
10806 a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which contains information
10807 about the currently processed blocks.
10808 @end defmac
10809
10810 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_FINAL (@var{ce_info})
10811 A C expression to perform any final machine dependent modifications in
10812 converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10813 can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10814 to by @var{ce_info}.
10815 @end defmac
10816
10817 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_CANCEL (@var{ce_info})
10818 A C expression to cancel any machine dependent modifications in
10819 converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10820 can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10821 to by @var{ce_info}.
10822 @end defmac
10823
10824 @defmac IFCVT_INIT_EXTRA_FIELDS (@var{ce_info})
10825 A C expression to initialize any extra fields in a @code{struct ce_if_block}
10826 structure, which are defined by the @code{IFCVT_EXTRA_FIELDS} macro.
10827 @end defmac
10828
10829 @defmac IFCVT_EXTRA_FIELDS
10830 If defined, it should expand to a set of field declarations that will be
10831 added to the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure. These should be initialized
10832 by the @code{IFCVT_INIT_EXTRA_FIELDS} macro.
10833 @end defmac
10834
10835 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG (void)
10836 If non-null, this hook performs a target-specific pass over the
10837 instruction stream. The compiler will run it at all optimization levels,
10838 just before the point at which it normally does delayed-branch scheduling.
10839
10840 The exact purpose of the hook varies from target to target. Some use
10841 it to do transformations that are necessary for correctness, such as
10842 laying out in-function constant pools or avoiding hardware hazards.
10843 Others use it as an opportunity to do some machine-dependent optimizations.
10844
10845 You need not implement the hook if it has nothing to do. The default
10846 definition is null.
10847 @end deftypefn
10848
10849 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS (void)
10850 Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10851 that need to be defined. It should be a function that performs the
10852 necessary setup.
10853
10854 Machine specific built-in functions can be useful to expand special machine
10855 instructions that would otherwise not normally be generated because
10856 they have no equivalent in the source language (for example, SIMD vector
10857 instructions or prefetch instructions).
10858
10859 To create a built-in function, call the function
10860 @code{lang_hooks.builtin_function}
10861 which is defined by the language front end. You can use any type nodes set
10862 up by @code{build_common_tree_nodes} and @code{build_common_tree_nodes_2};
10863 only language front ends that use those two functions will call
10864 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.
10865 @end deftypefn
10866
10867 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_DECL (unsigned @var{code}, bool @var{initialize_p})
10868 Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10869 that need to be defined. It should be a function that returns the
10870 builtin function declaration for the builtin function code @var{code}.
10871 If there is no such builtin and it cannot be initialized at this time
10872 if @var{initialize_p} is true the function should return @code{NULL_TREE}.
10873 If @var{code} is out of range the function should return
10874 @code{error_mark_node}.
10875 @end deftypefn
10876
10877 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN (tree @var{exp}, rtx @var{target}, rtx @var{subtarget}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, int @var{ignore})
10878
10879 Expand a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
10880 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{exp} is the expression for the
10881 function call; the result should go to @var{target} if that is
10882 convenient, and have mode @var{mode} if that is convenient.
10883 @var{subtarget} may be used as the target for computing one of
10884 @var{exp}'s operands. @var{ignore} is nonzero if the value is to be
10885 ignored. This function should return the result of the call to the
10886 built-in function.
10887 @end deftypefn
10888
10889 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_RESOLVE_OVERLOADED_BUILTIN (unsigned int @var{loc}, tree @var{fndecl}, void *@var{arglist})
10890 Select a replacement for a machine specific built-in function that
10891 was set up by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. This is done
10892 @emph{before} regular type checking, and so allows the target to
10893 implement a crude form of function overloading. @var{fndecl} is the
10894 declaration of the built-in function. @var{arglist} is the list of
10895 arguments passed to the built-in function. The result is a
10896 complete expression that implements the operation, usually
10897 another @code{CALL_EXPR}.
10898 @var{arglist} really has type @samp{VEC(tree,gc)*}
10899 @end deftypefn
10900
10901 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_FOLD_BUILTIN (tree @var{fndecl}, int @var{n_args}, tree *@var{argp}, bool @var{ignore})
10902 Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
10903 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{fndecl} is the declaration of the
10904 built-in function. @var{n_args} is the number of arguments passed to
10905 the function; the arguments themselves are pointed to by @var{argp}.
10906 The result is another tree containing a simplified expression for the
10907 call's result. If @var{ignore} is true the value will be ignored.
10908 @end deftypefn
10909
10910 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_WITHIN_DOLOOP (const_rtx @var{insn})
10911
10912 Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return NULL if it is valid within a
10913 low-overhead loop, otherwise return a string explaining why doloop
10914 could not be applied.
10915
10916 Many targets use special registers for low-overhead looping. For any
10917 instruction that clobbers these this function should return a string indicating
10918 the reason why the doloop could not be applied.
10919 By default, the RTL loop optimizer does not use a present doloop pattern for
10920 loops containing function calls or branch on table instructions.
10921 @end deftypefn
10922
10923 @defmac MD_CAN_REDIRECT_BRANCH (@var{branch1}, @var{branch2})
10924
10925 Take a branch insn in @var{branch1} and another in @var{branch2}.
10926 Return true if redirecting @var{branch1} to the destination of
10927 @var{branch2} is possible.
10928
10929 On some targets, branches may have a limited range. Optimizing the
10930 filling of delay slots can result in branches being redirected, and this
10931 may in turn cause a branch offset to overflow.
10932 @end defmac
10933
10934 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_COMMUTATIVE_P (const_rtx @var{x}, int @var{outer_code})
10935 This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{x} is considered to be commutative.
10936 Usually, this is just COMMUTATIVE_P (@var{x}), but the HP PA doesn't consider
10937 PLUS to be commutative inside a MEM@. @var{outer_code} is the rtx code
10938 of the enclosing rtl, if known, otherwise it is UNKNOWN.
10939 @end deftypefn
10940
10941 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE (rtx @var{hard_reg})
10942
10943 When the initial value of a hard register has been copied in a pseudo
10944 register, it is often not necessary to actually allocate another register
10945 to this pseudo register, because the original hard register or a stack slot
10946 it has been saved into can be used. @code{TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE}
10947 is called at the start of register allocation once for each hard register
10948 that had its initial value copied by using
10949 @code{get_func_hard_reg_initial_val} or @code{get_hard_reg_initial_val}.
10950 Possible values are @code{NULL_RTX}, if you don't want
10951 to do any special allocation, a @code{REG} rtx---that would typically be
10952 the hard register itself, if it is known not to be clobbered---or a
10953 @code{MEM}.
10954 If you are returning a @code{MEM}, this is only a hint for the allocator;
10955 it might decide to use another register anyways.
10956 You may use @code{current_function_leaf_function} in the hook, functions
10957 that use @code{REG_N_SETS}, to determine if the hard
10958 register in question will not be clobbered.
10959 The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which disables any special
10960 allocation.
10961 @end deftypefn
10962
10963 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_UNSPEC_MAY_TRAP_P (const_rtx @var{x}, unsigned @var{flags})
10964 This target hook returns nonzero if @var{x}, an @code{unspec} or
10965 @code{unspec_volatile} operation, might cause a trap. Targets can use
10966 this hook to enhance precision of analysis for @code{unspec} and
10967 @code{unspec_volatile} operations. You may call @code{may_trap_p_1}
10968 to analyze inner elements of @var{x} in which case @var{flags} should be
10969 passed along.
10970 @end deftypefn
10971
10972 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_CURRENT_FUNCTION (tree @var{decl})
10973 The compiler invokes this hook whenever it changes its current function
10974 context (@code{cfun}). You can define this function if
10975 the back end needs to perform any initialization or reset actions on a
10976 per-function basis. For example, it may be used to implement function
10977 attributes that affect register usage or code generation patterns.
10978 The argument @var{decl} is the declaration for the new function context,
10979 and may be null to indicate that the compiler has left a function context
10980 and is returning to processing at the top level.
10981 The default hook function does nothing.
10982
10983 GCC sets @code{cfun} to a dummy function context during initialization of
10984 some parts of the back end. The hook function is not invoked in this
10985 situation; you need not worry about the hook being invoked recursively,
10986 or when the back end is in a partially-initialized state.
10987 @code{cfun} might be @code{NULL} to indicate processing at top level,
10988 outside of any function scope.
10989 @end deftypefn
10990
10991 @defmac TARGET_OBJECT_SUFFIX
10992 Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix for object
10993 files on your target machine. If you do not define this macro, GCC will
10994 use @samp{.o} as the suffix for object files.
10995 @end defmac
10996
10997 @defmac TARGET_EXECUTABLE_SUFFIX
10998 Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix to be
10999 automatically added to executable files on your target machine. If you
11000 do not define this macro, GCC will use the null string as the suffix for
11001 executable files.
11002 @end defmac
11003
11004 @defmac COLLECT_EXPORT_LIST
11005 If defined, @code{collect2} will scan the individual object files
11006 specified on its command line and create an export list for the linker.
11007 Define this macro for systems like AIX, where the linker discards
11008 object files that are not referenced from @code{main} and uses export
11009 lists.
11010 @end defmac
11011
11012 @defmac MODIFY_JNI_METHOD_CALL (@var{mdecl})
11013 Define this macro to a C expression representing a variant of the
11014 method call @var{mdecl}, if Java Native Interface (JNI) methods
11015 must be invoked differently from other methods on your target.
11016 For example, on 32-bit Microsoft Windows, JNI methods must be invoked using
11017 the @code{stdcall} calling convention and this macro is then
11018 defined as this expression:
11019
11020 @smallexample
11021 build_type_attribute_variant (@var{mdecl},
11022 build_tree_list
11023 (get_identifier ("stdcall"),
11024 NULL))
11025 @end smallexample
11026 @end defmac
11027
11028 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_MODIFY_JUMPS_P (void)
11029 This target hook returns @code{true} past the point in which new jump
11030 instructions could be created. On machines that require a register for
11031 every jump such as the SHmedia ISA of SH5, this point would typically be
11032 reload, so this target hook should be defined to a function such as:
11033
11034 @smallexample
11035 static bool
11036 cannot_modify_jumps_past_reload_p ()
11037 @{
11038 return (reload_completed || reload_in_progress);
11039 @}
11040 @end smallexample
11041 @end deftypefn
11042
11043 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS (void)
11044 This target hook returns a register class for which branch target register
11045 optimizations should be applied. All registers in this class should be
11046 usable interchangeably. After reload, registers in this class will be
11047 re-allocated and loads will be hoisted out of loops and be subjected
11048 to inter-block scheduling.
11049 @end deftypefn
11050
11051 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CALLEE_SAVED (bool @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen})
11052 Branch target register optimization will by default exclude callee-saved
11053 registers
11054 that are not already live during the current function; if this target hook
11055 returns true, they will be included. The target code must than make sure
11056 that all target registers in the class returned by
11057 @samp{TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS} that might need saving are
11058 saved. @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} indicates if prologues and
11059 epilogues have already been generated. Note, even if you only return
11060 true when @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} is false, you still are likely
11061 to have to make special provisions in @code{INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET}
11062 to reserve space for caller-saved target registers.
11063 @end deftypefn
11064
11065 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTION (void)
11066 This target hook returns true if the target supports conditional execution.
11067 This target hook is required only when the target has several different
11068 modes and they have different conditional execution capability, such as ARM.
11069 @end deftypefn
11070
11071 @deftypefn {Target Hook} unsigned TARGET_LOOP_UNROLL_ADJUST (unsigned @var{nunroll}, struct loop *@var{loop})
11072 This target hook returns a new value for the number of times @var{loop}
11073 should be unrolled. The parameter @var{nunroll} is the number of times
11074 the loop is to be unrolled. The parameter @var{loop} is a pointer to
11075 the loop, which is going to be checked for unrolling. This target hook
11076 is required only when the target has special constraints like maximum
11077 number of memory accesses.
11078 @end deftypefn
11079
11080 @defmac POWI_MAX_MULTS
11081 If defined, this macro is interpreted as a signed integer C expression
11082 that specifies the maximum number of floating point multiplications
11083 that should be emitted when expanding exponentiation by an integer
11084 constant inline. When this value is defined, exponentiation requiring
11085 more than this number of multiplications is implemented by calling the
11086 system library's @code{pow}, @code{powf} or @code{powl} routines.
11087 The default value places no upper bound on the multiplication count.
11088 @end defmac
11089
11090 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11091 This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11092 target. The parameter @var{stdinc} indicates if normal include files
11093 are present. The parameter @var{sysroot} is the system root directory.
11094 The parameter @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11095 @end deftypefn
11096
11097 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_PRE_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11098 This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11099 target before any standard headers. The parameter @var{stdinc}
11100 indicates if normal include files are present. The parameter
11101 @var{sysroot} is the system root directory. The parameter
11102 @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11103 @end deftypefn
11104
11105 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_OPTF (char *@var{path})
11106 This target hook should register special include paths for the target.
11107 The parameter @var{path} is the include to register. On Darwin
11108 systems, this is used for Framework includes, which have semantics
11109 that are different from @option{-I}.
11110 @end deftypefn
11111
11112 @defmac bool TARGET_USE_LOCAL_THUNK_ALIAS_P (tree @var{fndecl})
11113 This target macro returns @code{true} if it is safe to use a local alias
11114 for a virtual function @var{fndecl} when constructing thunks,
11115 @code{false} otherwise. By default, the macro returns @code{true} for all
11116 functions, if a target supports aliases (i.e.@: defines
11117 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF}), @code{false} otherwise,
11118 @end defmac
11119
11120 @defmac TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES
11121 If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11122 target-specific format checking information for the @option{-Wformat}
11123 option. The default is to have no target-specific format checks.
11124 @end defmac
11125
11126 @defmac TARGET_N_FORMAT_TYPES
11127 If defined, this macro is the number of entries in
11128 @code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES}.
11129 @end defmac
11130
11131 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES
11132 If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11133 target-specific format overrides for the @option{-Wformat} option. The
11134 default is to have no target-specific format overrides. If defined,
11135 @code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES} must be defined, too.
11136 @end defmac
11137
11138 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES_COUNT
11139 If defined, this macro specifies the number of entries in
11140 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES}.
11141 @end defmac
11142
11143 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_INIT
11144 If defined, this macro specifies the optional initialization
11145 routine for target specific customizations of the system printf
11146 and scanf formatter settings.
11147 @end defmac
11148
11149 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RELAXED_ORDERING
11150 If set to @code{true}, means that the target's memory model does not
11151 guarantee that loads which do not depend on one another will access
11152 main memory in the order of the instruction stream; if ordering is
11153 important, an explicit memory barrier must be used. This is true of
11154 many recent processors which implement a policy of ``relaxed,''
11155 ``weak,'' or ``release'' memory consistency, such as Alpha, PowerPC,
11156 and ia64. The default is @code{false}.
11157 @end deftypevr
11158
11159 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_ARG_FOR_UNPROTOTYPED_FN (const_tree @var{typelist}, const_tree @var{funcdecl}, const_tree @var{val})
11160 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11161 illegal to pass argument @var{val} to function @var{funcdecl}
11162 with prototype @var{typelist}.
11163 @end deftypefn
11164
11165 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_CONVERSION (const_tree @var{fromtype}, const_tree @var{totype})
11166 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11167 invalid to convert from @var{fromtype} to @var{totype}, or @code{NULL}
11168 if validity should be determined by the front end.
11169 @end deftypefn
11170
11171 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_UNARY_OP (int @var{op}, const_tree @var{type})
11172 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11173 invalid to apply operation @var{op} (where unary plus is denoted by
11174 @code{CONVERT_EXPR}) to an operand of type @var{type}, or @code{NULL}
11175 if validity should be determined by the front end.
11176 @end deftypefn
11177
11178 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_BINARY_OP (int @var{op}, const_tree @var{type1}, const_tree @var{type2})
11179 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11180 invalid to apply operation @var{op} to operands of types @var{type1}
11181 and @var{type2}, or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11182 the front end.
11183 @end deftypefn
11184
11185 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_PARAMETER_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
11186 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11187 invalid for functions to include parameters of type @var{type},
11188 or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11189 the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11190 @end deftypefn
11191
11192 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_RETURN_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
11193 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11194 invalid for functions to have return type @var{type},
11195 or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11196 the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11197 @end deftypefn
11198
11199 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_PROMOTED_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
11200 If defined, this target hook returns the type to which values of
11201 @var{type} should be promoted when they appear in expressions,
11202 analogous to the integer promotions, or @code{NULL_TREE} to use the
11203 front end's normal promotion rules. This hook is useful when there are
11204 target-specific types with special promotion rules.
11205 This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11206 @end deftypefn
11207
11208 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CONVERT_TO_TYPE (tree @var{type}, tree @var{expr})
11209 If defined, this hook returns the result of converting @var{expr} to
11210 @var{type}. It should return the converted expression,
11211 or @code{NULL_TREE} to apply the front end's normal conversion rules.
11212 This hook is useful when there are target-specific types with special
11213 conversion rules.
11214 This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11215 @end deftypefn
11216
11217 @defmac TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION
11218 This macro determines whether to use the JCR section to register Java
11219 classes. By default, TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION is defined to 1 if both
11220 SUPPORTS_WEAK and TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS are true, else 0.
11221 @end defmac
11222
11223 @defmac OBJC_JBLEN
11224 This macro determines the size of the objective C jump buffer for the
11225 NeXT runtime. By default, OBJC_JBLEN is defined to an innocuous value.
11226 @end defmac
11227
11228 @defmac LIBGCC2_UNWIND_ATTRIBUTE
11229 Define this macro if any target-specific attributes need to be attached
11230 to the functions in @file{libgcc} that provide low-level support for
11231 call stack unwinding. It is used in declarations in @file{unwind-generic.h}
11232 and the associated definitions of those functions.
11233 @end defmac
11234
11235 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_UPDATE_STACK_BOUNDARY (void)
11236 Define this macro to update the current function stack boundary if
11237 necessary.
11238 @end deftypefn
11239
11240 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_GET_DRAP_RTX (void)
11241 This hook should return an rtx for Dynamic Realign Argument Pointer (DRAP) if a
11242 different argument pointer register is needed to access the function's
11243 argument list due to stack realignment. Return @code{NULL} if no DRAP
11244 is needed.
11245 @end deftypefn
11246
11247 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALLOCATE_STACK_SLOTS_FOR_ARGS (void)
11248 When optimization is disabled, this hook indicates whether or not
11249 arguments should be allocated to stack slots. Normally, GCC allocates
11250 stacks slots for arguments when not optimizing in order to make
11251 debugging easier. However, when a function is declared with
11252 @code{__attribute__((naked))}, there is no stack frame, and the compiler
11253 cannot safely move arguments from the registers in which they are passed
11254 to the stack. Therefore, this hook should return true in general, but
11255 false for naked functions. The default implementation always returns true.
11256 @end deftypefn
11257
11258 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR
11259 On some architectures it can take multiple instructions to synthesize
11260 a constant. If there is another constant already in a register that
11261 is close enough in value then it is preferable that the new constant
11262 is computed from this register using immediate addition or
11263 subtraction. We accomplish this through CSE. Besides the value of
11264 the constant we also add a lower and an upper constant anchor to the
11265 available expressions. These are then queried when encountering new
11266 constants. The anchors are computed by rounding the constant up and
11267 down to a multiple of the value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR}.
11268 @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} should be the maximum positive value
11269 accepted by immediate-add plus one. We currently assume that the
11270 value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is a power of 2. For example, on
11271 MIPS, where add-immediate takes a 16-bit signed value,
11272 @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is set to @samp{0x8000}. The default value
11273 is zero, which disables this optimization. @end deftypevr